Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

mf8580cdw Scribd PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 401
At a glance
Powered by AI
The manual provides information on technical theory, installation, maintenance and repair of Canon products. It uses various symbols to indicate permissions, prohibitions and actions that should be taken. Data can be backed up to different locations and initialized in various ways.

The manual uses symbols to indicate actions like removing screws, tightening screws, checking, disconnecting/connecting connectors, turning on power etc. It also uses symbols to represent signal directions in diagrams.

The different types of data that can be backed up include address book, preferences, timer settings, copy settings, fax settings etc. They are stored in locations like flash ROM, DC controller PCB, main controller PCB etc.

MF8500Series/MF8200Series

Service Manual Rev.0

Product Overview
Technical Overview
Periodical Services
Disassembly/Assembly
Adjustment
Trouble Shooting
Error codes
Service Mode
Appendex
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Application
This manual has been issued by Canon Inc. for qualified persons to learn technical theory, The following paragraph does not apply to any countries where such provisions are
installation, maintenance, and repair of products. This manual covers all localities where the inconsistent with local law.
products are sold. For this reason, there may be information in this manual that does not
apply to your locality. Trademarks
The product names and company names used in this manual are the registered trademarks
Corrections of the individual companies.
This manual may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors due to improvements
or changes in products. When changes occur in applicable products or in the contents of this Copyright
manual, Canon will release technical information as the need arises. In the event of major This manual is copyrighted with all rights reserved. Under the copyright laws, this manual may
changes in the contents of this manual over a long or short period, Canon will issue a new not be copied, reproduced or translated into another language, in whole or in part, without the
edition of this manual. consent of Canon Inc.

© CANON INC. 2013

Caution
Use of this manual should be strictly supervised to avoid disclosure of confidential
information.
Explanation of Symbols The following rules apply throughout this Service Manual:
The following symbols are used throughout this Service Manual.
1. Each chapter contains sections explaining the purpose of specific functions and the
Symbols Explanation Symbols Explanation relationship between electrical and mechanical systems with reference to the timing of
operation.
In the diagrams, represents the path of mechanical drive; where a signal name
Used to show permission. Remove the screw.
accompanies the symbol, the arrow indicates the direction of the electric
signal.
The expression "turn on the power" means flipping on the power switch, closing the
Used to show prohibition. Tighten the screw. front door, and closing the delivery unit door, which results in supplying the machine with
power.

2. In the digital circuits, '1' is used to indicate that the voltage level of a given signal is
Check. Remove the claw.
"High", while '0' is used to indicate "Low". (The voltage value, however, differs from
circuit to circuit.) In addition, the asterisk (*) as in "DRMD*" indicates that the DRMD
signal goes on when '0'.
Check visually. Insert the claw. In practically all cases, the internal mechanisms of a microprocessor cannot be checked
in the field. Therefore, the operations of the microprocessors used in the machines
are not discussed: they are explained in terms of from sensors to the input of the DC
controller PCB and from the output of the DC controller PCB to the loads.
Check the noise. Use the bundled part.

The descriptions in this Service Manual are subject to change without notice for product
improvement or other purposes, and major changes will be communicated in the form of
Disconnect the connector. Push the part. Service Information bulletins.
All service persons are expected to have a good understanding of the contents of this Service
Manual and all relevant Service Information bulletins and be able to identify and isolate faults
in the machine.
Connect the connector. Plug the power cable.

Remove the cable/wire


from the cable guide or wire Turn on the power.
saddle.

Set the cable/wire to the


cable guide or wire saddle.

T-0-1
Contents
0 Safety Precautions 2 Technical Overview
CDRH Provisions--------------------------------------------------------------0-2 Basic Configuration------------------------------------------------------------2-2
Notes When Handling a Lithium Battery---------------------------------0-2 Configuration function------------------------------------------------------------- 2-2
Laser Safety---------------------------------------------------------------------0-2 Basic Sequence--------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-2
About Laser Beams---------------------------------------------------------------- 0-2 Print Mode---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-5
Handling Laser Scanner Unit---------------------------------------------------- 0-2 Document Exposure/Feeder System-------------------------------------2-6
Toner Safety---------------------------------------------------------------------0-3 Document Exposure System----------------------------------------------------- 2-6
About Toner-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0-3 Document Feeder System-------------------------------------------------------- 2-8
Handling Adhered Toner---------------------------------------------------------- 0-3 Service Tasks------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-9
Notes on Assembly/Disassembly------------------------------------------0-3 Controller System------------------------------------------------------------ 2-10
Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-10
1 Product Overview Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-11
Product Lineups----------------------------------------------------------------1-2 Service Tasks-----------------------------------------------------------------------2-14
Main Unit------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-2 Laser Control System------------------------------------------------------- 2-15
Options-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-3 Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-15
Product Features---------------------------------------------------------------1-4 Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-15
Features------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-4 Service Tasks-----------------------------------------------------------------------2-16
Specifications-------------------------------------------------------------------1-5 Image Formation System-------------------------------------------------- 2-17
Main Unit Specifications----------------------------------------------------------- 1-5 Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-17
ADF Specifications----------------------------------------------------------------- 1-7 Parts-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-17
Wireless LAN Specifications----------------------------------------------------- 1-7 Image Forming Process----------------------------------------------------------2-18
SEND Specifications--------------------------------------------------------------- 1-8 Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-23
FAX Specifications------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-8 Service Tasks-----------------------------------------------------------------------2-28
Print Speed--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-9 Fixing System----------------------------------------------------------------- 2-29
Paper types / Paper size---------------------------------------------------------1-10 Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-29
Name of Parts----------------------------------------------------------------- 1-12 Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-29
External View-----------------------------------------------------------------------1-12 Service Works----------------------------------------------------------------------2-32
Cross Section View----------------------------------------------------------------1-15 Pickup / Feed System------------------------------------------------------- 2-33
Control Panel-----------------------------------------------------------------------1-17 Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-33
Parts Configuration----------------------------------------------------------------2-34
Drive Configuration----------------------------------------------------------------2-35
Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-36 Removing the ADF Pickup Roller----------------------------------------------4-40
Service Works----------------------------------------------------------------------2-38 Removing the ADF Separation Roller----------------------------------------4-41
Removing the ADF Separation Pad-------------------------------------------4-42
3 Periodical Services Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit-----------------------------------------4-43
Periodically Replaced Parts-------------------------------------------------3-2 Removing the ADF Pickup Motor----------------------------------------------4-46
Durable Parts-------------------------------------------------------------------3-2 Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover------------------------------------4-47
Periodical Services------------------------------------------------------------3-2 Removing the CIS Unit-----------------------------------------------------------4-49
Cleaning--------------------------------------------------------------------------3-2 Removing the Reader Scanner Motor----------------------------------------4-52
Controller System------------------------------------------------------------ 4-55
4 Disassembly/Assembly Location------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-55
List of Parts----------------------------------------------------------------------4-2 Removing the Controller Cover------------------------------------------------4-57
List of External/ Internal Cover (MF8500 series)--------------------------- 4-2 Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8580Cdw)-------------------------4-57
List of Main Unit (MF8500 series)---------------------------------------------- 4-4 Removing the Main Controller PCB-------------------------------------------4-58
List of Motor/Fan (MF8500 series)--------------------------------------------- 4-6 Removing the Main Controller Support Plate-------------------------------4-61
List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/speaker Removing the DC Controller PCB---------------------------------------------4-61
(MF8500 series)--------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-7 Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB---------------------------4-63
List of Sensor (MF8500 series)-------------------------------------------------- 4-8 Removing the Low Voltage Unit------------------------------------------------4-65
PCB (MF8500 series)-------------------------------------------------------------- 4-9 Removing the Fixing Sub PCB-------------------------------------------------4-67
Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series)-------------------------------------------4-10 Removing the Driver PCB-------------------------------------------------------4-68
External Cover, Internal Cover-------------------------------------------- 4-15 Removing the Relay PCB--------------------------------------------------------4-69
Location------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-15 Removing the Control Panel Unit----------------------------------------------4-70
Removing the Left Cover--------------------------------------------------------4-17 Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB
Removing the Right Cover------------------------------------------------------4-20 and Control Panel Key PCB-----------------------------------------------------4-73
Removing the Right Front Cover-----------------------------------------------4-22 Removing the FAX PCB (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn)-------------------------4-75
Removing the Front Cover------------------------------------------------------4-23 Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn)-------------------4-75
Removing the Rear Upper Cover----------------------------------------------4-24 Removing the Main Drive Unit--------------------------------------------------4-76
Removing the Rear Cover-------------------------------------------------------4-24 Removing the Duplex Reverse Drive Unit-----------------------------------4-85
Removing the Rear Lower Cover----------------------------------------------4-25 Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit-----------4-86
Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit-------------------------------------------4-27 Removing the Duplex Feeding Fan-------------------------------------------4-88
Removing the Upper Cover-----------------------------------------------------4-28 Removing the Speaker (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn)--------------------------4-89
Removing the Cartridge Tray---------------------------------------------------4-30 Laser Exposure System---------------------------------------------------- 4-90
Document Exposure, Feed System------------------------------------- 4-31 Location------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-90
Location------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-31 Removing the Laser Scanner Unit---------------------------------------------4-90
Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit---------------------------------------4-32 Image Formation System-------------------------------------------------- 4-95
Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit--------------------------------------4-35 Location------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-95
Removing the ADF Roller Unit--------------------------------------------------4-38 Removing the ITB Unit-----------------------------------------------------------4-95
Removing the Patch Density and Registration Sensor unit-------------4-98 Removing the Rear Lower Cover-------------------------------------------- 4-154
Removing the Developing Motor--------------------------------------------- 4-100 Removing the Rear Cover----------------------------------------------------- 4-155
Removing the Drum Motor---------------------------------------------------- 4-102 Removing the Upper Cover--------------------------------------------------- 4-156
Fixing System--------------------------------------------------------------- 4-104 Document exposure/feeder system----------------------------------- 4-157
Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-104 Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-157
Removing the Fixing Assembly----------------------------------------------- 4-104 Removing the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit--------------------- 4-158
Removing the Fixing Film Unit ----------------------------------------------- 4-106 Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit-------------------- 4-160
Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller--------------------------------------- 4-110 Removing the ADF Roller Unit
Removing the Fixing Motor Unit-----------------------------------------------4-111 (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)------------------------------------ 4-164
Pickup Feeder System-----------------------------------------------------4-113 Removing the ADF Pickup Roller
Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller-------------------------------------- 4-114 (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)------------------------------------ 4-166
Removing the Cassette Separation Roller-------------------------------- 4-115 Removing the ADF separation roller
Removing the MP Tray Pickup Roller--------------------------------------- 4-117 (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)------------------------------------ 4-166
Removing the MP Tray Separation Pad------------------------------------ 4-117 Removing the ADF Separation Pad
Removing the Pickup Motor--------------------------------------------------- 4-118 (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)------------------------------------ 4-167
Removing the Pickup Unit----------------------------------------------------- 4-120 Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
Removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit----------------------------------------- 4-125 (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)------------------------------------ 4-169
Removing the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit---------------------------- 4-127 Removing the ADF Pickup Motor
Removing the Delivery Unit--------------------------------------------------- 4-128 (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)------------------------------------ 4-172
Removing the Duplex Feed Unit--------------------------------------------- 4-130 Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover---------------------------------- 4-173
Removing the Re-pickup Guide Unit---------------------------------------- 4-131 Removing the CIS Unit--------------------------------------------------------- 4-175
List of Parts------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-132 Removing the Reader Scanner Motor-------------------------------------- 4-178
List of External / Internal Cover(MF8200 series)------------------------ 4-132 Controller System---------------------------------------------------------- 4-180
List of Main Unit (MF8200 series)------------------------------------------- 4-134 Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-180
List of Motor/Fan (MF8200 series)------------------------------------------ 4-135 Removing the Controller Cover---------------------------------------------- 4-182
List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/speaker Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8280Cw/8240Cw)------------- 4-182
(MF8200 series)------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-135 Removing the Main Controller PCB----------------------------------------- 4-183
List of Sensor (MF8200 series)----------------------------------------------- 4-136 Removing the DC Controller PCB------------------------------------------- 4-186
PCB (MF8200 series)----------------------------------------------------------- 4-137 Removing the Driver PCB----------------------------------------------------- 4-187
List of connector (MF8200 Series)------------------------------------------ 4-138 Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit-------------------------- 4-190
External Cover, Internal Cover------------------------------------------ 4-142 Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB------------------------- 4-193
Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-142 Removing the Fixing Power Supply Unit----------------------------------- 4-195
Removing the Left Cover------------------------------------------------------ 4-144 Removing the Control Panel Unit-------------------------------------------- 4-196
Removing the Right Cover---------------------------------------------------- 4-147 Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB
Removing the Front Covent Cover------------------------------------------ 4-150 and Control Panel Key PCB--------------------------------------------------- 4-199
Removing the Rear Upper Cover-------------------------------------------- 4-153 Removing the FAX PCB (MF8280Cw/8250Cn)-------------------------- 4-201
Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8280Cw/8250Cn)-------------------- 4-201 Controller test print----------------------------------------------------------------- 6-3
Removing the Main Drive Unit------------------------------------------------ 4-202 Trouble shooting items-------------------------------------------------------6-5
Removing the Sub Drive Unit------------------------------------------------- 4-209 Recurring faulty image------------------------------------------------------------- 6-5
Removing the Main Motor----------------------------------------------------- 4-210 Confirming nip width--------------------------------------------------------------- 6-5
Removing the Fan--------------------------------------------------------------- 4-211 Special Management Mode-------------------------------------------------6-6
Removing the Speaker (MF8280Cw/8250Cn)--------------------------- 4-212 Overview------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 6-6
Laser Exposure System-------------------------------------------------- 4-213 Supported models------------------------------------------------------------------ 6-6
Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-213 Operational Description----------------------------------------------------------- 6-6
Removing the Laser Scanner Unit------------------------------------------- 4-213 Menu List------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 6-7
Image Formation System------------------------------------------------ 4-218 Version Upgrade------------------------------------------------------------- 6-11
Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-218 Overview----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-11
Removing the ITB Unit--------------------------------------------------------- 4-218 UST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 6-11
Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller------------------------- 4-223 Preparation-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-11
Fixing System--------------------------------------------------------------- 4-225 Downloading System Software-------------------------------------------------6-12
Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-225 Upgrading via Internet------------------------------------------------------------6-13
Removing the Fixing Assembly----------------------------------------------- 4-225
Replacing the Fixing Film Unit------------------------------------------------ 4-228
Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller--------------------------------------- 4-231 7 Error codes
Removing the Fixing Motor---------------------------------------------------- 4-232 Overview-------------------------------------------------------------------------7-2
Pickup Feeder System---------------------------------------------------- 4-233 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-2
Location---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-233 Jam code------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7-2
Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller-------------------------------------- 4-233 Error Codes----------------------------------------------------------------------7-3
Removing the Cassette Separation Roller-------------------------------- 4-235 Jam Code------------------------------------------------------------------------7-8
Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit------------------------------------- 4-237 MF8500 Series---------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-8
Removing the Pickup Unit----------------------------------------------------- 4-242 MF8200 Series---------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-9

5 Adjustment 8 Service Mode


Overview-------------------------------------------------------------------------5-2 Overview-------------------------------------------------------------------------8-2
Adjustment at Parts Replacement-----------------------------------------5-3 Service Mode Menu---------------------------------------------------------------- 8-2
Document Exposure / Feed System------------------------------------------- 5-3 Backing up Service Mode--------------------------------------------------------- 8-2
Controller System------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-6 Screen flow of Service Mode---------------------------------------------------- 8-3
Laser Exposure System----------------------------------------------------------- 5-9 Remote UI service mode---------------------------------------------------------- 8-4
Supported models------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-4
6 Trouble Shooting COPIER--------------------------------------------------------------------------8-5
Test Print-------------------------------------------------------------------------6-2 DISPLAY------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-5
Engine test print--------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-2 I/O--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-7
ADJUST------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-7
FUNCTION--------------------------------------------------------------------------8-19
OPTION------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-27
COUTER-----------------------------------------------------------------------------8-30
FEEDER------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-34
ADJUST------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-34
FUNCTION--------------------------------------------------------------------------8-35
FAX------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-36
List of SSSW------------------------------------------------------------------------8-36
List of MENU------------------------------------------------------------------------8-38
List of NUM--------------------------------------------------------------------------8-38
Setting of NCU Parameters-----------------------------------------------------8-39
TESTMODE------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-43
PRINT---------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-43
FAX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-44

Appendex
Service Tools---------------------------------------------------------------------- II
Special Tools---------------------------------------------------------------------------- II
Solvents and Oils---------------------------------------------------------------------- II
General Circuit Diagram--------------------------------------------------------III
General Circuit Diagram (MF8500)----------------------------------------------- III
General Circuit Diagram (MF8200)----------------------------------------------- VI
Backup Data---------------------------------------------------------------------VIII
Safety Precautions

■CDRH Provisions

■Notes When Handling
a Lithium Battery

■Laser Safety

■Toner Safety

■Notes on Assembly/
Disassembly

F-0-1
0-2

CDRH Provisions Laser Safety


Food and Drug CDRH (Center for Devices and Radiological Health) under FDA (Food and
Drug Administration) enforced provisions of the section for laser and laser products on August About Laser Beams
2, 1976. These provisions are applicable to all laser products manufactured or assembled Laser radiation may be hazardous to human. The laser scanner unit mounted in this device is
after August 1, 1976 and allow only products certified their compliance with the provisions sealed in the protective housing and the external cover to prevent laser beams from leaking
to market in the US. Each product shall have affixed the applicable label as shown below to to the environment. As long as the device is operated under normal conditions, users are
follow the labeling requirements prescribed in CDRH provisions. safely arded from laser leaks.

Handling Laser Scanner Unit


Note that the wording included in labels is different depending on laser product Before providing service works for the laser scanner unit and its peripherals, ensure to turn
classifications. off the power of the device.
Any cover with potential dangers of laser beam reflection has affixed the caution label at the
position shown in the figure below.

Notes When Handling a Lithium Battery

CAUTION:

RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE.


DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.

The following warnings are given to comply with Safety Principles (EN60950).

CAUTION:

Wenn mit dem falschen Typ ausgewechselt, besteht Explosionsgefahr.


F-0-2
Gebrauchte Batterien gemäß der Anleitung beseitigen.

0-2
0-3

Toner Safety Notes on Assembly/Disassembly


Follow the items below to assemble/disassemble the device.
About Toner
1. Disconnect the power plug to avoid any potential dangers during assembling/disassembling
Toner is a nontoxic matter composed of plastic, iron and a trace of pigments. works.
2. If not specially instructed, reverse the order of disassembly to reinstall.
3. Ensure to use the right screw type (length, diameter, etc.) at the right position when
assembling.
Never throw toner in flames to avoid explosion. 4. To keep electric conduction, binding screws with washers are used to attach the grounding
wire and the varistor. Ensure to use the right screw type when assembling.
5. Unless it is specially needed, do not operate the device with some parts removed.
6. Never remove the paint-locked screws when disassembling.
Handling Adhered Toner
• Use dry tissue paper to wipe off toner adhered to skin or clothes and wash in water.
• Never use warm water for cleaning up toner to prevent toner particles from being gelated to CAUTION
soak into fibers permanently. DOUBLE POLE/NEUTRAL FUSING
• Toner particles are reactive with vinyl polymers. Avoid contacting these materials.

F-0-3

0-3
1 Product Overview

■Product

■Product
Lineups
Features

■Specifications

■Name of Parts

1
Product Overview
1 Product Overview > Product Lineups > Main Unit
1-2

Product Lineups Function MF8200 Series


MF8280Cw MF8250Cn MF8240Cw MF8230Cn MF8210Cn
Appearance
Main Unit
Function MF8500 Series
MF8580Cdw MF8570Cdw MF8550Cdn MF8540Cdn MF8530Cdn
Appearance

Copy Yes Yes Yes Yes


F-1-2 Yes
Print Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Fax Yes Yes - - -
USB Scan Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Network Scan Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Copy Yes Yes Yes Yes
F-1-1 Yes Wireless LAN Yes - Yes - -
Print Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes SEND - - - - -
Fax Yes Yes Yes - - Sequre Print - - - - -
USB Scan Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Remote UI Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Network Scan Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes ADF (1-side) Yes Yes Yes Yes -
Wireless LAN Yes Yes - - - ADF (2-side) - - - - -
SEND Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Automatic 2-sided Print - - - - -
Sequre Print Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes T-1-2
Remote UI Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
ADF (1-side) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
ADF (2-side) Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Automatic 2-sided Print Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
T-1-1

1-2
1
Product Overview > Product Lineups > Main Unit
1 Product Overview > Product Lineups > Options > MF8200 Series
1-3
Options ■■MF8200 Series
■■MF8500 Series

[1]

[2]

F-1-4
[1]
No. Name Description Remarks
1 TELEPHONE 6 KIT Long cord Telephone call is enabled by using the AUS, EUR
F-1-3
Cool White handset.
No. Name Description Remarks HANDSET KIT 3 Long cord Cool CLA, CSPL, CIPL,
1 Cassette Feeding Module-V1 A cassette unit with 250 sheet capacity White CHK, TWN
(for paper of 60-90g/m2) T-1-4
2 TELEPHONE 6 KIT Long cord Telephone call is enabled by using the AUS, EUR
Cool White handset.
HANDSET KIT 3 Long cord Cool CLA, CSPL, CIPL,
White CHK, TWN
T-1-3

1-3
1
Product Overview > Product Lineups > Options > MF8200 Series
1 Product Overview > Product Features > Features > MF8500Series / MF8200Series
1-4

Product Features ●● Mobile print supported (Apple Air Print, Google Cloud Print)

●● Addition of Scan to PC, Paper Save Copy by supporting Smart


Features
Shortcut Key
■■MF8500Series / MF8200Series
●● Compact MFP ●● Wireless LAN supported (MF8570Cdw, MF8580Cdw, MF8240Cw,
MF8280Cw)

●● Increased engine speed from 8/12 ppm (CL/BW) to 14/14 ppm (CL/
428.5 mm 478.5 mm BW) (MF8200 series only)
375 mm

430 mm 430 mm 434 mm

<MF8210Cn> <MF8200 Series> <MF8500 Series>


F-1-5

●● Improved operability by new color UI

F-1-6

1-4
1
Product Overview > Product Features > Features > MF8500Series / MF8200Series
1 Product Overview > Specifications > Main Unit Specifications
1-5

Specifications Item Specification / function


MF8500 Series MF8200 Series
Print area Cassette For print jobs (Non-envelope) For print jobs (Non-envelope)
Main Unit Specifications • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm
• Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
• Leading edge: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
• Left Side: 5.0+1.8 mm / -1.2 mm
For print jobs (envelope) For print jobs (envelope)
Item Specification / function • Leading edge: 10.0 ± 2.0 mm • Leading edge: 10.0 ± 1.5 mm
MF8500 Series MF8200 Series • Left Side: 10.0 ± 1.5 mm • Left Side: 10.0+1.8 mm / -1.2 mm
Copyboard Fixed For copy jobs: For copy jobs:
Device Installation Desktop • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
Light source LED (RGB) • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm • Left Side: 5.0+1.8 mm / -1.2 mm
Photoreceptor OPC drum (φ24) FAX / Report FAX / Report
Image scanning CIS (color) • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
Light exposure method Laser beam exposure • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm • Left Side: 5.0+1.8 mm / -1.2 mm
Charging method Roller charging Multi- (Non-envelope) (Non-envelope)
Developing method Contact development purpose For print jobs For print jobs
Transfer method Primary transfer: Tray • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm
Sequential 4 colors transfer to Intermediate Transfer Belt • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
Secondary transfer: For copy jobs: For copy jobs:
4-color batch transfer onto the transfer material by the Transfer Roller • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm
• Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
Separation method Curvature separation
FAX / Report FAX / Report
Cassette paper feed Simple separation retard
• Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm • Leading edge: 5.0 ± 2.0 mm
Multi-purpose tray paper Pad separation method Separation roller method • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm • Left Side: 5.0 ± 1.5 mm
feed
Drum cleaning method Cleaning blade
(envelope) (envelope)
Transfer cleaning method Cleaning brush and roller
For print jobs / For copy jobs: For print jobs / For copy jobs:
Fixing method On-demand fixing
• Leading edge: 10.0 ± 2.5 mm • Leading edge: 10.0 ± 3.0 mm
Paper delivery method Face-down • Left Side: 10.0 ± 2.5 mm • Left Side: 10.0 ± 2.5 mm
Toner level sensor Mounted Reading resolution Color: 600 x 600 dpi, 300 x 600 dpi, 300 x 300 dpi
Toner type Non-magnetic one-component toner B&W: 600 x 600 dpi, 300 x 600 dpi
Toner supply method All-in-one cartridge (drum + toner) Reading Speed Fixed (A4/LTR):
Toner save mode N/A N/A
Document types Sheet / book Continuous reading, SEND:
Maximum document size Copyboard Glass: 216 mm x 297 mm Color: 10 images / minute (A4/LTR)
Feeder: 216 x 356 mm B&W: 20 images / minute (A4)
Document size sensor N/A B&W: 21 images / minute (LTR)
Image size magnification AB series :25.0%, 50.0%, 70.7%, 81.6%, 86.5%, 100.0%, 115.4%, Copy resolution 600 x 600 dpi
122.4%, 141.4%, 200.0%, 400.0% Print resolution 600 x 600 dpi
Inch series :25.0%, 50.0%, 64.7%, 78.5%, 100.0%, 129.4%, 200.0%, First copy time Fixed (A4/LTR): Fixed (A4/LTR):
400.0% Color: 16 seconds or less Color / B&W: 19 seconds or less
A series :25.0%, 50.0%, 70.7%, 100.0%, 141.4%, 200.0%, 400.0% B&W: 15.3 seconds or less
AB series / Inch series :25.0%, 50.0%, 70.7%, 81.6%, 86.5%, 100.0%, Continuous reading: (A4/LTR) Continuous reading (A4/LTR)
115.4%, 122.4%, 141.4%, 200.0%, 400.0% Color: 16.5 seconds or less Color / B&W: 19 seconds or less
Zoom :25 to 400% (1% increment) B&W: 16.2 seconds or less
Warm-up Time *1 About 23 seconds or less About 23 seconds or less First print time Color / B&W: Color / B&W:
14.3 seconds or less (A4/LTR) 18.0 seconds or less (A4/LTR)

1-5
1
Product Overview > Specifications > Main Unit Specifications
1 Product Overview > Specifications > Main Unit Specifications
1-6
Item Specification / function Item Specification / function
MF8500 Series MF8200 Series MF8500 Series MF8200 Series
Print Speed 1-sided print (A4/LTR): Color / B&W: Maximum power 100 V: 1200 W or lower / 9.5 A 100 V: 1200 W or lower / 9.5 A
Color / B&W: 21 ppm (A4/LTR) 14 ppm (A4/LTR) consumption 120 V: 1200 W or lower / 9.0 A 120 V: 1200 W or lower / 9.0 A
2-sided print (A4/LTR): (For details, see “Print Speed”.) 230 V: 1200 W or lower / 6.0 A 230 V: 1200 W or lower / 6.0 A
Color / B&W: 10 ppm (A4/LTR) Average power at 100 V: 550 W or lower / 7.0 A 100 V: 400 W or lower / 4.5 A
(For details, see “Print Speed”.) operation 120 V: 550 W or lower / 6.0 A 120 V: 400 W or lower / 4.5 A
Available paper type for Plain paper, Recycled paper, Color paper, Thick paper, Coated paper, 230 V: 550 W or lower / 3.0 A 230 V: 400 W or lower / 2.5 A
cassette Transparency, Label, Postcard, Envelope Average power at standby 100 V: 23 Wh 100 V: 23 Wh
(For details, see “Paper types / Paper size”.) 120 V: 23 Wh 120 V: 23 Wh
Available paper type for Plain paper, Recycled paper, Color paper, Thick paper, Coated paper, 230 V: 25 Wh 230 V: 23 Wh
multi-purpose tray Transparency, Label, Postcard, Envelope Average power at sleep 100 V: 100 V:
(For details, see “Paper types / Paper size”.) mode 1 Wh (wired) / 2 Wh (wireless) 1 Wh (wired) / 2 Wh (wireless)
Available paper size in A4, B5, A5, LGL, LTR, STMT, EXEC, OFFICIO, B-OFFICIO, M-OFFICIO, 120 V: 120 V:
cassette GLTR, GLGL, FLS, K16, Index card, Postcard, Reply Postcard, 1 Wh (wired) / 2 Wh (wireless) 1 Wh (wired) / 2 Wh (wireless)
Envelopes (COM10, Monarch, Nagagata 3, Yougatanaga 3, C5, DL), 230 V: 230 V:
Custom Paper Size 1 Wh (wired) / 2 Wh (wireless) 1 Wh (wired) / 2 Wh (wireless)
(For details, see “Paper types / Paper size”.) Power consumption at 0.5 W or lower
Multi-purpose Tray / Multi- A4, B5, A5, LGL, LTR, STMT, EXEC, OFFICIO, B-OFFICIO, M-OFFICIO, Main Power Switch OFF
purpose Tray Pickup Slot GLTR, GLGL, FLS, K16, Index card, Postcard, Reply Postcard, Ozone emission Color: 3.0 mg/hr
paper size Envelopes (COM10, Monarch, Nagagata 3, Yougatanaga 3, C5, DL), B&W: 1.5 mg/hr
Custom Paper Size Footprint ADF model: ADF model:
(For details, see “Paper types / Paper size”.) 434 x 484 x 478.5 mm 430 x 484 x 428.5 mm
Cassette capacity Cassette: Cassette: ADF model (with the optional Copyboard model:
250 sheets (60 to 90 g/m2) 150 sheets (60 to 90 g/m2) cassette): 430 x 484 x 375 mm
Option: 434 x 484 x 578.5 mm
250 sheets (60 to 90 g/m2) Weight Device (including toner cartridges): ADF model (including toner
Multi-purpose tray 50 sheets (60 to 90 g/m2) 1 sheet Approx. 31 kg cartridges):
capacity Optional cassette: Approx. 26 kg
Delivery tray stacking 125 sheets (60 to 90 g/m2) Approx. 4 kg Copyboard model (including toner
capacity *2 cartridges):
Continuous copying 1 - 99 sheets Approx. 24 kg
Automatic 2-sided Available (A4, B5, LGL, LTR, N/A Accessories: See the configuration of options
EXEC) *1: Temperature: 20 degC, Humidity: 65%, from when the machine is turned on to when the
T-1-5
Memory capacity 256MB 128MB
standby screen is displayed.
Sleep mode Available
*2: The actual stack capacity varies depending on the site environment and the type of paper
Allowable environmental 10 - 30 deg C
temperature used.
Allowable humidity 20 - 80% in relative humidity (no condensation)
Operational noise At stand-by: At stand-by:
• 43 dB or lower (acoustic power • 43 dB or lower (acoustic power
level) level)
During copy jobs: During copy jobs:
• Color: 67 dB or lower • Color: 65.2 dB or lower
• B&W: 66 dB or lower • B&W: 63.9 dB or lower
Power rating Rated input voltage : 100-127 V (100V system) / 220-240 V (200V
system)
Rated input frequency: 50/60 Hz

1-6
1
Product Overview > Specifications > Main Unit Specifications
1 Product Overview > Specifications > Wireless LAN Specifications
1-7
ADF Specifications Wireless LAN Specifications
Item Specification / Function Item Specification / Function
MF8500 Series MF8200 Series Standard IEEE802.11g/IEEE802.11b/IEEE 802.11n*
Document setting Set the document face up (face-up method) Transmission Scheme DS-SS System/OFDM System
direction Frequency Range 2412 to 2472 MHz
Document setting position Center reference Data Transmission Rate • IEEE802.11g
Document processing 1-sided document -> 1-sided 1-sided document -> 1-sided copy 6/9/12/18/24/36/48/54 Mbps
mode copy/2-sided copy • IEEE802.11b
2-sided document -> 1-sided 1/2/5.5/11 Mbps
copy/2-sided copy • IEEE 802.11n
Document scanning Continuous reading - SGI Invalidated 20 MHz : 6.5/13/19.5/26/39/52/58.5/65 Mbps
Loadable sheets A4/LTR 50 sheets (80g/m2) LGL 30 sheets (80g/m2) - SGI Validated 20 MHz : 7.2/14.4/21.7/28.9/43.3/57.8/72.2 Mbps
Mixed paper reading Copyboard Glass: 216 mm x 297 mm - SGI Invalidated 40 MHz : 13.5/27/40.5/81/108/121.5/135 Mbps
Feeder: 216 x 356 mm - SGI Validated 40 MHz : 15/30/45/60/90/120/150 Mbps
Mixed paper Available Communication Mode Infrastructure Mode
Document AE sensor N/A Security WEP, WPA-PSK (TKIP/AES-CCMP), WPA2-PSK (TKIP/AES-CCMP)
Document size sensor N/A * WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup), Connection can be established by manually setting values.
T-1-7

Stamp function N/A


Allowable environment Same as device
T-1-6

1-7
1
Product Overview > Specifications > Wireless LAN Specifications
1 Product Overview > Specifications > FAX Specifications
1-8
SEND Specifications FAX Specifications
Item Specification / Function Item Specification/function
File Server Transmission E-mail Sending Suitable line Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN)
Communication Protocol SMB (TCP/IP) SMTP* Up to 33.6Kbps in modem speed is currently available in PSTN. Note
Data Format PDF (Compact), PDF, JPEG, TIFF PDF (Compact), PDF that available modem speed is telephone-line dependent.
System Environment • Windows XP / Vista / 7 / Server • Windows XP / Vista / 7 / Server Telephone line connection: 1
2003 / Server 2008 2003 / Server 2008 Communication Protocol Super G3, G3
• Solaris Version 2.6 or later • Solaris Version 2.6 or later Modulation method Image modulation: V.34/V.17/V.29/V.27ter
• Mac OS X (Mac OS X 10.7 and • Mac OS X Transmission procedure: V.21
10.8 are not supported.) • Red Hat Linux 7.2 or later Transmission speed 33,600 bps
• Red Hat Linux 7.2 or later Coding Compression method: JBIG, MMR, MR, MH
Interface 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T Error correction ECM
Inputted Image Text, Text/Photo, Photo Minimum receivable input V.17, V.27ter, V.29: -6 to -43 dBm
Color Mode Color, Black/White level V.34:24.0 k to 28.8 k bps: -43 dBm
Paper Size A4, A5, B5 28.8 k to 33.6 k bps: -38 dBm
33.6 k bps: -9 dBm
* POP3 is available to use only when authenticating before sending. T-1-8
Modem IC SiliconLabs Si2435
Scanning line density Normal:8 dots/mm x 3.85 lines/mm
Fine:8 dots/mm x 7.7 lines/m,km
Super fine:8 dots/mm x 15.4 lines/mm
Ultra fine:16 dots/mm x 15.4 lines/mm
Half tone 256 tones
Reproduction resolution 600 x 600 dpi
Receivable reduction Automatic reduction: 75-100% (1% increment)
setting
FAX/TEL switching Available
Answering machine Available
transfer setting
Remote reception Available
Auto-dialing Available
Delayed transmission N/A
Broadcast transmission MF8500 Series/MF8200 Series
• Destinations: up to 210
Dual access Up to 10 schedules
Image data backup Available
T-1-9

1-8
1
Product Overview > Specifications > FAX Specifications
1 Product Overview > Specifications > Print Speed > MF8200 Series
1-9
Print Speed ■■MF8200 Series
Unit: page/minute.
■■MF8500 Series
Paper type Cassette
Unit: page/minute. Color Mode B&W Mode
Paper type Cassette MP Tray Plain 1 (60 to 74g/m2) A4 14.0 14.0
1-sided 2-sided 1-sided 2-sided Plain 2 (70 to 84g/m2) LTR 14.0 14.0
Plain 3 (75 to 90g/m2) LGL 11.5 11.5
Plain 1 (60 to 74g/m2) A4 20.0 9.9 16.0 9.1
Plain 2 (70 to 84g/m2) LTR 21.0 10.2 16.0 9.2 Recycled (60 to 74g/m2) A4 14.0 14.0
Plain 3 (75 to 90g/m2) LGL 17.1 9.2 14.1 8.4 Color (70 to 84g/m2) LTR 14.0 14.0
Recycled (60 to 74g/m2) A4 20.0 9.9 16.0 9.1 LGL 11.5 11.5
Color (60 to 74g/m2) LTR 21.0 10.2 16.0 9.2 Thick 1 (85 to 120g/m2) A4 6.0 6.0
LGL 17.1 9.2 14.1 8.4 Thick 2 (121 to 163g/m2) LTR 6.0 6.0
Thick 1 (86 to 119g/m2) A4 20.0 9.9 16.0 9.1 LGL 5.0 5.0
LTR 21.0 10.2 16.0 9.2 Coated 1 (100 to 110g/m2) A4 6.0 6.0
Coated 2 (120 to 130g/m2) LTR 6.0 6.0
LGL 17.1 9.2 14.1 8.4
Coated 3 (155 to 165g/m2) LGL 5.0 5.0
Thick 2 (120 to 128g/m2) A4 11.9 8.8 11.9 8.8
LTR 12.2 9.0 12.2 9.0 Transparency 6.0 6.0
LGL 10.8 8.0 10.8 8.0 Label 6.0 6.0
Thick 3 (129 to 163g/m2) A4 9.7 5.0 7.6 4.6 Index card 6.0* 6.0*
LTR 9.7 5.2 7.6 4.6 Envelope 6.0* 6.0*
LGL 8.3 5.0 6.7 4.4 *: By reducing throughput, print speed becomes approximately 2 pages/min. at a minimum.
T-1-11

Coated 1 (100 to 110g/m2) A4 11.9 8.8 11.9 8.8


LTR 12.2 9.0 12.2 9.0
LGL 10.8 8.0 10.8 8.0
Coated 2 (120 to 130g/m2) A4 6.5 3.0 5.0 3.0
Coated 3 (155 to 163g/m2) LTR 6.9 3.0 5.0 3.0
LGL 5.6 3.0 4.4 2.8
Coated 4 (210 to 220g/m2) A4 - - 5.0 -
LTR - - 5.0 -
LGL - - 4.4 -
Transparency 6.5 - 5.0 -
Label 9.7 - 7.6 -
Index card 4.3* - 4.6* -
Envelope 7.6* - 5.4* -
*: By reducing throughput, print speed becomes approximately 2 pages/min. at a minimum.
T-1-10

1-9
1
Product Overview > Specifications > Print Speed > MF8200 Series
1 Product Overview > Specifications > Paper types / Paper size > MF8500 Series
1-10
Paper types / Paper size *1: 100% recycled paper is also usable.
*2: Use transparency sheets for laser printers.
■■MF8500 Series (Canon’s genuine transparency sheets are specially recommended.)
Type Size Feeding Width Pickup position *3: Received documents, report and lists can be printed.
direction direction MP Tray Cassette *4: You can load paper of the following custom paper sizes.
(mm) (mm) Width 3" to 8 1/2" (76.2 to 215.9 mm); Length 5" to 14"(127 to 355.6 mm)
2
Thin paper (60 g/m ) - - - - *5: You can load paper of the following custom paper sizes.
Recycled (60 to 74g/m2)*1 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES Width 4" to 8 1/2" (100 to 215.9 mm); Length 5 7/8" to 14" (148 to 355.6 mm)
Color (60 to 74g/m2) B5 182.0 257.0 YES YES
Plain 1 (60 to 74g/m2) A5 148.0 210.0 YES YES
Plain 2 (70 to 84g/m2) LGL 215.9 355.6 YES YES
Plain 3 (75 to 90g/m2) LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Thick 1 (86 to 119g/m2)
STMT 139.7 215.9 YES YES
Thick 2 (120 to 128g/m2)
EXEC*4 184.1 266.7 YES YES
Thick 3 (129 to 163g/m2)
OFFICIO 317.5 215.9 YES YES
B-OFFICIO 355.0 216.0 YES YES
M-OFFICIO 341.0 216.0 YES YES
GLTR 203.2 266.7 YES YES
GLGL 330.2 203.2 YES YES
FLS 330.2 215.9 YES YES
K16 195.0 270.0 YES YES
Custom Paper Size - YES*5 YES*6
Coated 1 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES
(100 to 110g/m2) LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Coated 2
(120 to 130g/m2)
Coated 3
(155 to 165g/m2)
Coated 4 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES -
(210 to 220g/m2) (100 to 110g/m2) 215.9 279.4 YES -
Transparency*2 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES
LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Label A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES
LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Custom Paper Size - YES*5 YES*6
Index card Postcard*4 100 148 YES YES
Reply Postcard*4 148 200 YES YES
Envelope Envelope COM10 104.7 241.3 YES YES
Envelope Monarch 98.4 190.5 YES -
N3*4 120 235 YES YES
Y3*4 120 235 YES YES
Envelope C5 162 229 YES YES
Envelope DL 110 220 YES YES
Custom Paper Size*4 - YES*5 YES*6
T-1-12

1-10
1
Product Overview > Specifications > Paper types / Paper size > MF8500 Series
1 Product Overview > Specifications > Paper types / Paper size > MF8200 Series
1-11
■■MF8200 Series *1: 100% recycled paper is also usable.
*2: Use transparency sheets for laser printers.
Type Size Feeding Width Pickup position
(Canon’s genuine transparency sheets are specially recommended.)
direction direction MP Tray Cassette
*3: Received documents, report and lists can be printed.
(mm) (mm)
Thin paper (60 g/m2) A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES *4: You can load paper of the following custom paper sizes.
Recycled (60 to 74g/m2)*1 B5 182.0 257.0 YES YES Width 3" to 8 1/2" (76.2 to 215.9 mm); Length 5" to 14"(127 to 355.6 mm)
Color (60 to 74g/m2) A5 148.0 210.0 YES YES *5: You can load paper of the following custom paper sizes.
Plain 1 (60 to 74g/m2) LGL 215.9 355.6 YES YES
Plain 2 (70 to 84g/m2) Width 4" to 8 1/2" (100 to 215.9 mm); Length 5 7/8" to 14" (148 to 355.6 mm)
LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Plain 3 (75 to 90g/m2)
STMT 139.7 215.9 YES YES
Thick 1 (85 to 120g/m2)
EXEC 184.1 266.7 YES YES
Thick 2 (121 to 163g/m2)
OFFICIO 317.5 215.9 YES YES
B-OFFICIO 355.0 216.0 YES YES
M-OFFICIO 341.0 216.0 YES YES
GLTR 203.2 266.7 YES YES
GLGL 330.2 203.2 YES YES
FLS 330.2 215.9 YES YES
K16 195.0 270.0 YES YES
Index card *4 - YES YES
Custom Paper Size - YES*5 YES*5
Coated 1 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES
(100 to 110g/m2) LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Coated 2
(111 to 130g/m2)
Coated 3
(131 to 160g/m2)
Coated 4 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES -
(161 to 220g/m2) LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES -
Transparency*2 A4*3 210.0 297.0 YES YES
Label LTR*3 215.9 279.4 YES YES
Index card Postcard 100 148 YES YES
Reply Postcard 148 200 YES YES
Envelope Envelope COM10 104.7 241.3 YES YES
Envelope Monarch 98.4 190.5 YES YES
N3 120 235 YES YES
Y3 120 235 YES YES
Envelope C5 162 229 YES YES
Envelope DL 110 220 YES YES
Index card *4 - YES YES
Custom Paper Size - YES*5 YES*5
T-1-13

1-11
1
Product Overview > Specifications > Paper types / Paper size > MF8200 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > External View > MF8500 Series
1-12

Name of Parts

External View
■■MF8500 Series
●● Front Side
(1)
(7) 1 Document guide 10 Main power switch
(8) 2 Feeder 11 Vent-hole
(2)
(9) 3 Control panel 12 Speaker
4 Front cover 13 Grip
(3) 5 Multi-purpose tray (MP tray) 14 Paper scanner for document from feeder
(4) (10) 6 Paper cassette 15 Delivery tray
(11) 7 Document feed tray 16 Copyboard glass
8 Extension tray 17 USB memory port
(5)
9 Document delivery tray 18 Manual feed guide
(12)
(6)
(13) (16)
(14) (17)

(15)

(13)

(18)

F-1-7

1-12
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > External View > MF8500 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > External View > MF8500 Series
1-13
●● Rear Side ●● Inside

(1)
(2)
(1) (3)
(6)
(2) (4)
(7)
(8) (9) (5)
(3) (4)(5)

F-1-8 F-1-9

1 USB port 6 Rear cover 1 Y toner cartridge slot


2 LAN port 7 Rating plate 2 M toner cartridge slot
3 Telephone line terminal 8 Vent-hole 3 C toner cartridge slot
4 External telephone terminal 9 Power socket 4 Bk toner cartridge slot
5 Handset terminal 5 Toner cartridge tray

1-13
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > External View > MF8500 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > External View > MF8200 Series
1-14
■■MF8200 Series ●● Rear Side
●● Front Side
(1)
(1) (2)
(7)

(2) (8)
(3)
(9)
(4)
(3) (7)
(13)
(5)
(8)
(4) (6)
(10) (9)
(5)
(6) (12) F-1-11
(16)
1 USB port 6 Power socket
(11) (14) (17) 2 LAN port 7 Rear cover
(19) 3 Handset terminal 8 Vent-hole
4 External telephone terminal 9 Rating plate
(13)
5 Telephone line terminal (unused)
(15)

●● Inside

(1)
(18) (2)
(3)
(4)
F-1-10
(5)
1 Document guide 11 Vent-hole
2 Feeder 12 Speaker
3 Control panel 13 Grip
4 Front cover 14 Scanner for documents from feeder
5 Manual feed slot 15 Delivery tray
6 Cassette 16 Copyboard glass F-1-12
7 Document feed tray 17 USB memory port 1 Y toner cartridge slot
8 Extension tray 18 Manual feed guide 2 M toner cartridge slot
9 Document delivery tray 19 Platen Cover (for MF8210 only) 3 C toner cartridge slot
10 Main power switch 4 Bk toner cartridge slot
5 Toner cartridge tray

1-14
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > External View > MF8200 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Section View > MF8500 Series
1-15
Cross Section View ●● Reader/ADF Unit
[1] [2] [3] [4]
■■MF8500 Series
●● Printer
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]

[8] [7] [6] [5]

F-1-14

1 ADF registration roller


2 ADF separation roller
3 ADF pickup roller
4 ADF unit
5 Reader unit
6 ADF delivery roller
7 ADF separation pad
8 CIS unit

[17] [16] [15] [14] [13] [12] [11] [10] [9] [8] F-1-13
1 Fixing assembly 10 MP tray feed roller
2 Pressure roller 11 Primary transfer pad
3 Fixing film unit 12 ITB unit
4 Delivery roller 13 Cassette pickup roller
5 Toner cartridge 14 Cassette separation roller
6 Laser scanner unit 15 Registration roller
7 Photosensitive drum 16 Secondary transfer external roller
8 MP tray separation pad 17 Duplex feed roller
9 MP tray pickup roller

1-15
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Section View > MF8500 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Section View > MF8200 Series
1-16
■■MF8200 Series ●● Reader/ADF Unit
●● Printer [1] [2] [3] [4]

[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]

[8] [7] [6] [5]

F-1-16

1 ADF registration roller


2 ADF separation roller
3 ADF pickup roller
4 ADF unit
5 Reader unit
6 ADF delivery roller
7 ADF separation pad
8 CIS unit

[14] [13] [12] [11] [10] [9] [8]


F-1-15

1 Pressure roller 8 Manual feed roller


2 Fixing assembly 9 Primary transfer pad
3 Feed roller 10 ITB unit
4 Fixing film unit 11 Cassette separation roller
5 Toner cartridge 12 Cassette pickup roller
6 Laser scanner unit 13 Registration roller
7 Photosensitive drum 14 Secondary transfer external roller

1-16
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Cross Section View > MF8200 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > Control Panel > MF8540 / MF8530 / MF8240 / MF8230 / MF8210 Series
1-17
Control Panel ■■MF8540 / MF8530 / MF8240 / MF8230 / MF8210 Series
■■MF8580 / MF8570 / MF8550 / MF8280 / MF8250 Series ●● Main Control Panel
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11]
●● Main Control Panel
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14]

[26] [25] [24] [23] [22] [21] [20] [19] [18] [17] [16] [15] [14] [13] [12]
F-1-18
[29] [28] [27] [26] [25] [24] [23] [22] [21] [20] [19] [18] [17] [16] [15] 1 [COPY] key 14 [Stop] key
F-1-17 2 [SCAN] key 15 [#] key
1 [COPY] key 16 [Clear] key 3 [USB PRINT] key 16 [Start (Color)] key
2 [FAX] key 17 [Stop] key 4 [Reset] key 17 [Start (B&W)] key
3 [SCAN] key 18 [#] key 5 Numeric keys 18 [*] key
4 [USB PRINT] key 19 [Start (Color)] key 6 [Menu] key 19 [Select Paper/Settings] key
5 [Reset] key 20 [Start (B&W)] key 7 [Report] key 20 [Back] key
6 [Address Book] key 21 [*] key 8 [Status Monitor] key 21 [▲] [▼] [<] [>] [OK] key
7 [Coded Dial] key 22 [Select Paper/Settings] key 9 [Energy Saver] key 22 [Error] indicator
8 Numeric keys 23 [Back] key 10 [ID] key 23 Wi-Fi Lamp (MF8570Cdw/MF8280Cw only)
9 [Menu] key 24 [▲] [▼] [<] [>] [OK] key 11 [Scan > PC1 / Scan > PC2] key 24 [Processing/Data] indicator
10 [Report] key 25 [Error] indicator 12 [Paper Save Copy] key 25 Multi keys (left/right)
11 [Status Monitor] key 26 Wi-Fi Lamp (MF8570Cdw/MF8280Cw only) 13 [Clear] key 26 Display
12 [Energy Saver] key 27 [Processing/Data] indicator
13 [ID] key 28 Multi keys (left/right)
14 [Scan > PC1 / Scan > PC2] key 29 Display
15 [Paper Save Copy] key

1-17
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Control Panel > MF8540 / MF8530 / MF8240 / MF8230 / MF8210 Series
1 Product Overview > Name of Parts > Control Panel > Explanation of the Main Control Panel
1-18
■■Explanation of the Main Control Panel Name Description
(3) [Menu] key Press to specify or register various settings.
[2] [3] [4] [Report] key A report or a list is printed. You can also make settings related to
[1]
printing of a report.
[Status Monitor] key The processing status and usage history of print and fax can be
checked. It is also possible to check the status of this equipment
such as the paper level, toner level, and occurrence of an error.
[Energy Saver] key It is used to enter/cancel sleep mode (energy saving mode). It lights
up in yellow during sleep mode.
[ID] key Press to log in/out of the machine when the machine is managed
by Department ID management.
Numeric keys ([0]-[9] keys) Enter characters and numbers.
[*] key Press to switch the character entry mode. Press to switch between
pulse and tone dialing to send a fax.
[#] key Press to enter symbols.
[Clear] key The entered character or number is cancelled.
(4) [Scan > PC1] key Press to send your scans to the computer registered in each key.
[Scan > PC2] key
[Paper Save Copy] key* Press to make copies with the preset modes to reduce paper
consumption.
[7] [6] [5] (5) [Start (B&W)] key The original is read in black and white. If this key is pressed when
making a copy or printing an image in a USB memory device
F-1-19
(memory media print), it is printed in black and white.
Name Description [Start (Color)] key The original is read in color. If this key is pressed when making a
(1) Mode switch keys Press to switch the mode to copy, fax (MF8580 / MF8570 / MF8550 copy or printing an image in a USB memory device (memory media
/ MF8280 / MF8250 only), scan or USB direct print. print), it is printed in color.
(2) [Address Book] key* Addresses registered in the address book are called up. It is also [Stop] key Press to cancel jobs.
used when registering/editing an address in the address book. (6) [Processing/Data] indicator Blinks during transmission and lights up when the machine has
[Reset] key The setting is cancelled and changed back to the original state. waiting jobs.
[Coded Dial] key* This is pressed when using coded dial. Press this key and then Wi-Fi Lamp* It lights up during wireless LAN connection.
enter a 3-digit number to call up the address registered under the [Error] indicator It blinks or lights when an error has occurred.
number. (7) Display Displays messages and operation status. Displays items, texts, and
[▲] key Press to scroll up or to increase the value. numbers when you are specifying settings.
[▼] key Press to scroll down or to decrease the value. T-1-14
[<] key Press to return to the previous screen or move the cursor to the left.
Press to decrease the sound volume of fax communications. * MF8580 / MF8570 / MF8550 / MF8280 / MF8250 only
[>] key Press to proceed to the next screen or move the cursor to the right.
Press to increase the sound volume of fax communications.
[OK] key Confirms specified or registered settings.
[Back] key The screen goes back to the screen one layer before. When this
key is pressed while making a setting, the screen goes back to the
previous screen without applying the setting.
[Select Paper/Settings] key Select the pickup assembly containing the paper to be used for
printing.
This is used also when specifying the size and type of the paper set
in the pickup assembly.

1-18
1
Product Overview > Name of Parts > Control Panel > Explanation of the Main Control Panel
2 Technical Overview

■Basic

Configuration
■Document Exposure/Feeder System

■Controller System

■Laser Control System

■Image Formation System

■Fixing System

■Pickup / Feed System

2
Technical Overview
2 Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Basic Sequence > Basic Operational Sequence
2-2

Basic Configuration Basic Sequence


■■Basic Operational Sequence
Configuration function
The CPU on the DC controller PCB controls the operational sequence. The table below
This device is roughly composed of the 6 functional blocks as shown in the figure below shows the operation and the purposes in each status from start-up of the device and to last
• Document exposure/delivery system rotation after print job completion.
• Controller system Status Operation
• Laser exposure system WAIT Interval from power-ON or Activate the printer to be ready for printing. During WAIT
• Image formation system (Wait) reactivation from sleep mode time, the following operations are done: pressure is
upon shutting the door(s) applied to the pressure roller of the fixing assembly; check
• Fixing system
to entering the print-ready cartridges and units being in place; move the developing
• Pickup / Feed System status unit to the home position; and, clean the ITB. When
needed, color displacement is corrected and the image is
Document Exposure/ stabilized.
ADF Feeding System STBY Interval from the wait time or Maintain the print-ready status. The printer enters the sleep
(STBY) the last rotation to issuance mode upon receiving a “sleep” command from the main
PC of a print command from the controller during the stand-by status. The printer executes
CIS Unit main controller or power- color displacement correction or image stabilization
OFF. upon receiving corresponding commands from the main
controller.
INTR Interval from issuance of To make the printer ready for print jobs, activate high-
Delivery
Assembly (IINTR) a print command from the voltage bias PCBs, the laser scanner unit and the fixing
Main main controller during the assembly.
Controller
Laser Exposure System stand-by status to warming
up the fixing assembly to the
Fixing System Laser Scanner target temperature.
DC Fixing PRINT Interval from the initial Based on the video signals input from the main controller,
Controller Assembly Image
(Print) rotation to completion of last form the static latent image on the photosensitive drum to
Formation
System Drum Drum Drum Drum page fixation. transfer and fix the toner image on paper. When a certain
pages are printed after power-ON, the device undergoes
Secondary ITB Unit
Transfer
color displacement correction and/or image stabilization.
Controller System LSTR Interval from print job The last page of the print job is completely delivered. In this
Pickup Manual Feed (Last completion to motor status, the laser scanner unit and high-voltage bias PCBs
Unit Pickup Unit rotation) deactivation. are inactive. The printer starts the initial rotation upon
Laser beam
receiving a print command from the main controller during
Paper flow Cassette
Pickup/feed System this status.
Signal flow
T-2-1
F-2-1

2-2
2
Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Basic Sequence > Basic Operational Sequence
2 Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Basic Sequence > Print Sequence
2-3
■■Print Sequence
●● MF8500 Series
Full-color print on A4 plain paper (3 pages)
Print command
(second)
Operatio n STBY INTR PRNT LSTR STBY

1 Fixing temperature control

1. 0
2 Drum motor (M1)

1. 2
3 Developing motor (M2)

0. 7
4 Pickup motor (M3)

0. 2
5 Fixing motor (M4)

6 Scanner motor (M7)

4. 5
7 Cassette pickup solenoid (SL2)

8 Development contact solenoid


4. 0
(SL3)
5. 2
9 Registration sensor (SR4)

11.5
10 Fixing / delivery sensor (SR5)

4. 5
11 Vertical sync signal (/TOP)

1. 7
12 Primary charging bias

3. 6
13 Development bias (Y, M, C)

3. 6
14 Development bias (Bk)

2. 5 2. 2
15 Primary transfer bias (Y)

2. 9
16 Primary transfer bias (M, C)

2. 0 4. 7
17 Primary transfer bias (Bk)

1. 0 9 .2
18 Secondary transfer bias

19 ATVC Print bias Sheet-to-sheet bias

20

F-2-2

2-3
2
Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Basic Sequence > Print Sequence
2 Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Basic Sequence > Print Sequence
2-4
●● MF8200 Series
Full-color print on A4 plain paper (3 pages)
Print command
(second)
Operation STBY INTR PRNT LSTR STBY

1 Fixing temperature control

2 Main motor (M701)

3.5
3 Pickup motor (M702)

3.9
4 Fixing motor (M703)

2.0
5 Scanner motor (M704)

6.1
6 Cassette pickup solenoid (SL705)

7 Development contact solenoid


4.4
(SL706)
7.6
8 Paper leading edge sensor (SR602)

21.2
9 Fixing/delivery sensor (SR609)

6.1
10 Vertical sync signal (/TOP)
1.6
11 Primary charging bias

4.4
12 Development bias (Y, M, C)

4.4
13 Development bias (Bk)

2.1 4.7
14 Primary transfer bias (Y)

6.1
15 Primary transfer bias (M, C)
0.5 10.5
16 Primary transfer bias (Bk)

3.7 14.7
17 Secondary transfer bias

18 ATVC Print bias Sheet-to-sheet bias

19

20

F-2-3

2-4
2
Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Basic Sequence > Print Sequence
2 Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Print Mode > MF8200 Series
2-5
Print Mode ■■MF8200 Series
The models of this series switch among 3 print modes to optimize the normal print speed
■■MF8500 Series
each for color and B&W printing.
The models of this series switch among 3 print modes to optimize the paper feed speed for
Print mode Paper feed Paper type Print speed Remarks
printing.
speed
Print mode Paper feed Paper type Print speed Remarks B&W normal 3/2 speed Plain paper 1 (60 to 74 g/m2) 12 ppm for B&W
speed speed mode Plain paper 2 (70 to 90 g/m2) printing
Normal speed 1/1 speed Plain paper 1 (60 to 74 g/m2) 20 ppm*6 Common to Recycled paper (60 to 74 g/m2)
mode Plain paper 2 (70 to 84 g/m2) color and B&W Color paper (60 to 74 g/m2)
Plain paper 3 (75 to 90 g/m2) printing Color normal 1/1 speed Plain paper 1 (60 to 74 g/m2) 8 ppm for color
Recycled paper (60 to 74 g/m2) speed mode Plain paper 2 (70 to 90 g/m2) printing
Color paper (60 to 74 g/m2) Recycled paper (60 to 74 g/m2)
Thick paper 1 (86 to 119 g/m2)*1 Color paper (60 to 74 g/m2)
Thick paper 2 (120 to 128 g/m2)*2 3/4 speed 3/4 speed Thick paper 1 to 3 (91 to 163 g/m2) 6 ppm Common to
Coated paper 1 (100 to 110 g/m2)*4 mode Coated paper 1 to 4 (100 to 220 g/m2) color and B&W
1/2 speed 1/2 speed Thick paper 1 (91 to128 g/m2)*1 9.7 ppm*6 Transparency printing
mode Thick paper 2 (120 to 128 g/m2)*2 Labels
Thick paper 3 (129 to163 g/m2)*3 Envelopes
Coated paper 1 (100 to 110 g/m2)*4 Postcards
Postcards*5 T-2-3

1/3 speed 1/3 speed Thick paper 3 (129 to 163 g/m2)*2 7.6 ppm*6
mode Coated paper 2 (120 to 130 g/m2)
Coated paper 3 (155 to 165 g/m2)
Coated paper 4 (210 to 220 g/m2)
Transparency
Labels
Postcards*5
Envelopes
*1: For Thick Paper 1 (86 to 119 g/m2), switched to normal mode when environment T-2-2

temperature is 20 deg C and above, and switched to 1/2 speed mode when the
temperature is lower than 20 deg C.
*2: For Thick Paper 2 (120 to 128 g/m2), switched to normal mode when environment
temperature is 20 deg C and above, and switched to 1/2 speed mode when the
temperature is lower than 20 deg C.
*3: For Ticick Paper 3 (129 to 163 g/m2), switched to 1/2 speed mode when environment
temperature is 20 deg C and above, and switched to 1/3 speed mode when the
temperature is lower than 20 deg C.
*4: For Coated paper 1 (100 to 110 g/m2), switched to normal mode when environment
temperature is 20 deg C and above, and switched to 1/2 speed mode when the
temperature is lower than 20 deg C.
*5: For Postcard, switched to 1/2 speed mode when environment temperature is 20 deg C
and above, and switched to 1/3 speed mode when the temperature is lower than 20 deg C.
*6: The fastest print speed in each mode.

2-5
2
Technical Overview > Basic Configuration > Print Mode > MF8200 Series
2 Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Document Exposure System > Major Components
2-6

Document Exposure/Feeder System ■■Major Components


Followings are the major components for Document Exposure System.
Document Exposure System • The contact sensor to scan document.
• The Reader motor (M720), The drive pulley, The drive belt, to shift The contact sensor
■■Overview In image scanning control, the contact sensor is shifted by rotating the Reader motor based
on the drive signal from the Main Controller PCB and scan the original on the copyboard
Specifications / Control / Function List
glass. When ADF is in use, image is scanned by feeding the originals by ADF instead of
Item Function / Method
shifting the contact sensor.
Document Exposure LED
Document Scan Book Mode:
• Scan by the shift of the contact sensor (CIS)
Drive Belt
ADF:
• Document stream reading by fixed contact sensor (CIS) Drive Pulley
Scanning Resolution [CL]
600 dpi (horizontal scanning) x 600 dpi (vertical scanning)
300 dpi (horizontal scanning) x 600 dpi (vertical scanning)
300 dpi (horizontal scanning) x 300 dpi (vertical scanning) Reader Motor
[BK] (M720)
600 dpi (horizontal scanning) x 600 dpi (vertical scanning)
300 dpi (horizontal scanning) x 600 dpi (vertical scanning)
Number of Gradations 256 Gradations
Magnification 25% to 400%
Horizontal scanning direction: Image processing by the Main Controller
PCB
Vertical scanning direction: The speed at which the carriage moves and
image processing by the Main Controller PCB
Lens CIS/Color
CIS Number of lines: 1 line
Number of pixels: 5184 pixels as total pixels (5107 pixels as effective
pixels) Drive Pulley Contact Image Sensor (CIS)
Maximum document scanning width: 216mm F-2-4
CIS Drive Control Drive Control by Reader Motor (M720)
Document Size None
Detection
Dirt Sensor Detection Yes
T-2-4

2-6
2
Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Document Exposure System > Major Components
2 Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Document Exposure System > Reference Position for Reading/Printing
2-7
■■Reference Position for Reading/Printing ●● Reference Position for Printing
Only when the original is read from ADF without reduction layout setting (1 on 1), it is printed
The reference position for reading/printing from the copyboard or ADF is explained below.
in center alignment. In other cases, upper left alignment is applied for printing.

●● Reference Position for Reading ADF Copyboard


(center alignment) (upper left alignment)
Upper left alignment is applied when the original is read from the copyboard, and center
alignment is applied when the original is read from the ADF.
In the case where only a part of the document is read due to the scaling setting, the read area 1 in 1

and the output result differ between copyboard reading and ADF reading.

Copyboard
ADF (center alignment)
(upper left alignment)
2 in 1

Set scaling
(original size < recording paper size)

4 in 1
Original Output Original Output

F-2-6
Set scaling (enlargement)

Original Output Original Output

F-2-5

2-7
2
Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Document Exposure System > Reference Position for Reading/Printing
2 Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Document Feeder System > Various Control
2-8
Document Feeder System ■■Various Control
■■Overview ●● Original Detection
There are two types of Original Detection in this Equipment.
Pickup/Feed/Delivery Operation
The Auto Document Feeder (ADF) mounted onto this host machine is dedicated to stream-
1. Original Presence / Absence Detection
reading.
Setting the original onto the original tray pushes up the actuator, activating (light shielded
1 Motor (ADF Motor: M721) is engaged in Pickup/Feeding/Delivery.
=>light transmitted) the Document Sensor (SR703), and resulting in detection of the presence
At the start of Copy/Fax/Scan, the ADF Motor (M721) is driven by the drive command from
of original.
the Main Controller PCB to Pickup/Feed the originals set face up on the original tray one by
one in order from the top. The original is scanned by the contact sensor when moving through
2. Detection of the End of the Original
the copyboard glass, and then delivered face down to the original Delivery Assembly.
The leading edge of the original that is fed pushes up the actuator, activating the Document
End Sensor (SR702) (light shielded =>light transmitted) and resulting in detection of the reach
of the leading edge of original. Furthermore, when the trailing edge of the original passes
A
7
8
A\ the actuator position, the actuator returns to the original position, inactivating the Document
B M721
9
10
B\ End Sensor (SR702) (light transmitted => light shielded). The trailing edge of the original is
J903 detected by this mechanism.
MCON
The original length that can be scanned with this equipment is less than 400 mm. Passing of
the original longer than this results in jam stop. The original length is calculated by the time it
takes from detection of the leading edge of the original to detection of the trailing edge of the
original.

MEMO:
There is no function to detect the original size (original width, length) in this
equipment.
F-2-7

PS703

PS702

GND

GND
VCC

VCC
DES

DS
J903
1 2 3 4 5 6 F-2-8

MCON
2-8
2
Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Document Feeder System > Various Control
2 Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Service Tasks > Service Notes
2-9
●● Jam Detection Service Tasks
The following cases are judged as jam.
1. In case of delay in reaching DS/DES or stationary during scanning of original ■■Action for Parts Replacement
2. In case DS/DES is detected as ON at power-on (residual paper jam) Outline of the measures is described in this section. For the detailed procedure, refer to the
3. In case of detecting original of which length is 400 mm or longer “Chapter 5 Adjustment”.

• Operation after Detection of Jam


●● After replacing ADF Unit
The host machine stops scanning operation and displays "CHECK DOCUMENT" on the
1) Execute the white level adjustment.
control panel. No jam code is displayed.
2) Execute the reading position adjustment.
In case of the model equipped with fax function (with built-in speaker), the warning beep
3) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading.
occurs at the detection of jam.

• How to release Jam.


●● Reader Unit
1) Enter the setting value of the Standard White Plate.
Remove the jammed paper and open / close the ADF upper cover
2) Execute the color/B&W AGC adjustment.
3) Execute the reading position adjustment.
4) Execute the white level adjustment.
5) Enter the value on the label packed with the part in the service mode item.
6) Execute the image reading adjustment at ADF reading.

●● Reader Unit Upper Cover (Copyboard Glass)


1) Enter the value on the label affixed on the glass in the service mode item.
2) Execute the reading position adjustment.
3) Execute the white level adjustment.

●● CIS Unit
1) Execute the color/B&W AGC adjustment.
2) Execute the auto detection of the reading position at DF stream reading.
3) Execute the white level adjustment.
4) Execute the image reading position adjustment.
5) Execute the image reading adjustment at ADF reading.

■■Maintenance
No periodically replaced parts, durable parts or periodical service is set for this product.

■■Service Notes
None

2-9
2
Technical Overview > Document Exposure/Feeder System > Service Tasks > Service Notes
2 Technical Overview > Controller System > Overview
2-10

Controller System • MF8200 Series

Overview
This product is mainly controlled by the main and DC controllers.

• MF8500 Series
Reader Unit
Wireless LAN PCB
Network

Main Controller PCB


Telephone Line
Wireless LAN PCB
Reader Unit
DC Controller PCB
DC Controller PCB
Network FAX-NCU PCB

Relay PCB
Telephone Line

Off Hook PCB


Off Hook PCB

Driver PCB Low Voltage


FAX-NCU PCB Main Controller
Power Supply PCB
PCB
F-2-10

Parts name Role


Main Controller PCB Provides controls on the system, image processing, reader / ADF,
Driver PCB FAX and network and maintain various setting values.
DC Controller PCB Provides controls on printer, laser, high-voltage PCBs, I/O, etc.
and maintain setting values.
T-2-6
Low Voltage Sub PCB

Low Voltage Main PCB


F-2-9

Parts name Role


Main Controller PCB Provides controls on the system, image processing, reader / ADF,
FAX and network and maintain various setting values.
DC Controller PCB Provides controls on printer, laser, high-voltage PCBs, I/O, etc.
and maintain setting values.
T-2-5

2-10
2
Technical Overview > Controller System > Overview
2 Technical Overview > Controller System > Controls > Open door detection
2-11
Controls ■■Open door detection
This product detects door opening by the door open sensor.
■■Motor Controls
Sensor Name Function
This product uses 3 motors for paper feed and image formation. Front Cover Sensor (SR612) Detect open the Front Cover.
The tables below show motor specifications used in this product. Rear Cover Sensor (SR613) Detect open the Rear Cover.
T-2-9

• MF8500 Series When this sensor detects door opening, the DC controller stops driving motors and solenoids.
Failure
Name Driven parts Type
detection
Drum Motor M1 Photosensitive drum, developing DC Motor Available
cylinder, ITB
Registration Motor M3 Registration Roller Stepping Motor Not Available
Developing Motor M2 Developing Cylinder DC Motor Available
Fixing Motor M4 Pressure Roller, Delivery Roller, Diplex Stepping Motor Not Available
Feed Roller
Pickup Motor M5 Pickup Roller, Multi Manual feed Roller, Stepping Motor Not Available
Multi Purpose Tray Pickup Roller
T-2-7

• MF8200 Series
Failure
Name Driving parts Type
detection
Drum Motor M701 Photosensitive Drum, Developing DC Motor Available
Cylinder, ITB
Pickup Motor M702 Pickup Roller, Feed Roller, Registration Stepping Motor Not Available
Roller
Fixing Motor M703 Pressure Roller, Delivery Roller Stepping Motor Not Available
T-2-8

2-11
2
Technical Overview > Controller System > Controls > Open door detection
2 Technical Overview > Controller System > Controls > Low-Voltage Power Supply Control
2-12
■■Low-Voltage Power Supply Control • MF8200 Series

This circuit converts AC voltage input from the power supply receptacle through the fixing AC input
power supply into DC power supply and supplies it to each load.
See the figures below for low-voltage / fixing power supply block diagrams. DC
Fuse Fixing Power Supply
• Low-voltage power supply: generates DC power supply required in the printer. Controller PCB
FU201
• Fixing power supply: supplies AC power supply to the low-voltage power supply and control Noise
Filter Fixing
Control
the fixing heater temperatures. Circuit

The low-voltage power supply is actuated when the AC power supply is attached to the inlet
Low-voltage Power Supply
and the power switch is turned on. The AC power supply supplied through the fixing power Fuse Fuse (non-all night)
FU101 FU102
supply is converted to + 24V and + 3.3V of the DC power supply in the low-voltage power
supply before supplied to the printer engine. Noise Filter
• MF8500 Series
Rectifying Low-voltage Power
Circuit Supply (all night)
AC input 24V DCON
+24V 24V REM
Generation
Circuit 3.3V DCON
Fuse Fixing Power Supply
FU1201 Protection
Fixing Circuit Power Switch DCON_ON Main
Control Control Circuit Controller PCB
Noise Filter Circuit
Power 24V
Switch +3.3V 24S_ON
SW1 Rectifying
Circuit Generation
Low-voltage Power Circuit
Fuse Fuse Supply (all night) DC 3.3V
FU1101 FU1102 Controller PCB
Protection
Circuit
Noise Filter
Frequency Power Supply Assembly
ZEROX
Detecting
Circuit
24V DCON
Power Switch
Rectifying 24V REM SW1,SW1001
Circuit 3.3V DCON
+24V F-2-12
Generation SW1001 : Product supporting automatic shutdown (MF8230)
Circuit 24V
24S_ON
Protection
Circuit
DCON_ON Main
+3.3V Controller PCB
Generation
Circuit 3.3V

F-2-11

2-12
2
Technical Overview > Controller System > Controls > Low-Voltage Power Supply Control
2 Technical Overview > Controller System > Controls > Power-Saving Mode
2-13
■■Protective control ■■Power-Saving Mode
The low-voltage power supply has protective controls against excessive current and voltage, This is the function to save power consumed by the printer.
which automatically detect excessive current or abnormal voltage to shut off the output The table below lists various power-saving modes.
voltage for avoiding the power supply circuit failures. Power-Saving Mode Status
In case the DC voltage output is not detected from the low-voltage power supply, the Stand-by at power-OFF on the reader
protective control may be activated. Turn off the power switch and remove the AC power Power-saving at power-OFF on the reader and the display (LCD)
supply from the inlet to settle load troubles. Once these are settled, turn on the power switch Sleep Sleep 1 at power-OFF on the reader, engine and the display (LCD)
again. Sleep 2 at power-OFF on the reader and the engine.
Sleep 3 (3W at power-off on the reader, the engine and the display (LCD)
Another protective control is provided by 2 power fuses on the fixing power supply. These
sleep) The main controller enters the power-saving mode.
are open when excessive current is detected to shut off power supply to low-voltage power Automatic shutdown* The Main Power Switch is turned OFF when a specified period of
supply. time has passed (default: 4 hours)
after the machine has entered sleep mode (excluding sleep 2).
*: In the case of a model without fax for EUR (MF8540/MF8230) T-2-10

Explanation
Service error of the status
Power-off The automatic shutdown time has passed.
Power-on

Power-saving
Power-on
Power-off
Service call

depending on the conditions


Standby
Sleep 1B Sleep 3

Automatically shifted
Non-all-night
24V OFF
The energy saver key is pressed.
Control Panel Automatically shifted
The auto sleep time has passed. depending on the conditions

Reader
Sleep 1A
Energy saver The auto sleep
The energy saver time has passed.
Engine
key is pressed. ↓A job is Non-all-night
The energy saver generated 24V ON
Controller key is pressed. /completed.↑
Hook detection
* The reader is turned ON
The energy saver key is pressed.
only when it is used. Hook detection
The auto sleep time has passed.

Sleep 2
←A job is generated/completed.→

No service error (no error requiring a service visit) has occurred.

F-2-13

2-13
2
Technical Overview > Controller System > Controls > Power-Saving Mode
2 Technical Overview > Controller System > Service Tasks > Service Notes
2-14
Service Tasks ●● DC controller PCB
Before replacing the DC Controller PCB
■■Action for Parts Replacement 1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to store the DC Controller setting values.
Outline of the measures is described in this section. For the detailed procedure, refer to the COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN
“Chapter 5 Adjustment”.
After replacing the DC Controller PCB
1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to restore the DC Controller setting
●● Main Controller PCB
values.
Before replacing Main Controller PCB
COPIER > FUINCTION > VIFFNC > RSTR-DCN
Back up user data (settings / registered data, etc.) and Service mode data for setting /
2) Turn OFF/ON the power.
registration after replacing PCBs. Take notes of data unable to back up.
3) Execute the print color displacement correction and the quick correction.
1) In Remote UI, export the user data.
4) Turn OFF/ON the power.
2) In service mode, export the service mode data.
3) Record the default settings shown on the service label.
4) Write down the machine's serial number and the data of Settings/Registration > System
Settings > Device Information> Location. ■■Maintenance
After replacing Main Controller PCB No periodically replaced parts, durable parts or periodical service is set for this product.

1) Setting of destination / paper size groups.


2) Clearing setting / registered data.
3) Adjustment and input of default values. ■■Service Notes
4) Migrating the serial number None
5) In Remote UI, import the user data.
6) In service mode, import the service mode data.
7) Reinstall the drivers.

In the case of a model without fax for EUR (MF8540/MF8230), perform the following works.

8. Setting of automatic shutdown menu display


9. Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
10. Checking the setting of Auto Sleep Time

2-14
2
Technical Overview > Controller System > Service Tasks > Service Notes
2 Technical Overview > Laser Control System > Controls > Failure detection
2-15

Laser Control System Controls


■■Failure detection
Overview
1. Scanner Motor failures
The Laser Scanner system is to form a static latent image on the photosensitive drum based • The rotation does not reach the pre-defined value after a certain time elapsed from the
on the video signal sent from the Main Controller. Scanner Motor actuated.
The Laser Scanner Unit is composed of the laser driver, the Scanner Motor Unit and other • The rotation failed to meet the tolerable range consecutively within a certain time during the
components, which are controlled based on signals input by the DC Controller. Scanner Motor in drive.
The figure below shows the Laser Scanner Unit schematically. Error Code: E110-0000

Laser Driver 2. BD failures


Scanning Mirror
• When out-of-range BD cycle is detected during printing.
Scanning Motor
BD Sensor

Photosensitive Drum
(Y)
Photosensitive Drum
(M)
Photosensitive Drum
SPEED CONTROL signal

LASER CONTROL signal

(C)
Photosensitive Drum
SCANNER MOTOR

(K)
VIDEO signal
BD signal

DC Controller

Main Controller

F-2-14

2-15
2
Technical Overview > Laser Control System > Controls > Failure detection
2 Technical Overview > Laser Control System > Service Tasks > Service Notes
2-16
Service Tasks
■■Action for Parts Replacement
Outline of the measures is described in this section. For the detailed procedure, refer to the
“Chapter 5 Adjustment”.

●● After replacing Laser Scanner Unit


1) Register the value on the label packed with the Laser Scanner Unit in service mode.
2) After the registration, affix the label packed with the unit on the inside of the Right Cover.

■■Maintenance
No periodically replaced parts, durable parts or periodical service is set for this product.

■■Service Notes
●● Point to note when replacing the laser scanner unit
Do not disassemble the laser scanner unit in the field because it has been adjusted in the
factory.
Otherwise, it may cause image fault such as color displacement. (you need to replace the
laser scanner unit in that case.)

2-16
2
Technical Overview > Laser Control System > Service Tasks > Service Notes
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Parts > MF8200 series
2-17

Image Formation System Parts


■■MF8500 series
Overview
ITB Cleaning Roller Developing Cylinder Toner Cartridge
The image formation system holds the core function of this product to form toner images on
paper. ITB Cleaning Brush
To form toner images, the DC controller controls various high-voltage power supply PCBs. Photosensitive
Drum
This product is a compact and high-speed color printing device that employs the 4-drum and Y M C Bk
intermediate transfer method.
The image formation system is composed of the following components. Secondary Transfer
Internal Roller
• 4 cartridges
• ITB unit
• Secondary transfer external roller Color Displacement
Secondary Transfer ITB Unit Primary /Density Sensor
External Roller Transfer Pad
The figure below shows the image formation system schematically.
F-2-16

■■MF8200 series
ITB cleaning roller Developing cylinder Toner cartridge

Photosensitive
drum
Fixing ITB cleaning brush Y M C Bk
unit
Laser scanner
Secondary transfer
internal roller
Laser beam
Cartridge
ITB cleaning unit Photosensitive drum
Secondary transfer ITB unit Primary Color
external roller transfer pad displacement/density
ITB sensor

Secondary transfer F-2-17


external roller Primary transfer pad
High-voltage power supply

DC controller

F-2-15

2-17
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Parts > MF8200 series
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Static latent image forming block
2-18
Image Forming Process ■■Static latent image forming block
This block consists of 2 steps to form a static latent image on the photosensitive drum.
■■Overview
The image forming process of this product is composed roughly of 6 blocks and 9 steps.
●● Step 1: Primary charging
Block Step Description Before forming a static latent image, the photosensitive drum surface should be charged
1 Primary charging Charge the photosensitive drum surface
negatively.
Static latent image forming negatively.
block 2 Laser beam exposure Form a static latent image on the This product employs the method to charge the photosensitive drum directly from the primary
photosensitive drum. charging roller, applying the DC negative bias in order to negatively charge the photosensitive
3 Development Deposit toner to visualize the static latent drum surface.
Development block
image.
4 Primary transfer Transfer the toner image on the Primary charging roller
photosensitive drum to the ITB.
Transfer block 5 Secondary transfer Transfer the toner image on the ITB to the
paper.
6 Separation Separate the paper from the ITB.
Fixing block 7 Fixing Fix the toner image on the paper.
ITB cleaning block 8 ITB cleaning Clean the residual toner on the ITB.
Drum cleaning block 9 Drum cleaning Clean the residual toner on the
photosensitive drum. DC bias
T-2-11
Photosensitive drum
Delivery
Flow of paper
Rotation of ITB/photosensitive drum
Fixing block

Static image formation block Block


7. Fixing F-2-19
Step
2. Laser beam exposure

Development 1. Primary charging


6. Separation block
3. Development
Drum cleaning block
ITB cleaning 9. Drum cleaning
block
8. ITB cleaning
4. Primary transfer

5. Secondary transfer

Transfer block

Registration

Pickup

F-2-18

2-18
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Static latent image forming block
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Development block
2-19
●● Step 2: Laser beam exposure ■■Development block
Expose the photosensitive drum with laser beams to form a static latent image.
The static latent image formed on the photosensitive drum is visualized by toner deposited in
The static latent image is formed by laser beam scanning that neutralizes or strips negative
this block.
potentials on the scanned parts.

Laser beam ●● Step 3: Development


Toner is deposited on the static latent image formed on the photosensitive drum.
Toner is then charged negatively through friction between the developing cylinder and the
developing blade surface. The DC bias is applied to the developing cylinder to generate
potential difference from the photosensitive drum. When the negatively charged toner
contacts the photosensitive drum, it is deposited on the static latent image due to potential
difference between the drum and the developing cylinder.

Developing blade

Unexposed area Exposed area


Developing cylinder

F-2-20
DC negative bias

Exposed area Unexposed area

Unexposed area Exposed area

Photosensitive drum

F-2-21

2-19
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Development block
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Transfer block
2-20
■■Transfer block ●● Step 5: Secondary transfer
Transfer the toner image on the ITB to paper.
The toner image on the photosensitive drum is transferred to paper through 3 steps in this
The DC positive bias is applied to the secondary transfer external roller to charge the paper
block.
positively. By this, the negatively charged toner image on the ITB is transferred to the paper.

●● Step 4: Primary transfer Media


Transfer the toner image on the photosensitive drum to the ITB.
The DC positive bias is applied to the primary transfer pad to charge the ITB positively. By
this, the negatively charged toner on the photosensitive drum is transferred to the ITB. ITB
Static charge eliminator
ITB drive roller
Photosensitive
drum

Secondary
transfer external roller
ITB
DC bias
Primary transfer pad

DC bias
F-2-23

F-2-22
●● Step 6: Separation
Separate the paper from the ITB using paper elasticity and curvature of the ITB drive motor.
To stabilize the paper delivery and image quality, use the static eliminator to decay the
potential on the back of the paper after image transfer.

Media

ITB

ITB drive roller

Secondary
transfer external roller
F-2-24
.

2-20
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Transfer block
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Cleaning block
2-21
■■Fixing block ■■Cleaning block
The toner image is fixed on the paper in this block. The residual toner on the ITB surface is cleaned in this step.

●● Step 7: Fixing ●● Step 8: ITB cleaning


This product employs the on-demand fixing method. The DC positive bias is applied to the ITB cleaning roller and the ITB cleaning brush to charge
By applying pressure and heat on the paper and the toner image on it, the toner is fused to the collected toner positively. The positively charged collected toner is reversely transferred
develop the permanent image. from the ITB to the photosensitive drum by the primary transfer pad.

Positive potential waste toner


Cartridge
Negative potential waste toner

Fixing film
Pressure roller
Photosensitive drum

Partition sheet ITB cleaning roller


Fixing heater
ITB cleaning brush

ITB

Sweeper strip

Toner DC bias DC bias

Media F-2-26

F-2-25

2-21
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Cleaning block
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Cleaning block
2-22
■■Cleaning block
The residual toner on the photosensitive drum is cleaned in this block.

●● Step 9: Drum cleaning


The cleaning blade scrapes off the residual toner on the photosensitive drum to collect into
the cleaner container. Now the photosensitive drum is cleaned.

Cleaning blade

Photosensitive
drum
Waste toner container

Sweeper strip

F-2-27

2-22
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Image Forming Process > Cleaning block
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > High-voltage power supply control
2-23
Controls
■■High-voltage power supply control Primary charging Developing bias Blade bias circuit
bias circuit circuit
●● Overview

BLD1
BLD2
BLD3
BLD4
The high-voltage power supply PCBs are to apply high-voltage bias to the primary charging

DEV1
DEV2
DEV3
DEV4
PRI
roller, the primary transfer pad, the secondary transfer external roller, and the ITB cleaning
unit. Such high-voltage bias is generated through control by the DC controller on the high-
voltage power supply PCBs.
The figure below shows the high-voltage power source schematically.

Type Bias applied Purpose Applied to


Primary charging Charge the photosensitive drum Primary charging roller Cartridge
DC negative
bias surface negatively. (cartridge) Photosensitive drum
Deposit toner on the static latent Primary transfer pad
Developing cylinder
Developing bias DC negative image formed on the photosensitive ICLB
(cartridge)
drum. ICLR
Adjust the charged toner amount on Developing blade
Blade bias DC negative
the developing cylinder. (cartridge) ITB ??
Primary transfer Transfer the toner image on the Developing blade cleaning unit
DC negative
bias photosensitive drum to the ITB. (cartridge)

TR1_23

TR1_23
TR2

TR1_1

TR1_4
Secondary transfer
external roller
Transfer the toner image on the ITB
DC positive
Secondary transfer to the paper. Secondary transfer
bias Clean the secondary transfer external roller
DC negative
external roller.
ITB cleaning brush Charge the toner on the ITB
DC positive ITB cleaning brush ITB cleaning brush ITB cleaning roller Secondary transfer Primary transfer
bias positively. bias circuit bias circuit bias circuit bias circuit
ITB cleaning roller Charge the toner on the ITB
DC positive ITB cleaning roller High-voltage power supply
bias positively.
T-2-12

DC controller

F-2-28

2-23
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > High-voltage power supply control
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Image stabilization control
2-24
■■Image stabilization control ●● Execution timing
The table below lists the execution timing and duration of each control.
●● Overview
Duration Color
This product controls image stabilization to avoid faulty images due to environmental Execution
No. MF8500 MF8200 D-max D-half displacement Remarks
changes, deteriorated photosensitive drum or toner, etc. The controls listed in the table below timing
series series correction
are executed when needed to stabilize image quality. 1 Power-ON Approx.195 Approx.120 ○ ○ ○ Executed at initial
Control Description seconds seconds rotation
D-max control Correct values of the primary charging bias and/or developing bias based 2 Toner cartridge Approx.195 Approx.120 ○ ○ ○ Executed at initial
on signals from the environment sensor. replacement seconds seconds rotation
D-half control Correct the gradation data in the main controller PCB based on signals 3 Environmental Approx.195 Approx.120 ○ ○ ○ Executed after job
from the color displacement / density sensor. changes seconds seconds completion
Color displacement Correct the video signal output timing based on signals from the color Detected by the
correction control displacement / density sensor. environment sensor
Auto-gradation To stabilize the image gradation density characteristics, users execute full 4 After the pre- Approx.195 Approx.120 ○ ○ ○ Executed after job
correction control or quick correction, or copy image correction. defined counts seconds seconds completion
printed
T-2-13
5 After the pre- Approx.195 Approx.120 ○ ○ ○ Executed after job
defined time seconds seconds completion
elapsed
Laser scanner unit 6 Resumed from Approx.100 Approx.60 ○ ○ - Executed after job
sleep (after 8 seconds seconds completion upon
Toner cartridge hours or more) resumed
Color 7 Full correction Approx.100 Approx.60 ○ ○ - Executed by users
displacement/density seconds seconds
sensor
8 Quick correction Approx.100 Approx.60 ○ ○ -
seconds seconds
ITB unit 9 Copy image Approx.100 Approx.60 ○ ○ -
correction seconds seconds
T-2-14
Signal from color
Bias High-voltage displacement/density signal
power supply PCBs
Video signal

Auto-gradation
D-max correction control

Color displacement
Reader unit D-half
correction control

F-2-29

2-24
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Image stabilization control
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Image stabilization control
2-25
●● Image density correction control (D-max control) ●● Color displacement control
This control is to stabilize the print image density. This control is to correct color displacement due to variability of the laser units or toner
The DC controller PCB triggers D-max control under the pre-defined conditions. cartridges.
1. Measure the density detection patterns for each color on the ITB. The following displacements are corrected through this control.
2. To optimize the density of the measured patterns, control the primary charging bias and the • Horizontal scanning start position
developing bias. • Horizontal scanning magnification
• Vertical scanning start position
The image density correction control is triggered under the conditions below. The DC controller PCB controls the color displacement/density sensor and the color
• In the case of Menu > Adjustment/Cleaning > Auto Adjustment Settings > Auto Adjustment displacement sensor under the conditions below.
Image Regularly: OFF (default) • In the case of Menu > Adjustment/Cleaning > Auto Adjustment Settings > Correct Color
1) At power ON (When the environmental change is great compared with the condition Mismatch when turned ON: OFF (default)
before turning OFF the power (more than +/-10 degC)) 1) When completing the first job after power ON
2) When replacing the Toner Cartridge 2) When replacing the Toner Cartridge
3) When the environmental change is great while not getting into the sleep state (more 3) After printing the specified number of sheet (every 150 sheets)
than +/-5 degC) 4) After the specified time has passed
4) After printing the specified number of sheet (every 500 sheets) • MF8200 Series: only twice (100 min, and 300 min)
5) After printing or after 300 min. since the execution of the image density correction • MF8500 Series: 60 min, after that every 240 min
6) At recovery from the sleep state (When the environmental change is great compared 5) When completing the first job after recovering from the 8-hour (or longer) sleep state
with the condition before getting into the sleep state (more than +/-10 degC)) 6) When the user commands execution of the color displacement correction
7) When the user commands execution of the calibration • In the case of Menu > Adjustment/Cleaning > Auto Adjustment Settings > Correct Color
• In the case of Menu > Adjustment/Cleaning > Auto Adjustment Settings > Auto Adjustment Mismatch when turned ON: ON, the operation of (1) and (5) mentioned in the above
Image Regularly: ON, the operation of (1) and (6) mentioned in the above conditions will be conditions will be as follow:
as follow: 1)’ At power ON, execute before executing a job
1)’ Must execute at power ON 5)’ At recovery from the 8-hour (or longer) sleep state, execute before executing a job
6)’ Must execute at recovery from the 8-hour (or longer) sleep state

●● Image gradation correction control (D-half control)


This control is to correct the gradation by the main controller PCB based on the half-tone
density measured by the DC controller PCB.
Upon D-max control completed, the DC controller PCB and the main controller PCB enter the
following steps of D-half control.
1. The DC controller PCB measures the density detection patterns on the ITB by applying the
primary charging bias and the developing bias optimized through D-max control to send the
density data to the main controller PCB.
2. The main controller PCB corrects gradation based on the density data to reproduce the
ideal half-tone images.

2-25
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Image stabilization control
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Image stabilization control
2-26
This control follows the sequence below. ●● Auto-gradation correction control
1)The DC controller computes the color displacement degree for each color based on This control is to stabilize the image gradation density characteristic.
the color displacement detection patterns measured on the ITB. The computed color To execute this control, go to “Adjustment / Cleaning > Auto-gradation correction” in User
displacement data is sent to the main controller. mode.
2)The main controller controls the video signals for each color based on the data received This control is performed in the following 3 approaches.
from the DC controller to adjust the horizontal scanning start position, the horizontal
Item Description Test pattern
scanning magnification and the vertical scanning start position.
Output Type
In addition to the above, the DC controller PCB on the printer engine controls the scanner
sheets
motor speed to correct the color displacement in the vertical scanning direction. Full correction Gradation is corrected based on the gradation 2 sheets 1: for error diffusion
(PASCAL) density read on output test patterns by the process
Scanning magnification reader. 2: for screen
This refers to the size of the image in the horizontal scanning direction. Quick correction Gradation is corrected by D-half control not - -
The laser path length is dependent on the photosensitive drums independently included using output test patterns.
in each toner cartridge. This causes color displacement at the trailing edge due to Copy image Gradation of copy images is corrected based 1 sheet for for error diffusion
cartridge-dependent image area in the horizontal scanning direction. correction on the gradation density read on output test process
pattern by the reader.
T-2-15

Operational flow
Gradation is corrected either in the 3 approaches above in the following flow.

Image gradation
画像階調補正
correction

Copy image
コピー画像補正 Fullフル補正
correction Quick correction
クイック補正
correction

Test print 1
テストプリント1

Scan 1
スキャン1

Full correction
Test print 2
テストプリント2
Copy image correction

Quick correction
Scan 2
スキャン2

F-2-30

2-26
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Image stabilization control
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Transfer unit
2-27
■■Toner cartridges ■■Transfer unit
●● Developing cylinder contact control ●● Pad transfer method
The control makes the developing cylinder engagement / disengagement to the This product employs the pad transfer method in the primary transfer mechanism.
photosensitive drum as required in the specified print mode (full color or monochrome). Enhanced image stabilization is achieved by replacing the conventional transfer roller with the
By controlling the developing cylinder engagement to the photosensitive drum only when transfer pad. The characteristic of the pad transfer method is:
needed, this control effectively prevents the photosensitive drums from being deteriorated to • It maintains the wider nip to the photosensitive drum to increase transferability.
maximize the service life.
The DC controller actuates the motor (MF8500: Developing motor, MF8200: Main motor) The figures below show the difference between the pad transfer method and the conventional
to switch the direction of the engagement / disengagement cam to contact / separate the roller transfer method schematically.
developing cylinder to / from the photosensitive drum.
The DC controller controls the developing cylinder (engagement / disengagement) by
Photosensitive drum
regulating the main motor rotation upon detecting signals from the development home
position sensor.
The state of the Developing Cylinder for each color (engagement / disengagement) differs Wider nip width Narrow nip width
depending on the condition of the Main Body.
ITB
Condition of the Main Body Y M C Bk
Power OFF/Standby Disengagement
Monochrome print Disengagement Engagement
Transfer pad
full-color print Engagement Transfer roller
T-2-16
<Pad transfer method> <Roller transfer method>
Related Error Code
• E015-000 (Error in developing roller contact) F-2-31

Failed to detect changes in developing home position sensor signals within the pre-defined
time after actuating motor (MF8500: Developing motor, MF8200: Main motor) to control the
developing roller contact.

2-27
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Controls > Transfer unit
2 Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Service Tasks > Notes on Field Service
2-28
Service Tasks
■■Action for Parts Replacement
No work is required at parts replacement of this product.

■■Maintenance
No periodically replaced parts, durable parts or periodical service work is set for this
product.

■■Notes on Field Service

2-28
2
Technical Overview > Image Formation System > Service Tasks > Notes on Field Service
2 Technical Overview > Fixing System > Controls > Fixing Speed Control
2-29

Fixing System Controls


■■Fixing Speed Control
Overview
●● Reduction of Throughput Based on Detected Temperature of Sub
The fixing power supply controls temperatures of the Fixing Assembly.
Thermistor
This product employs the on-demand fixing method in the Fixing Assembly. The figure below
Paper interval extension time is determined based on the detected temperature of the Sub
shows the structure schematically.
Thermistor.
H801 Fixing DC controller Paper interval extension time determined by the detected temperature of the Sub Thermistor
power supply
FU1 is added to the paper interval extension time derived from the paper width detection result
TH802 Fixing control and paper length detection result.
FIXING circuit Detection of temperature by the Sub Thermistor is performed when the Delivery Sensor turns
HEATER OFF.
Fixing film DRIVE signal Fixing heater
FIXING TEMPERATURE signal safety circuit When the Paper Width Sensor is ON, reduction of throughput based on the detected
temperature of the Sub Thermistor is not executed.
Pressure roller Tempreture of Sub Thermistor: Tx Paper interval (sec)
T1 3
T2 6
T3 9
T4 15
F-2-32
T-2-18
Name MF8500 MF8200 Role
Fixing heater 100V H100 T801 To heat the fixing film
Note :
120V H120
• With MF8200 series, this control is not executed since detection of temperature by the
230V H220
Sub Thermistor is not performed.
Main thermistor TH801 TH802 To detect the fixing heater temperature • Tempreture of Sub Thermistor: T1 < T2 < T3 < T4
(center of the heater, contact thermistor)
Sub thermistor 1 TH802 - To detect the fixing heater temperature
Sub thermistor 2 TH803 - (heater ends, contact thermistor)
Temperature fuse FU1 To prevent abnormal temperature rise in the
fixing heater
T-2-17

The temperature fuse is attached to the center of the fixing heater.


When the fixing heater comes to be abnormally hot, the temperature fuse is open to shut off
the power supply to the fixing heater.
The thermistor detects the fixing heater temperature to input the temperature detection signal
to the DC controller. Note that temperatures at heater ends are not detected in models of
MF8200 series with slower print speed.
The temperatures in the whole fixing assembly are controlled by the fixing control circuit and
the fixing heater safety circuit based on commands from the DC controller.

2-29
2
Technical Overview > Fixing System > Controls > Fixing Speed Control
2 Technical Overview > Fixing System > Controls > Fixing Speed Control
2-30
●● Reduction of Throughput Based on Environment Temperature Paper interval extension time
Throughput is reduced according to the detected temperature of the Environment Sensor. Pre-registration Detection Sensor Paper length (L) (seconds)
Detected temperature Paper type Upper limit of throughput (1) (2) (3)
ON - 0 (Not extended)
17 deg C or lower Heavy paper 1 Upper limit of throughput becomes 5 ppm.
OFF L >/= 270 mm 10 8 6
Heavy paper 2
L < 270mm 8 4 2
13 deg C or lower Plain paper 1 Upper limit of throughput becomes 12 ppm.
T-2-21
Thin paper 1
Thin paper 2
Plain paper 2 Upper limit of throughput becomes 10 ppm. MF8200 Series
T-2-19
When small standard size paper other than A4 or LTR or custom paper size which paper
width is less than 195 mm is specified, throughput is reduced according to the number of
Note: prints.
In MF8500 series, the thermistor does not detect environment temperature when it
exceeds a certain temperature. Thus, this control is executed only in MF8200 series. Print speed
Paper Type
1-5 sheets 6-10 Sheets 11-20 sheets 21-50 sheets 50 sheets
Plain paper1 (60 to 74g/m2) 8 6 5.5 4 2
Plain paper2 (75 to 90g/m2)
Thick paper1 (91 to 120 g/m2) 6 5 5 2 2
Thick paper2 (121 to 163 g/m2)
●● Reduction of Throughput by Feeding Small Size Paper
Coated paper 1 5.5 5 5 2 2
(100 to 110g/m2)
Note : Coated paper 2 5 5 5 2 2
When paper size is specified by user, paper interval is increased from the 2nd sheet of (120 to 130g/m2)
the job. Coated paper 3 4 4 4 2 2
When a sensor detects that the paper size is small, paper interval is increased from 3rd (155 to 165g/m2)
or 4th sheet of the job. T-2-22

MF8500 Series
Based on the combination of detection result of the Pre-registration Detection Sensor and
detection result of paper length (L), paper interval extension time is determined according to
the table shown below.
Category Paper type
(1) Plain paper (environment temperature is 18 deg C or lower),
heavy paper 1, heavy paper 2
(2) Plain paper (environment temperature is higher than 18 deg C),
heavy paper 3, label paper
(3) Others
T-2-20

2-30
2
Technical Overview > Fixing System > Controls > Fixing Speed Control
2 Technical Overview > Fixing System > Controls > Protective Control
2-31
■■Fixing temperature control ■■Protective Control
The fixing control circuit controls temperatures of the fixing heater to attain the respective his control is to detect abnormal temperature rise in the fixing assembly to shut off power
target temperatures. supply to the fixing heater.
The figure below shows this circuit schematically. This product has the following 3 protective controls to prevent abnormal temperature rise in
the fixing assembly.
Fixing assembly • DC controller
• Fixing heater safety circuit
Fixing film unit
Fuse • Temperature fuse
FU901 The descriptions below are the details of each protective control.
/RLD+ 1) DC controller
FU1 Relay /RLD- When DC Controller monitors temperature of the central thermistor of the fixing heater
RL901 drive
TH circuit DC controller and exceeds the pre-defined temperature, which is thought abnormally high temperature,
therefore the drive signal (FSRD+, FSRD-) of the fixing heater is stopped outputting and
FSRD+ the relay is turned off and the power distribution to the heater is stopped.
Pressure ixing heater
FSRD-
roller drive circuit
2) Fixing heater safety circuit
FU1:Temperature fuse Fixing heater This circuit detects abnormal temperatures in the center of the fixing heater to shut off
TH:Thermistor Fixing control circuit safety circuit power supply to the heater.
MAINTH
3) Temperature fuse
When the temperature of the fixing heater abnormally rises, the temperature fuse is open

F-2-33
to shut off power supply to the heater.
The DC controller monitors the fixing heater temperature detection signal (MAINTH) to • 226 deg C or higher detected at the temperature fuse.
output the respective fixing heater drive signals (FSRD+, FSRD-) depending on the detected
temperatures. The fixing heater drive circuit controls the fixing heater based on the output
signal to attain the target temperature in the fixing heater.

1) Start-up temperature control


This controls the fixing heater warm-up to the target temperature.
Different temperatures are targeted depending on elapsed time after the last print job,
paper types or the environment.
2) Printing temperature control
This controls the fixing film temperature during printing to maintain the target.
Different temperatures are set in the fixing film depending on paper types.
3) Sheet-to-sheet temperature control
This control lowers the sheet-to-sheet fixing heater temperature during continuous printing
in the low-speed mode to prevent temperature rise on the pressure roller.
Different sheet-to-sheet temperatures are set depending on sheet intervals or paper types.

2-31
2
Technical Overview > Fixing System > Controls > Protective Control
2 Technical Overview > Fixing System > Service Works > Notes on service works
2-32
■■Failure detection Service Works
The DC controller determines failures of the fixing assembly under conditions below to stop
■■At parts replacement
the fixing heater drive signal output (FSRD+, FSRD-) and shut off relay and power supply to
the heater. At the same time, it notifies the failure occurrence to the main controller. No work is required for this product at parts replacement.

1) Start-up failure detection ■■Maintenance


• The thermistor temperature does not exceed startup temperature 1 within the pre-defined
No periodically replaced parts, durable parts or periodical service is set for this product.
time after start-up of the heater from the waiting status.
• The thermistor temperature does not exceed startup temperature 2 within the pre-defined
time after reaching startup temperature 1 upon start-up of the heater from the waiting ■■Notes on service works
status. When removing the fixing assembly, perform the operation after the fixing assembly is surely
• The thermistor temperature does not reach the target temperature within the pre-defined cooled. The fixing assembly just after printing may cause burn injury.
time after heater temperature control during initial rotation.
[Related error code]
E000-0000

2) Abnormally high temperature failure


• The thermistor temperature remains at pre-defined temperature or higher for the pre-
defined time.
[Related error code]
E001-0000 main thermistor
E001-0001 sub thermistor (MF8500 Series only)

3) Abnormally low temperature failure


• The thermistor temperature remains at pre-defined temperature or lower within the pre-
defined time after heater temperature control during printing.
[Related error code]
E003-0000 main thermistor
E003-0001 sub thermistor (MF8500 Series only)

4) Fixing heater drive circuit failure


• The zero-cross signal has not been detected for a certain times within the pre-defined time
after power-ON.
• ned time after power-ON.
• The zero-cross signal is detected after power-ON but has not been detected continuously
within the pre-defined time during printing.
[Related error code]
E004-0000

2-32
2
Technical Overview > Fixing System > Service Works > Notes on service works
2 Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Overview > MF8200 Series
2-33

Pickup / Feed System ■■MF8200 Series

Overview
The Pickup / Feed System is responsible for paper pickup and delivery, made up with multiple Face-down Delivery
rollers.
The figure below shows the structure of the Pickup/Feed System schematically.

■■MF8500 Series

Manual Feed
Pickup
Face-down Delivery
Cassette
Pickup
Duplexing
Feeding
F-2-35
<Pickup slot>
• Cassette
MP Tray
Pickup • Manual feed slot
<Delivery slot>
• Face-down tray
<Automatic 2-sided>
• Not Available

Cassette Pickup
F-2-34
<Pickup slot>
• Cassette
• MP tray
<Delivery slot>
• Face-down tray
<Automatic 2-sided>
• Available

2-33
2
Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Overview > MF8200 Series
2 Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Parts Configuration > MF8200 Series
2-34
Parts Configuration ■■MF8200 Series
■■MF8500 Series

Delivery Roller
Delivery Roller
Pressure Duplexing Flapper
Roller

Pressure Roller

Duplex
Feed MP Tray
Roller Pickup
Roller Secondary Transfer
External Roller

Secondary
Transfer
External Roller
MP Tray
Separation
Pad Registration Cassette Cassette
Duplex Manual Feed Roler
Feed Roller Registration Cassette Cassette
Roller Pickup Roller Separation Roller
MP Tray Feed Roler
Roller Separation Roller Pickup Roller F-2-37

F-2-36

2-34
2
Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Parts Configuration > MF8200 Series
2 Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Drive Configuration > MF8200 Series
2-35
Drive Configuration ■■MF8200 Series
■■MF8500 Series

SR609
M703 M701
SR15
SR8
SL5 M1
SR603
CL2 M4

SR10 SR604
SR602 SR605

SR14 M702 SL705 SR601


SR4
SR7
F-2-39
SL2
M3 Symbol Name Symbol Name
SR12 SR13 M701: Main Motor SR601: Cassette paper sensor
M5 CL1 SL1
SR1 M702: Pickup Motor SR602: Registration sensor
M703: Fixing Motor SR603: Fixing arch sensor
F-2-38
SL705: Cassette pickup solenoid SR604: Manual feed paper sensor
Symbol Name Symbol Name SR605: Manual feed pre-registration sensor
M1: Drum Motor SR1: Paper feeder pre-registration sensor SR609: Fixing delivery sensor
M3: Registration Motor SR4: Registration sensor T-2-24
M4: Fixing Motor SR7: MP tray pre-registration sensor
M5: Pickup Motor SR8: Fixing delivery sensor
SL1: MP Tray Pickup Solenoid SR10: Fixing arch sensor
SL2: Cassette Pickup solenoid SR12: Pre-registration sensor
SL5: Duplex reversal solenoid SR13: Cassette paper sensor
CL1: MP Tray Feeding Clutch SR14: MP tray paper sensor
CL2: Duplex feeding clutch SR15: Delivery full sensor
T-2-23

2-35
2
Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Drive Configuration > MF8200 Series
2 Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Controls > Jam detection
2-36
Controls ■■Jam detection
■■Cassette paper feed ●● Overview
This product has the paper sensors as listed below to detect paper level and paper feed
●● Roller separation method status.
This product employs the separation roller method to avoid multi-feeding. • Registration sensor
This method prevents multiple sheets from being fed by the driven separation roller. The • MP tray pre-registration sensor (MF8500 Series only)
separation roller is driven by the pickup roller. • Manual feed pre-registration sensor (MF8200 Series only)
• Fixing delivery sensor
<When normally operated> • Fixing arch sensor
The separation roller is driven by the pickup roller to feed paper. By this, the separation roller • Pre-registration sensor (MF8500 Series only)
rotates in the paper feed direction. • Cassette paper sensor
• MP tray paper sensor (MF8200 Series only)
<When multiple sheets are fed> • Delivery full sensor (MF8500 Series only)
Multiple sheets weaken friction between rollers, decaying the driving force conveyed from • Paper feeder pre-registration sensor (MF8200 Series only)
the pickup roller to the separation roller. This product has the mechanism to regulate the
separation roller rotation, which stops the roller rotation at multi-feeding under weaker driving The following jams are detected in this product.
force conveyed from the pickup roller. This enables to avoid multi-feeding. 1. Pickup delay jam 1
The figure below shows the multi-feeding prevention mechanism employed in this product. 2. Pickup delay jam 2 (MF8500 Series only)
3. Pickup stationary jam
4. Fixing / delivery delay jam
Pickup roller 5. Delivery stationary jam
6. Fixing seizure jam
7. Internal paper remaining jam
Media 8. Duplex re-pickup jam (MF8500 Series only)
9. Open door jam
Separation roller
Lifting plate

The separation roller does not rotate.

<Normal-feed> <Multiple-feed>
F-2-40

2-36
2
Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Controls > Jam detection
2 Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Controls > Jam detection
2-37
●● Delay jams ●● Other jams
Pickup delay jam 1 Fixing seizure jam
This occurs when the leading edge of the paper is not detected by the registration sensor* This occurs when the fixing / delivery sensor (SR8) detected the leading edge of the paper
from the start of image formation to re-pickup. but the sensor went off before starting the fixing / delivery stationary detection.
* *
: MF8500: SR4, MF8200: SR602 : MF8500: SR8, MF8200: SR609

Pickup delay jam 2 (MF8500 Series only) Internal paper remaining jam
This occurs when the leading edge of the paper is not detected by the MP tray pre- When the sensor below detects “Paper Sensor” before-and-after Power on, Door close, Print
registration sensor (SR7) within the pre-defined duration after the paper is fed from the multi- operation.
purpose tray. < MF8500 Series >
• Paper feeder pre-registration sensor (SR1)
Fixing / delivery delay jam • Registration sensor (SR4)
This occurs when the leading edge of the paper is not detected by the fixing delivery sensor*1 • MP tray pre-registration sensor (SR7)
within the pre-defined duration after re-pickup; or when the leading edge of the paper is not • Fixing delivery sensor (SR8)
detected by the delivery full sensor*2 during the pre-defined duration after the trailing edge of • Fixing arch sensor (SR10)
the paper is detected by the registration sensor. • Pre-registration sensor (SR12)
*1
: MF8500: SR8, MF8200: SR609 < MF8200 Series >
*2
: MF8500: SR15 • Registration sensor (SR602
• Fixing arch sensor (SR603)
●● Stationary jams • Manual feed pre-registration sensor (SR605)
Pickup stationary jam • Fixing delivery sensor (SR609)
*
This occurs when the trailing edge of the paper is not detected by the registration sensor
within the pre-defined duration after re-pickup. Duplex re-pickup jam (MF8500 Series only)
*
: MF8500: SR4, MF8200: SR602 This occurs when the leading edge of the paper is not detected by the registration sensor (SR4)
within the pre-defined duration elapsed from starting reversing.
Fixing / delivery stationary jam
This occurs when the trailing edge of the paper is not detected by the fixing delivery Open door jam
*2
sensor within the pre-defined duration after the trailing edge of the paper is detected by the This occurs when any of sensors detected paper in the device and the door opening is
registration sensor . *1 detected during print jobs.
*1
: MF8500: SR4, MF8200: SR602
*2
: MF8500: SR8, MF8200: SR609

2-37
2
Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Controls > Jam detection
2 Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Service Works > Notes on service works
2-38
Service Works
■■At parts replacement
No work is accompanied with parts replacement.

■■Maintenance
No periodically replaced parts, durable parts or periodical service is set for this product.

■■Notes on service works


No periodically

2-38
2
Technical Overview > Pickup / Feed System > Service Works > Notes on service works
3 Periodical Services

■Periodically

■Durable Parts
Replaced Parts


■Periodical Services

■Cleaning

3
Periodical Services
3 Periodical Services > Cleaning
3-2

Periodically Replaced Parts Cleaning


No periodically replaced parts is set for this product. • MF8500 series
[1] [2]

Durable Parts
No durable parts is set for this product.

Periodical Services
No periodical service is set for this product.

[8] [7] [6] [5] [4] [3]

F-3-1

Cleaning parts Procedure


1 Fixing front guide Clean with lint-free paper. For heavy soils, use alcohol to wipe
off with lint-free paper.
2 Laser beam window glass Clean with lint-free paper.
3 Multi-purpose tray Clean with lint-free paper. For heavy soils, use alcohol to wipe
separation pad off with lint-free paper.
4 Multi-purpose tray pickup
roller
5 Multi-purpose tray feed
roller
6 Cassette pickup roller
7 Cassette separation roller
8 Registration upper guide Clean with lint-free paper.
T-3-1

3-2
3
Periodical Services > Cleaning
3 Periodical Services > Cleaning
3-3
• MF8200 series

[4]

[3]

[2] [1]
F-3-2

Cleaning parts Procedure


1 Pickup roller Clean with lint-free paper. For heavy soils, use alcohol to wipe
2 Separation roller off with lint-free paper.
3 Paper feed guide
4 Fixing front guide
T-3-2

3-3
3
Periodical Services > Cleaning
4 Disassembly/
Assembly

■MF8500 series ■
■MF8200 series


■List of Parts ■
■List of Parts

■External Cover, Internal ■
■External Cover, Internal
Cover Cover

■Document Exposure, ■
■Document exposure/
Feed System feeder system

■Controller System ■
■Controller System

■Laser Exposure System ■
■Laser Exposure System

■Image Formation System ■
■Image Formation System

■Fixing System ■
■Fixing System

■Pickup Feeder System ■
■Pickup Feeder System

4
Disassembly/Assembly
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External/ Internal Cover (MF8500 series) > Front Side
4-2

List of Parts

List of External/ Internal Cover (MF8500 series)


■■Front Side
[3] [4] No. Parts Name Remarks Reference
[5] [1] ADF Front Upper Cover - -
[2]
[1] [6] [2] ADF Upper Cover - -
[3] Side Guide (Front) - -
[7] [4] Side Guide (Rear) - -
[5] Document Tray - -
[8] [6] Extension Tray - -
[7] Sub Tray - -
[8] Delivery Tray - -
[9] Right Cover - (Refer to page 4-20)
[10] Control Panel Lower Cover - -
[11] Control Panel - (Refer to page 4-70)
[12] Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-28)
[9]
[13] USB Port - -
[14] Right Front Cover - (Refer to page 4-22)
[11] [15] Front Cover - (Refer to page 4-23)
[16] Cassette - -
[10]
[17] Mulyi-Purpose Tray Transport - (Refer to page 4-125)
Guide
[12] [18] Left Cover - (Refer to page 4-17)
[19] Reader Cover - -
[13] T-4-1
[19]

[18]

[14]
[15]
[17] [16]
F-4-1

4-2
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External/ Internal Cover (MF8500 series) > Front Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External/ Internal Cover (MF8500 series) > Rear Side
4-3
■■Rear Side
[1]

[10]
[9]

[2]
[8]

[7]
[3]
[6]

[4]

[5]
F-4-2

No. Parts Name Remarks Reference


[1] ADF Rear Cover - -
[2] Rear Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-24)
[3] Rear Cover - (Refer to page 4-24)
[4] Rear Lower Cover - (Refer to page 4-25)
[5] Power Socket - -
[6] Telephone Line Jack - -
[7] LAN Port - -
[8] USB Port - -
[9] External Device Jack - -
[10] Handset Terminal - -
T-4-2

4-3
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External/ Internal Cover (MF8500 series) > Rear Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Main Unit (MF8500 series) > 1/2
4-4
List of Main Unit (MF8500 series)
■■1/2
No. Parts Name Remarks Reference Adjastment during
[1] parts replacement
[1] ADF Unit - (Refer to page 4-35) (Refer to page 4-36)
[2] Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-35) (Refer to page 4-37)
[3] Control Panel Unit - (Refer to page 4-70) -
[4] Duplexing Reverse - (Refer to page 4-85) -
Drive Unit
[5] Main Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-76) -
[2] [6] Low Voltage Power - (Refer to page 4-65) -
Supply Unit
[7] MP Paper Pickup Unit - (Refer to page 4-125) -
[3] [8] Paper Pickup Unit - (Refer to page 4-120) -
T-4-3

[4]

[5]

[8]

[6]

[7]
F-4-3

4-4
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Main Unit (MF8500 series) > 1/2
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Main Unit (MF8500 series) > 2/2
4-5
■■2/2
[9] No. Parts Name Remarks Reference Adjastment during
parts replacement
[9] Fixing Assembly - (Refer to page 4-104) -
[10] [10] Laser Scanner Unit - (Refer to page 4-90) (Refer to page 4-94)
[11] ITB Unit - (Refer to page 4-95) -
[12] Delivery Unit - (Refer to page 4-128) -
[13] Secondary Transfer - (Refer to page 4-127) -
Feed Unit
[14] Duplex Feed Unit - (Refer to page 4-130) -
[11] [15] Re-Pickup Guide Unit - (Refer to page 4-131) -
T-4-4
[12]

[13]

[15] [14]

F-4-4

4-5
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Main Unit (MF8500 series) > 2/2
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Motor/Fan (MF8500 series)
4-6
List of Motor/Fan (MF8500 series)
M4 No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment
M7 during
M721
parts
M1 replacement
FM1 Fixing /Fixing Product - (Refer to page 4-86) -
M2 Power Supply configuration
Cooling Fan
FM2 Duplex Feeding Rear Cover Rib - (Refer to page 4-88) -
M720 Fan Unit
M1 Drum Motor Main Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-102) -
M2 Developing Main Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-100) -
Motor
M3 Registration Pickup Unit - - -
Motor
M4 Fixing Motor Product - (Refer to page 4-111) -
configuration
M5 Pickup Motor Product - (Refer to page 4-118) -
configuration
M7 Laser Scanner Laser Scanner - - -
FM2
Motor Unit
M720 Reader Motor Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-52) -
M3 M721 ADF Motor ADF Paper - (Refer to page 4-46) -
FM1
Feeder Unit
M5
T-4-5

F-4-5

4-6
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Motor/Fan (MF8500 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/speaker (MF8500 series)
4-7
List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/
speaker (MF8500 series)
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment
SL5 CL2
TH803 during
SL4 parts
SL3
replacement
TH801
H120 Fixing heater Fixing Film Unit 120V - -
H220 Fixing heater Fixing Film Unit 220V - -
SW1
H120 TH801 Main Thermistor Fixing Film Unit - - -
SP1 (MF8540Cdn)
/H220 TH802 Sub Thermistor Fixing Film Unit - - -
1
TH803 Sub Thermistor Fixing Film Unit - - -
2
SP1 Speaker Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-89) -
configuration /8550Cdn
SW1 Main Power Product MF8580Cdw - -
SW1 Switch configuration /8550Cdn
(MF8580Cdw MF8540Cdn - -
TH802 /8550Cdn)
CL1 MP Tray Product - - -
Feeding Clutch configuration
CL2 Duplex Feeding Duplex - - -
Clutch Reversing Drive
Unit
SL1 MP Tray Pickup Product - - -
SL1
Solenoid configuration
SL2 CL1 SL2 Cassette Pickup Pickup Unit - - -
Solenoid
SL3 Developing Main Drive Unit - - -
Separation
Solenoid
SL4 ADF Pickup ADF Paper - - -
Solenoid Feeder Unit
SL5 Duplex Reversal Duplex - - -
Solenoid Reversing Drive
Unit
T-4-6

4-7
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/speaker (MF8500 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Sensor (MF8500 series)
4-8
List of Sensor (MF8500 series)
PS702 SR15 No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment
PS703 during
SR4 parts
PS701 replacement
SR13 PCB28 Environment Sensor Product configuration - - -
PCB29 Patch Sensor Patch Density/ - - -
SR8 SR2 Registration Sensor
Unit
PCB30 Patch Registration Patch Density/ - - -
SR10 Sensor Registration Sensor
Unit
PS701 CIS Unit Homeposition Reader Unit - - -
Sensor
SR9 PS702 Document End Sensor ADF Paper Feeder Unit - - -
SR6
PS703 Document Sensor ADF Paper Feeder Unit - - -
SR1 Paper Feeder Pre- Pickup Unit - - -
Registration Detection
Sensor
PCB30 SR2 Front Cover Sensor Product configuration - - -
SR1 SR4 Registration Detection Pickup Unit - - -
Sensor
SR14
SR6 Developing Main Drive Unit - - -
SR12
Homeposition Sensor
PCB29
SR16 SR7 MP Tray Pre- Product configuration - - -
SR7 PCB28 Registration Detection
Sensor
SR8 Fixing Delivery Sensor Fixing Assembly - - -
SR9 Fixing Pressure Fixing Assembly - - -
Release Sensor
SR10 Fixing Loop Sensor Fixing Assembly - - -
SR12 Pre-registration Pickup Unit - - -
Detection Sensor
SR13 Cassette Paper Pickup Unit - - -
Detection Sensor
SR14 MP Tray Paper Product configuration - - -
Detection Sensor
SR15 Delivery Full Sensor Delivery Unit - - -
SR16 ITB Pressure Release ITB Unit - - -
Sensor
T-4-7

4-8
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Sensor (MF8500 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > PCB (MF8500 series)
4-9
PCB (MF8500 series) UN7 UN16

UN2
UN13
UN23 UN14
UN1 UN20
UN17 UN6

UN15

UN5

UN9

UN10 UN8

UN3 UN4 F-4-6

No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment during


parts replacement
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment during UN2 Driver PCB Product - (Refer to page 4-68) -
parts replacement configuration
UN1 DC Controller Product - (Refer to page 4-61) (Refer to page 4-61) UN6 Fixing Relay Product - - -
PCB configuration PCB configuration
UN3 High Voltage Product - (Refer to page 4-63) - UN7 Fixing Sub PCB Product - (Refer to page 4-67) -
Power Supply configuration configuration
PCB UN8 Low Voltage Low Voltage - - -
UN4 Laser Driver Laser Scanner - - - Main PCB Power Supply
PCB Unit Unit
UN5 Relay PCB Product - (Refer to page 4-69) - UN9 Low Voltage Low Voltage - - -
configuration Sub PCB Power Supply
UN13 Main Controller Product - (Refer to page 4-58) (Refer to page 4-58) Unit
PCB configuration UN10 Duplex Driver Re-Pickup - - -
UN15 USB Host PCB Product - - - PCB Guide Unit
configuration UN14 Control Panel Control Panel - (Refer to page 4-73) -
UN17 Off Hook PCB Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-75) - LCD PCB Unit
configuration /8550Cdn UN20 Control Panel Control Panel - (Refer to page 4-73) -
UN23 Wireless LAN Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-57) - Key PCB Unit
PCB configuration UN16 FAX-NCU PCB Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-75) -
T-4-8 configuration /8550Cdn
T-4-9

4-9
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > PCB (MF8500 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 1/5
4-10
List of Connector (MF8500 Series)
■■1/5
J918
J651 J942
J929 J941
J921
J2008

J2000

MF8580Cdw MF8540Cdn
/8550Cdn

J392
J1301 J393 J393 J386

J391 J388

J383

J387 J312
J301
J388 J311
J386 J301
F-4-7

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J651 UN7 Fixing Sub PCB J4003 J1301 H120 Fixing heater 120V
J311 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB J4003 J1301 H120 Fixing heater 120V
J651 UN7 Fixing Sub PCB J4003 J1301 H220 Fixing heater 220V
J311 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB J4003 J1301 H220 Fixing heater 220V
J651 UN7 Fixing Sub PCB J312 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB
J301 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB J301 - INLET
J386 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB J386 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J383 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB J387 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J388 UN8 Low Voltage Main PCB J388 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J391 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB J393 SW1 Main Power Switch MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn
J929 UN13 Main Controller PCB J392 SW1 Main Power Switch MF8540Cdn
J918 UN13 Main Controller PCB J941 UN16 FAX-NCU PCB MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn
J921 UN13 Main Controller PCB J2000 UN17 Off Hook PCB MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn
J942 UN16 FAX-NCU PCB J2008 UN17 Off Hook PCB MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn
T-4-10

4-10
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 1/5
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 2/5
4-11
■■2/5
J901
J914 J130

J912 J409 J151


J915 J153

J164
J3011 J163
J165
J3005 J166
J161
J3001
J351
J3003 J361
J352
J3002
J362
J611

J601

J3004
J3015
F-4-8

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J130 UN1 DC Controller PCB J912 UN13 Main Controller PCB
J151 UN1 DC Controller PCB J361 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J151 UN1 DC Controller PCB J362 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J153 UN1 DC Controller PCB J3015 PCB28 Environment Sensor
J161 UN5 Relay PCB J601 PCB29 Patch Sensor
J161 UN5 Relay PCB J611 PCB30 Patch Registration Sensor
J163 UN5 Relay PCB J3011 SR4 Registration Detection Sensor
J164 UN5 Relay PCB J3002 SR1 Paper Feeder Pre-Registration Detection
Sensor
J165 UN5 Relay PCB J3003 SR12 Pre-registration Detection Sensor
J165 UN5 Relay PCB J3004 SR13 Cassette Paper Detection Sensor
J166 UN5 Relay PCB J3001 SR6 Developing Homeposition Sensor
J166 UN5 Relay PCB J3005 SR2 Front Cover Sensor
J901 UN13 Main Controller PCB J409 - CIS Unit
J914 UN13 Main Controller PCB J351 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J915 UN13 Main Controller PCB J352 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
T-4-11

4-11
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 2/5
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 3/5
4-12
■■3/5
J904
J903 J654 J154
J1003
J902 J154
J908 J156
J1305 J133
J922
J1302 J141
J922
J160
J1404
J162
J1312
J972 J167

J1402

J3009
J1001
J3006

J3010
F-4-9

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J133 UN1 DC Controller PCB J1001 UN3 High Voltage Power Supply PCB
J141 UN1 DC Controller PCB J160 UN5 Relay PCB
J154 UN1 DC Controller PCB J154 SL3 Developing Separation Solenoid
J156 UN1 DC Controller PCB J654 UN7 Fixing Sub PCB
J162 UN5 Relay PCB J3010 SR7 MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
J167 UN5 Relay PCB J3006 SR14 MP Tray Paper Detection Sensor
J167 UN5 Relay PCB J4017 J3009 SR16 ITB Pressure Release Sensor
J903 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1302 PS703 Document Sensor
J903 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1305 M721 ADF Motor
J903 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1310 J1312 PS702 Document End Sensor
J908 UN13 Main Controller PCB J972 UN15 USB Host PCB
J904 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1402 J1402 M720 Reader Motor
J904 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1401 J1404 PS701 CIS Unit Homeposition Sensor
J922 UN13 Main Controller PCB J922 SP1 Speaker MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn
J902 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1003 J1003 SL4 ADF Pickup Solenoid
T-4-12

4-12
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 3/5
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 4/5
4-13
■■4/5
J203 J202
J201
J653 J1
J2001 J204
J910
J211
J213
J140

J208 J2004 J2002

J209
J2003

J210

J206

J2005 J205
J209
J210
J206 J208
J207
J207
F-4-10

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J140 UN1 DC Controller PCB J201 UN2 Driver PCB
J202 UN2 Driver PCB J2004 M5 Pickup Motor
J203 UN2 Driver PCB J2005 M3 Registration Motor
J204 UN2 Driver PCB J2003 M2 Developing Motor
J205 UN2 Driver PCB J2001 M4 Fixing Motor
J206 UN2 Driver PCB J206 FM1 Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan
J207 UN2 Driver PCB J207 SL2 Cassette Pickup Solenoid
J208 UN2 Driver PCB J208 CL1 MP Tray Feeding Clutch
J209 UN2 Driver PCB J209 SL1 MP Tray Pickup Solenoid
J210 UN2 Driver PCB J210 UN9 Low Voltage Sub PCB
J211 UN2 Driver PCB J2002 M1 Drum Motor
J213 UN2 Driver PCB J4004 J4004 UN11 Paper Feeder Relay PCB
J653 UN7 Fixing Sub PCB J4004 J4004 UN11 Paper Feeder Relay PCB
J910 UN13 Main Controller PCB J1 UN23 Wireless LAN PCB MF8580Cdw
T-4-13

4-13
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 4/5
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 5/5
4-14
■■5/5

J4001 J924 J4018


J707 J951
J703 J150 J706
J961
J704 J157 J708
J710 J952
J131
J709
J152

J132 J3014

J3012
J709
J3013

J705

J704

J501 J703

J705
J701
J2007
F-4-11

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J131 UN1 DC Controller PCB J501 UN4 Laser Driver PCB
J132 UN1 DC Controller PCB J2007 M7 Laser Scanner Motor
J150 UN1 DC Controller PCB J4001 J4001 TH801, TH802 Main Thermistor, Sub Thermistor 1
J150 UN1 DC Controller PCB J707 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB
J152 UN1 DC Controller PCB J701 UN10 Duplex Driver PCB
J157 UN1 DC Controller PCB J706 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB
J703 UN10 Duplex Driver PCB J703 SL5 Duplex Reversal Solenoid
J704 UN10 Duplex Driver PCB J704 CL2 Duplex Feeding Clutch
J705 UN10 Duplex Driver PCB J705 FM2 Duplex Feeding Fan
J708 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB J4018 SR15 Delivery Full Sensor
J709 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB J709 TH803 Sub Thermistor 2
J710 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB J3012 SR10 Fixing Loop Sensor
J710 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB J3013 SR9 Fixing Pressure Release Sensor
J710 UN6 Fixing Relay PCB J3014 SR8 Fixing Delivery Sensor
J924 UN13 Main Controller PCB J951 UN14 Control Panel LCD PCB
J961 UN20 Control Panel Key PCB J952 UN14 Control Panel LCD PCB
T-4-14

4-14
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > Llist of Connector (MF8500 Series) > 5/5
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Front Side
4-15

External Cover, Internal Cover

Location
■■Front Side
[3] [4] No. Parts Name Remarks Reference
[5] [1] ADF Front Upper Cover - -
[2]
[1] [6] [2] ADF Upper Cover - -
[3] Side Guide (Front) - -
[7] [4] Side Guide (Rear) - -
[5] Document Tray - -
[8] [6] Extension Tray - -
[7] Sub Tray - -
[8] Delivery Tray - -
[9] Right Cover - (Refer to page 4-20)
[10] Control Panel Lower Cover - -
[11] Control Panel - (Refer to page 4-70)
[12] Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-28)
[9]
[13] USB Port - -
[14] Right Front Cover - (Refer to page 4-22)
[11] [15] Front Cover - (Refer to page 4-23)
[16] Cassette - -
[10]
[17] Multi-Purpose Tray Transport - (Refer to page 4-125)
Guide
[12] [18] Left Cover - (Refer to page 4-17)
[19] Reader Cover - -
[13] T-4-15
[19]

[18]

[14]
[15]
[17] [16]
F-4-12

4-15
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Front Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Rear Side
4-16
■■Rear Side
[1]

[10]
[9]

[2]
[8]

[7]
[3]
[6]

[4]

[5]
F-4-13

No. Parts Name Remarks Reference


[1] ADF Rear Cover - -
[2] Rear Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-24)
[3] Rear Cover - (Refer to page 4-24)
[4] Rear Lower Cover - (Refer to page 4-25)
[5] Power Socket - -
[6] Telephone Line Jack - -
[7] LAN Port - -
[8] USB Port - -
[9] External Device Jack - -
[10] Handset Terminal - -
T-4-16

4-16
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Rear Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Procedure
4-17
Removing the Left Cover 5) While pushing the claw [2] of the Left Cover [1], hold the top of the host machine, and push
the Left Cover directly upward with your finger on the [A] part of the Left Cover.
■■Procedure
CAUTION:
1) To remove the lower claw of the Left Cover, shift the host machine by 5cm from the base.
2) Remove the Cassette [1]. Do not open [A] part of the Left Cover in the direction of the arrow when removing the
3) Open the ADF Unit + Reader Unit [2] and the Front Cover [3]. Left Cover; otherwise, the projection [1] of the Left Cover can be damaged/broken.

[2]

[1]

[1]

[3]
[1] [A]

ut 5 cm
abo F-4-16
F-4-14
4) Remove the 2 screws [2].

x2

[1] 1
2

[1]
[2]

[A]
F-4-15 F-4-17

4-17
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Installing the Left Cover
4-18
6) Release the hook [2] and remove the Left Cover [1] while opening the rear of the Left Cover ■■Installing the Left Cover
[1].
1) Fit the hook [1] at the upper right side of the Left Cover to the upper left area [2] of the
Upper Cover.

[2] [2]

[1]
[1]

F-4-18

F-4-19

4-18
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Installing the Left Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Installing the Left Cover
4-19
2) Fit the protrusion [1] of Left Cover to the groove [2] of the frame. 4) Install the Left Cover [1].
3) Insert the claw [3] of the Left Cover to the groove [4] of the Upper Cover to match the Left • 1 Claw [2]
Cover to the machine. • 8 Hooks [3]
• 2 Screws [4]
[4]

x2 [3]

[1]

[4]
[3]

[2]

[2] [1]
[3]
F-4-21

[1]

F-4-20

4-19
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Installing the Left Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4-20
Removing the Right Cover ■■Installing the Right Cover
1) Fit the 3 hooks [2] of the Right Cover into the holes [3] of the Upper Cover
■■Procedure
[2]
1) Open the ADF Unit + Reader Unit [1], and remove the Right Cover [2].
• 4 Screws [3]
x3 [3]
• 3 Hooks [4]

[1]
[3] [2]

x4

[2]

[1]

F-4-23
2) While pushing the Right Cover [1] to the Host Machine, fit the left surface [A] of the Right
[4]
[3] Cover to the right surface [B] of the Right Front Cover.

[1]
[3]
F-4-22

[B] [A]

F-4-24

4-20
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4-21
3) Install the 3 hooks [1] at the left side of the Right Cover and the 3 holes [2] of the Right
Front Cover.

[1] [2]
x3 [1]

[2]

F-4-25
4) Install the Right Cover [1].
• 4 screws [2]

[1] [2]

x4

[2]

[2]
F-4-26

4-21
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Front Cover > Procerdure
4-22
Removing the Right Front Cover 5) Remove the claw [1] at the lower right side of the Right Front Cover.
6) Put a flat-blade screwdriver into the gap [A] between the upper area of the Right Front
■■Preparation Cover and the Upper Cover to remove the claw [2] in the direction of the arrow.

1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.


[3] [A]

■■Procerdure
1) Remove the Cassette.
2) Open the ADF Unit + Reader Unit [1] and the Front Cover [2]. [2] [2]
3) Draw out the Cartridge Tray.
[1]
4) Remove the 2 screws [2].

[1]

x2
[3]

F-4-28
[2]

[4]

F-4-27

4-22
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Front Cover > Procerdure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Cover > Procerdure
4-23
Removing the Front Cover 3) While closing the Front Cover [1], release the shaft [3] of the Left Link [2] and the protrusion
[4].
■■Preparation 4) While closing the Front Cover [1], release the shaft [6] of the Right Link [5] and the
protrusion [7], and remove the Front Cover [1].
1) Remove the Cartridge Tray. Refer to page 4-30.
2) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
3) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17
[4]
4) Remove the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.

■■Procerdure
[3]
1) Remove the bushing support [1].
[1]
• 2 screws [2] [2]

[1]
[1]
x2

[2]
[7]
[6]
F-4-29
[5]
2) Remove the 2 pins [1] using a screwdriver. [5]
[1]

[1]
[1] F-4-31

F-4-30

4-23
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Cover > Procerdure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Cover > Procedure
4-24
Removing the Rear Upper Cover Removing the Rear Cover
■■Preparation ■■Procedure
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20 1) Open the Rear Cover [1].
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17. 2) Close the Duplex Feed Unit [2].

■■Procedure
1) Close the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. [2]
2) Open the Rear Cover.
3)Remove the 2 screws [1]. [1]

x2

[1]

F-4-34
3) Remove the Rear Cover [1].
• 2 screws [2]
• 4 hooks [3]

F-4-32 [2]
4) Push the 2 claws [1] to remove the Rear Upper Cover [2].
x2
• 1 Hook [3]

[1] [2]

x2 [1]

[1]

[3]
[3]

[3] F-4-35

F-4-33

4-24
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Lower Cover > Procedure
4-25
Removing the Rear Lower Cover 2) Open the Duplex Feed Unit [1] and remove the 2 claws [2] and 2 bosses [3].

■■Preparation [3] [2] [2] [3]


1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Remove the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.

■■Procedure
1) Remove the arm [1].
• 2 link caps [2]

[1]

[2]

[2] [1]
[1]
F-4-36
F-4-37
3) Close the Duplex Feed Unit [1].

[1]

F-4-38

4-25
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Lower Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Lower Cover > Procedure
4-26
4) Move the Rear Lower Cover [1] aside from the [A] part of the Duplex Reverse Drive Unit [2].
5) Hold the Rear Cover Rib Unit [3] and remove the Rear Lower Cover [1].
• 2 Hooks [4]

[A]
[A]

[2] [2]

[1] [1]

[3]
[4]
[1]

F-4-39

4-26
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Lower Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit > Procedure
4-27
Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit CAUTION:

■■Preparation At installation, make sure that the spring [1] is installed on [A] part before installing the
Rear Cover Rib Unit.
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Remove the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24
[1]
5) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25

■■Procedure
1) Remove the Rear Cover Rib Unit [1].
• 2 bearing holders [2]
• 1 fixing guide [3]
• 1 connector [4] [A]

[3] F-4-41
[4]

[1]

[2]

F-4-40

4-27
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Upper Cover > Procedure
4-28
Removing the Upper Cover 2) Remove 6 screws [1].

■■Preparation [2]
[2]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. x6
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Remove the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Remove the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
[2]

■■Procedure
1) Remove the USB Host PCB Unit [1].
• 1 screw [2] [1]

F-4-43
3) Release 2 claws [1] of the Upper Cover with a flat-blade screwdriver.

[1]

[2]
x2

[1]

[1]

[1]

F-4-44

F-4-42

4-28
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Upper Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Upper Cover > Procedure
4-29
4) Push down the flag [1] and remove the rear side of the Upper Cover [2].

[1] [1]

[2]

[2]

F-4-45
5) Remove the Upper Cover [1].
• 3 Hooks [2]

[1]

[2]
F-4-46

4-29
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Upper Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Cartridge Tray > Procedure
4-30
Removing the Cartridge Tray 4) While raising the stopper [1], remove the Cartridge Tray [2].
• 1 Protrusion [3]
■■Procedure
[3]
CAUTION:
When removing the Toner Cartridge, be careful not to damage the Photosensitive
Drum. Also, be sure to block light.

1) Open the Front Cover.


2) Pull out the Cartridge Tray [1]. [1]
3) Remove the toner cartridges (Y, M, C, Bk) [2].

[2]

[2] F-4-48

[1]

F-4-47

4-30
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Cartridge Tray > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Location
4-31

Document Exposure, Feed System

Location
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
[1]
parts replacement

[2]
[1] ADF Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-35) (Refer to page 4-36)
Configuration
[2] ADF Paper ADF Unit - (Refer to page 4-43) -
[3] Feeder Unit
[6] [3] ADF Roller ADF Unit - (Refer to page 4-38) -
Unit
[7] [4] ADF Pickup ADF Roller - (Refer to page 4-40) -
Roller Unit
[5] ADF ADF Roller - (Refer to page 4-41) -
[4] Separation Unit
Roller
[5] [6] ADF Motor ADF Paper M721 (Refer to page 4-46) -
Feeder Unit
[7] ADF ADF Paper - (Refer to page 4-42) -
Separation Feeder Unit
Pad
[8] Reader Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-35) (Refer to page 4-37)
Configuration
[9] CIS Unit Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-49) (Refer to page 4-51)
[11] [10] Reader Reader Unit M720 (Refer to page 4-52) -
Motor
[11] Reader Unit Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-47) (Refer to page 4-48)
Upper Cover
T-4-17

[8]
[10]
[9]
F-4-49

4-31
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Location
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-32
Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit 4) Bring down the Reader Support Shaft [1] to close the ADF Unit +Reader Unit [2].

[2]
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:
[1]
Be sure to perform "After replacing ADF unit (Refer to page 4-36)" and "After replacing
reader unit (Refer to page 4-37)" when replacing the ADF Unit and Reader Unit,
respectively.
F-4-51
5) Remove the Controller Cover [1] at the right side of the host machine.
1) Open the ADF Unit + Reader Unit.
• 9 screws [2]
2) Remove the claw [1] to remove the Reader Shaft Retainer [2].
• 2 Hooks [3]
3) While supporting the ADF Unit + Reader Unit [3], remove the Reader Support Shaft [4].
[1]
[3]
[3]
x9
[1]

[2]

[2]
[3] [4] [2]
[2]
F-4-50
F-4-52

4-32
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-33
6) Remove the 2 Flat Cables [1] and the Ferrite Core [2] on the right side of the machine.
CAUTION:
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [3]
• 3 Connectors [4] Be sure to perform the following when connecting the Flat Cable [1] to the connector
• 1 Claw [5] with a lock [2].
• 3 Harness Guides [6] Be sure to insert the Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after checking
that both sides (edges) [A] of the Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves [B] of the
connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].
[2] [6]
[6]
[1] [1]
x5
[5]
[4] [A]

[1] [A] [B]

[B]

x3 [2]
[2] [3]
[3]
[4]
[1] [1]
F-4-53

[A]
[A] [B]

[B]

[2] [3] [2]

F-4-54

4-33
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-34
7) Put the 2 Grounding Wires [1] through the hole [A] and open and remove the ADF Unit +
Reader Unit [2].
• 2 Screws [3]
• 2 Hooks [4]

[2]

[A]

x2
[1]

[1]
[3]
[4]
F-4-55

4-34
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-35
Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit 2) Remove the Reader Unit Lower Cover [1].
• 1 Screw [2]
■■Preparation • 4 Claws [3]
• 3 Harnesses [4]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
• 2 Flat Cables [5]
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
• 2 Grounding Wires [6]
3) Remove the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
[3]

■■Procedure
[4]
[1] [5]
CAUTION:
[5]
[3]
Be sure to perform "After replacing ADF unit (Refer to page 4-36)" and "After replacing
reader unit (Refer to page 4-37)" when replacing the ADF Unit and Reader Unit, x7
respectively.
[6]
[2]
[3]
1) Place the ADF Unit and Reader Unit in the open status as shown in the figure below.

[3]
F-4-57
3) Remove the harness [1] and the grounding [2].
• 6 harness guides [3]

[1]
x6
[3]

F-4-56
[3]

[3]

[2]
F-4-58

4-35
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > After replacing ADF units
4-36
4) Raise the ADF Unit [1] to separate from the Reader Unit [2] in the direction of the arrow. ■■After replacing ADF units
1) After executing the white level adjustment with the following service mode 1, check the
auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
1. White level adjustment
[1]
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
2. Checking the setting value
[2] • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
F-4-59 • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
NOTE:
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
Be sure to open the ADF Unit [1] to the degree indicated with the direction of the arrow
[A]; otherwise, the ADF Unit cannot be separated from the Reader Unit [3] because of using DF)
the 2 claws [2].
2) Execute the reading position adjustment with the following service mode.
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning
position in FEEDER mode)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)
[2]
[A]
3) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading.
• FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
[3] [1]
reading)
• FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)
[2]

F-4-60

4-36
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > After replacing ADF units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > After replacing reader units
4-37
■■After replacing reader units 4) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
1) Release 2 claws [1] and Remove the Scoopup sheet holder [2], Enter the setting value of
mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
the Standard White Plate.
1. White level adjustment
[2] • COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
x2
[1] scanning])
[1]
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
F-4-61 • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X (X signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Y (Y signal data for the standard white plate) using DF)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Z (Z signal data for the standard white plate)
5) Enter the value on the label packed with the part in the following service mode item.
MEMO • COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
The value of W-PLT-X: The first four digits of the value on the label
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
The value of W-PLT-Y: The four digits in the middle of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Z: The last four digits of the value on the label • COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning
position in FEEDER mode)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)
2) Execute the white level adjustment. • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> 50-RG (Color displacement correction value between RG
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment) in the vertical scanning direction (50%))
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>50-GB (Color displacement correction value between GB
in the vertical scanning direction (50%))
3) After executing the reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, check • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>100-RG (Color displacement correction value between RG
the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service in the vertical scanning direction (100%))
label. • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>100-GB (Color displacement correction value between GB
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto in the vertical scanning direction (100%))
execution) • COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL>OFST-P-Y (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value • COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-M (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
reference) • COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-C (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-K (Adjustment of test chart reading density)

4-37
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Separating the ADF Unit + Reader Unit > After replacing reader units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Roller Unit > Procedure
4-38
6) Read the image and execute the adjustment with the following service mode.
Removing the ADF Roller Unit
• FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
reading) ■■Procedure
• FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)

CAUTION:

Do not touch the surface of the roller.

1) Open the ADF Upper Cover [1].


[1]

F-4-62
2) Remove the gear [1] and the bushing [2].
• 1 claw [3]

[2] [1]

[3]

F-4-63

4-38
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Roller Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Roller Unit > Procedure
4-39
3) Remove the plastic E-ring [1] and slide the bushing [2].
CAUTION:

Be careful not to lose the spring [1] attached to the ADF Roller Unit.

[1]
[2]
[1]

F-4-64
4) Remove the ADF Roller Unit [1].
• 1 plastic E-ring [2]
F-4-66
• 1 bushing [3]

[2]
[3]
[1]

F-4-65

4-39
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Roller Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Roller > Procedure
4-40

CAUTION: Removing the ADF Pickup Roller


• When installing, match the spring [1] of the ADF Roller Unit to the boss [2]. ■■Preparation
1) Remove the ADF Roller Unit. Refer to page 4-38.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Do not touch the surface of the roller.

[2]
1) Insert the end of the flat-blade screwdriver into the [A] part to remove the ADF Pickup
Roller Unit [1].
[1]

F-4-67
• Be sure to put the Sensor Flag [1] above the ADF Roller Unit [2] at installation work.

[1]
[1]

[1]
[A]

F-4-69
2) Remove the ADF Pickup Roller [1].
[2] [2]
[1]
F-4-68

F-4-70

4-40
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Separation Roller > Procedure
4-41
Removing the ADF Separation Roller 3) Turn the Roller Shaft [1] in the direction of the arrow and fit the projection [2] to the hole of
the Roller Holder to remove.
■■Preparation
1) Remove the ADF Roller Unit. Refer to page 4-38. [2] [1]

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Do not touch the surface of the roller.

1) Remove the bushing [1] and the 2 plastic E-rings [2].

[2]
F-4-73
4) Remove the ADF Separation Roller [1].
[1]

[1]
F-4-71
2) Slide the Roller Shaft [1] to remove the parallel pin [2] and the bushing [3].
F-4-74

CAUTION:

Be careful not to lose the parallel pin [2] at assembly/disassembly.

[2]
[1]

F-4-72

4-41
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Separation Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Separation Pad > Procedure
4-42
Removing the ADF Separation Pad 3) Remove the Retaining Plate [1] On the Back of the Feed Guide.
• 2 Screws [2]
■■Procedure • 2 Tabs [3] of the Separation Pad Holder

[2]
CAUTION:
[1]
Do not touch the surface of the roller or pad. x2

1) Open the ADF Upper Cover [1].

[1]

[3]
F-4-77
4) Remove the Separation Pad Holder [1].

[1]

F-4-75
2) Remove the Feed Guide [1].
• 2 Bosses [2]

[2]
[1] [2]

F-4-78

F-4-76

4-42
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Separation Pad > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit > Procedure
4-43

CAUTION: Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit


Be careful not to lose the Spring [1] on the Separation Pad Holder. ■■Procedure
1) Open the ADF Upper Cover [1].
[1]

[1]

F-4-79

F-4-81

5) Remove the ADF Separation Pad [1]. 2) Remove the hook [1] using flat-head driver, and remove the ADF Front Cover [2] in the
• Pad Retainer [2] direction of the arrow.
• Sheet [3]

[2]
[2]

[3]

[1]

[1]

F-4-82

F-4-80

4-43
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit > Procedure
4-44
3) Lift the ADF Tray [1] until it stops and release the hook [2] to tip the tray into the 4) Remove the boss [1] to remove the ADF Rear Cover [2] in the direction of the arrow.
perpendicular position and remove by pulling upward. • 4 claws [3]

[1]
[1]
x4
[1]
[3]

[3]

[2]
[3]

F-4-84
5) Remove the harness [1] and the grounding cord [2].
• 1 screw (binding) [3]
• 4 connectors [4]
• 2 Harness Guide [5]

[1] [2]
[2]

F-4-83
[4]
x4
[4]
[5]
x2
[5]
[3]

F-4-85

4-44
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit > Procedure
4-45
6) Remove the 3 screws [1] of the ADF Pickup Feed Unit. 8) Remove the ADF Upper Cover Unit [1].
• 2 bosses [2]

[1]
x2 [2]

[1]

[2]

F-4-88

[1]

F-4-86
7) Close the ADF Upper Cover [1] to remove the ADF Pickup Feed Unit [2].

[2]

[1]

F-4-87

4-45
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Motor > Procedure
4-46
Removing the ADF Pickup Motor CAUTION:

■■Preparation • When installing the ADF Pickup Motor, be sure to hook the gear [1] of the motor on
the belt [2].
1) Remove the ADF Pickup Feed Unit. Refer to page 4-43

■■Procedure [2]

NOTE: [1]
When removing the ADF Pickup Motor, it is not necessary to remove the ADF Upper
Cover Unit described in the previous step.

1) Remove the ADF Motor [1] in the direction of the arrow.


• 2 screws [2]
• 1 belt [3]

[2] F-4-90

x2 [3]
• When installing the ADF Pickup Motor, be sure to install with the connector [1] on the
right side.

[1]

[1]

[2]
F-4-89

[1]

F-4-91

4-46
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the ADF Pickup Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > Procedure
4-47
Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover 2) Remove the Scoopup sheet holder [1].
• 2 claws [2]
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17. x2 [1]
3) Remove the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
4) Seaparare the ADF Unit from the Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-35.

■■Procedure
[2]
CAUTION:

Be sure to perform "After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit (Refer to page 4-48)"
when replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit, respectively.
F-4-93
3) Remove the Reader Unit Upper Cover [1].
• 2 screws [2]
• 5 claws [3]
CAUTION:

To replace the Copyboard Glass, be sure to replace the Copyboard Glass together with CAUTION:
the Reader Unit Upper Cover.
Because the Copyboard Glass [2] is attached to the Upper Cover [1], be careful not to
drop or damage the Upper Cover.

1) Remove the 3 screws [1] at the bottom of the Reader Unit.

[3] [2]
[1] [2]
x3
x2 [3]

x5

[3]
[1]
F-4-92
F-4-94

4-47
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
4-48
■■After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit 3) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
1) Enter the setting value of the Standard White Plate.
mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
1. White level adjustment
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
F-4-95
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X (X signal data for the standard white plate) 2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Y (Y signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Z (Z signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
MEMO using DF)
The value of W-PLT-X: The first four digits of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Y: The four digits in the middle of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Z: The last four digits of the value on the label

2) After executing the CCD reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1,
check the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the
service label.
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value
reference)

4-48
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4-49
Removing the CIS Unit 3) Remove the CIS Unit Mount [1] and remove the flat cable [2].
• 1 guide [3]
■■Preparation
CAUTION:
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17. • When assembling/disassembling the copyboard glass, take care not to lose the 2
3) Remove the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32. CIS unit spacers [1].
4) Separate the ADF Unit from the Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-35. • When assembling/disassembling the copyboard glass, do not touch the copy reading
5) Remove the Reader Unit Upper Cover Unit. Refer to page 4-47. area [2] of the CIS unit.

[2]
■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Be sure to perform "After replacing CIS unit(Refer to page 4-51)" when replacing the
CIS unit, respectively.
[1]

[1]
1) Pull the Drive Belt [1] to move the CIS Unit [2].
F-4-97
2) Loosen the screw [3] and move the Pulley Holder [4] in the direction of the arrow to remove
the Drive Belt [1].

[1] [3] [4] [3]


[1]

[2]
[2]

[1]

F-4-96
F-4-98

4-49
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4-50
4) Bring up the CIS Unit [1] to remove in the direction of the arrow.
CAUTION:

• When installing the CIS Unit [1], be sure to replace the CIS Spacer [2] together with
[1] the CIS Unit [1] (included in the pacage of the Service Parts).

[3]

F-4-99

CAUTION:

When replacing the CIS Unit [1], be sure to replace the CIS Unit [1] and the CIS Spacer F-4-101

[2], which are included in the package of the service part, at the same time. • When the CIS Spacers are mixed up or lost, check the CIS Rank Label [3] to use,
and use the appropriate CIS Spacer that fits the rank of the CIS Unit.
If a different spacer is used, image reading error may occur.
Rank Color of spacer Dimension (Height
of spacer)
rank A light gray 1.17 mm
rank B dark gray 1.27 mm
rank C brown 1.37 mm
T-4-18

[2]
[1]
[2]

F-4-100

4-50
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the CIS Unit > After replacing CIS units
4-51

CAUTION:
■■After replacing CIS units
1) Execute the white level adjustment. If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the
When installing the CIS Unit, be sure to check that the projection [1] is fitted to the dent [2]
operation again.
to install.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)

2) After executing the reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, check
the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service
label.
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value
reference)
[2] [1]
[2] [1]
3) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
F-4-102 the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
1. White level adjustment
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
using DF)

4-51
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the CIS Unit > After replacing CIS units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4-52
4) Execute the reading position adjustment with the following service mode.
Removing the Reader Scanner Motor
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>) ■■Preparation
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
position in FEEDER mode)
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)
3) Remove the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
4) Separate the ADF Unit from the Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-35.
5) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading.
5) Remove the Reader Unit Upper Cover Unit. Refer to page 4-47.
• FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
reading)
• FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment) ■■Procedure
1) Free the harness [2] while holding the Reader Unit [1].
• 1 Connector [3]
• 3 Harness Guides at the [A] location

CAUTION:

To prevent parts on the top side of the Reader Unit, do not tip the Reader Unit [1] into
the perpendicular position.

[1]

x3

[A] [2] [3]

F-4-103

4-52
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4-53
2) Pull the Drive Belt [1] to move the CIS Unit [2]. 5) Remove the Shaft Retaining Plate [1].
3) Loosen the screw [3] and move the Pulley Holder [4] in the direction of the arrow to remove • 1 screw [2]
the Drive Belt [1].

[1] [3] [4]


[1]

[2]

[2] [1]

F-4-104 F-4-106
4) Remove the gear [1]. 6) Move the Sensor Mount [1].
• 1 claw [2] • 1 screw [2]

[2]

[1]

[2]

[1]

[1]

F-4-105 F-4-107

4-53
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4-54
7) Move the Motor Mounting Plate [1] and turn it over.
• 2 screws [2]
• 1 Grounding Plate [3]

[2]
x2

[1]

[3]
F-4-108
8) Pass the connector [1] through the hole [A].
9) Remove the Reader Scanner Motor [3] from the Motor Mounting Plate [2].
• 2 screws [4]

[1]

x2 [4]

[A]

[3]
[2]

F-4-109

4-54
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document Exposure, Feed System > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (1/2)
4-55

Controller System

Location
■■(1/2)
[4] No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
[5] parts replacement
[1] Fixing Sub PCB Product UN7 (Refer to page 4-67) -
Configuration
[2] Main Controller Product - (Refer to page 4-61) -
[2] [3] [6] Support Plate Configuration
[1]

[3] FAX-NCU PCB Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-75) -


Configuration /8550Cdn
UN16
[4] Main Controller Product UN13 (Refer to page 4-58) (Refer to page 4-58)
PCB Configuration
[7] [5] Wireless LAN Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-57) -
PCB Configuration UN23
[6] Controller Cover Product - (Refer to page 4-57) -
Configuration
[7] Control Panel Product - (Refer to page 4-70) -
Unit Configuration
[8] Control Panel Control Panel UN20 (Refer to page 4-73) -
Key PCB Unit
[9] Control Panel Control Panel UN14 (Refer to page 4-73) -
LCD PCB Unit
[10] Fixing/Fixing Product FM1 (Refer to page 4-86) -
Power Supply Configuration
[11] Cooling Fan
[11] Duplex Feeding Rear Cover Rib FM2 (Refer to page 4-88) -
Fan Unit
T-4-19

[10]

[8]
[9]
F-4-110

4-55
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (1/2)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (2/2)
4-56
■■(2/2)
[13] No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
[14] parts replacement
[12] Relay PCB Product UN5 (Refer to page 4-69) -
[15]
Configuration
[13] Duplex Reverse Product - (Refer to page 4-85) -
[16] Drive Unit Configuration
[14] DC Controller Product UN1 (Refer to page 4-61) (Refer to page 4-61)
PCB Configuration
[17]
[12] [15] Off Hook PCB Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-75) -
Configuration /8550Cdn
UN17
[16] Speaker Product MF8580Cdw (Refer to page 4-89) -
Configuration /8550Cdn
SP1
[17] Driver PCB Product UN2 (Refer to page 4-68) -
Configuration
[18] Main Drive Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-76) -
Configuration
[19] Low Voltage Product - (Refer to page 4-65) -
Power Supply Configuration
[18] Unit
[20] High Voltage Product UN3 (Refer to page 4-63) -
[20] Power Supply Configuration
PCB
[19]
T-4-20
F-4-111

4-56
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (2/2)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8580Cdw) > Procedure
4-57
Removing the Controller Cover Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8580Cdw)
■■Preparation ■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. 1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57.
■■Procedure
1) Remove the Controller Cover [1].
■■Procedure
• 9 Screws [2] 1) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB [1].
• 2 Hooks [3] • 1 Screw [2]
• 1 Flat Cable [3]
[1]
[3]
[3] [1]
x9 [2] [2]

[3]

[2]

[2]
[2]

F-4-112

F-4-113

4-57
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8580Cdw) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > Procedure
4-58
Removing the Main Controller PCB ■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
CAUTION: 2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57.
3) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
Be sure to perform "Before Replacing the Main Controller PCB (Refer to page 4-58)"
when replacing the Main Controller PCB, respectively. ■■Procedure
1) Remove the Main Controller PCB [1].
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [2]
• 3 Flat Cables [3]
■■Before Replacing the Main Controller PCB
• 1 Flat Cable [4] (FAX model only)
Back up user data (settings, registered data, etc.) and service mode data for setting and • 6 Connectors [5]
registration after PCB replacement. Take notes if data is unable to back up. • 2 Connectors [6] (FAX model only)
1) In Remote UI, perform the following procedure to export the user data (login in • 1 Connector [7] (MF8540Cdn only)
administrator mode). • 6 Screws [8] (TP)
In Setting/Registration > Import/Export > Menu > Export, select an item and then start • 1 Screw [9] (Binding)
export. • 1 Hook [10]

2) In service mode, perform the following procedure to export the service mode data (and
then import it after replacement).
FUNCTION > SYSTEM > EXPORT

3) Record the default settings shown on the service label [1] (these are entered after
replacement).

4) Write down the machine's serial number and the data of Settings/Registration > System [2]

Settings > Device Information> Location (these are entered after replacement).
[3]
[10] [8]
[5]
x13 x7
[5]
[1]

[3] [5]
[9]
[6]

[1]
[4]
[5] [7] [5]
[8]
F-4-114 F-4-115

4-58
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > After replacing main controller PCB
4-59

CAUTION:
■■After replacing main controller PCB
1. Setting of destination/paper size group
Be sure to perform the following when connecting the Flat Cable [1] to the connector
1) COPIER > OPTION > BODY > LOCALE (to set destination groups)
with a lock [2].
[Settings]
Be sure to insert the Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after checking
that both sides (edges) [A] of the Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves [B] of the 1: Japan, 2: North America, 3: Korea, 4: China, 5: Taiwan, 6: Europe, 7: Asia,
connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3]. 8: Oceania
2) COPIER > OPTION > BODY > SIZE-LC (to set paper size groups)
[1] [1] [Settings]
1: AB series, 2: Inch series, 3: A series, 4: AB/Inch series
2. Clearing Setting/Registration data
[A]
1) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > ALL (to clear all data)
[A] [B]
Once executed, the following data are cleared according to the values of LOCALE and
[B] SIZE-LC set in step 1.
• Setting / Registration data (the default value for each destination is set).
[2] • Service mode data (the default value for each destination is set).
[2] [3]
• Job IDs
• Log data
[1] [1]
• Dates
2) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > R-CON (to clear default setting values for the
[A] reader/DF)
[A] [B] 3. Adjustment, input of default setting values
1) Close the ADF.
[B]
2) COPIER> FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC, BW-AGC (to adjust white levels)
The white level is adjusted.
[2] [3] [2] 3) Enter default setting values indicated on the service label in the corresponding service
mode items.
F-4-116
4) COPIER> FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN (to back up DC controller setting
values)
Purpose: to be prepared for replacing DC controller PCBs
5) Turn off and on the power.
6) Start in the initial installation mode. Follow instructions shown on the screen for setup.
(setting of date/time, auto-gradation correction)

4-59
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > After replacing main controller PCB
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > After replacing main controller PCB
4-60
4. Migrating the serial number 7. Reinstall the drivers.
1) Enter the serial number (8-digit alphanumeric) in Settings/Registration > System 1) Uninstalling Old Drivers.
Settings > Device Information > Location. • Printer Driver
2) Select COPIER > OPTION > SERIAL > SN-MAIN. Then, press the OK key to write the • FAX Driver
serial number entered in step 1 in the Main Controller PCB. After it has been written, • Scanner Driver
the serial number entered in "Location" in step 1 is deleted. • Network Scan Utility. (for machines with network connection)
3) Turn OFF and then ON the main power. * As for the procedure, refer to “Uninstalling the Software” in the Starter Guide.
4) Execute COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P> SPEC to output the spec report to check 2) Install the drivers which have been uninstalled in step 1.
the serial number BODY.No.. * As for the procedure, refer to the following items in the Starter Guide.
5) Enter the data of the installation location (which was written down in "Before replacing • In case of network connection: “Installing via Network Connection”
the Main Controller PCB") in Settings/Registration > System Settings > Device • In case of USB connection: “Installing with USB Connection”
Information > Location.
MEMO
MAC address information is changed after replacement of the Main Controller PCB.
5. Migrating user data
Therefore, when the PC and the machine are connected by the network, the PC will
In Remote UI, perform the following procedure to import the user data (login in not be able to recognize the machine on the network. When the PC and the machine
administrator mode). are connected by the USB memory device, the PC will not be able to recognize the
In Setting/Registration > Import/Export > Menu > Import, select an item and then start machine if the USB ID is changed. It becomes therefore necessary to reinstall the
driver.
import.

6. Migrating service mode data


In the case of a model without fax for EUR (MF8540/MF8230), perform the following works.
In service mode, perform the following procedure to import the service mode data.
FUNCTION > SYSTEM > IMPORT
MEMO
After replacing the Main Controller PCB, the value of the service mode (SDTM-DSP)
to set whether to display or hide the automatic shutdown menu becomes "0" (default
value).
In that case, the automatic shutdown menu is not displayed on the LUI of the machine.
To display the automatic shutdown menu on the LUI of the machine, it is necessary to
execute this process.

8. Setting of automatic shutdown menu display


Set 1 for automatic shutdown menu display in service mode (default: 0).
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > SDTM-DSP
9. Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
10. Checking the setting of Auto Sleep Time
In setting menu, check that the setting value of Auto Sleep Time is 1. (If the setting value is 0,
automatic shutdown does not work.)
Menu > Timer Settings > Auto Shutdown Time

4-60
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > After replacing main controller PCB
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the DC Controller PCB > Procedure
4-61
Removing the Main Controller Support Plate Removing the DC Controller PCB
■■Preparation
CAUTION:
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57. Be sure to perform "Before Replacing the DC Controller PCB (Refer to page 4-61)"
when replacing the DC Controller PCB, respectively.
3) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
4) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.

■■Procedure ■■Before replacing the DC Controller PCB


1) Free the harness [1] and Flat Cable [2], remove the Main Controller Support Plate [3]. 1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to store the DC Controller setting values.
• 1 Wire Saddle [4] COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN
• 3 Harness Guides [5]
• 7 Screws [6] ■■Preparation
• 2 Hooks [7]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
[7] [2] [1] [3] [7] 2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
[5]
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
x4 4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
[4]
x7
■■Procedure
[5]
1) Remove the Harness Cover Plate [1].
• 2 screws [2]

[6] [2]
[6]

F-4-117 x2

[2]

[1]

F-4-118

4-61
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the DC Controller PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the DC Controller PCB > After replacing DC Controller PCB
4-62
2) Disconnect the 5 flat cables [1]. ■■After replacing DC Controller PCB
1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to restore the DC Controller setting
values.
x5 COPIER > FUINCTION > VIFFNC > RSTR-DCN

[1]
MEMO
[1]
After executing the Printer Recovery Setting, be sure to wait for about 15 seconds
because of internal process/operation.

2) Turn OFF and then ON the power.


[1]
3)* Execute the following: Menu > Adjustment/Maintenance > Print Color Displacement
Correction
F-4-119 4)* Execute the following: Menu > Adjustment/Maintenance > Auto Gradation Correction >
3) Remove the DC Controller PCB [1]. Quick Correction
• 8 connectors [2] 5) Turn OFF and then ON the power.
• 5 screws [3]

[3]
[3]
x8 [2]
[2]

[3]
x5
[1]

[3]
[2]

[2]

F-4-120

4-62
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the DC Controller PCB > After replacing DC Controller PCB
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4-63
Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB 2) Remove the harness guide [1].
• 6 claws [2]
■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17. x6 [2]
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
[1]
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22. [2]
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
[2] [2]
■■Procedure
1) Remove the Harness Cover Plate [1].
• 2 screws [2] [2]
[2] F-4-122
3) Disconnect the flat cable [1].
x2

[1]

[2]

[1]

F-4-121

F-4-123

4-63
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4-64
4) Remove the 6 screws [1] and disconnect the connector [2].
CAUTION:
[2]
When installing the High-voltage Power PCB [1] to the host machine, make sure that
the contact spring [3] is connected from the 18 round holes [2].
x6

[1]

[1]

[1] [1]
F-4-124
[2] [3]
5) Remove the High Voltage Power Supply PCB [1].
• 9 claws [2] [1]
F-4-126
[2]

x10 [2]

[2]

[2]

[1]
F-4-125

4-64
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Unit > Procedure
4-65
Removing the Low Voltage Unit 3) Slide and open the Power Supply Unit [1] in the direction of the arrow.
• 6 Screws [2]
■■Preparation • 1 Screw [3] (Toothed washer screw)
• 2 Claws [4]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
2) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
3) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57. [4]
[4]
4) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57. x5
5) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58. x2 [2]
6) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.
7) Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit. Refer to page 4-86.

■■Procedure
1) Free the harness [1] from the guide [A].
• 1 Connector [2] [2] [3] [1]
2) Free the harness [3] from the guide [B]. [2]
• 1 Connector [4] F-4-128

3) Disconnect the connector [5] (FAX model only). 4) Remove 3 connectors [1].

[1]
x2 x2 [4]
[2] x3
[3]
[1]

[A]
[5]
[B] [3]

[1] [2]

F-4-127 F-4-129

4-65
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Unit > Procedure
4-66
5) Remove the Low Voltage Unit [1]
• 3 connectors [2]

x3
[1]

[2]

F-4-130

4-66
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing Sub PCB > Procedure
4-67
Removing the Fixing Sub PCB 2) Remove the wire harness [1], and remove the wire harness guide [2].
• 3 connectors [3]
■■Preparation • 4 fixing guides [4]
• 1 claw [5]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57.
[3]
3) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
4) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58. [5]
5) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61. x3
6) Removing the FAX PCB. Refer to page 4-75. [3]
7) Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit. Refer to page 4-86. [2]
x4
■■Procedure [1]
1) Remove the PCB Fixation Plate [1] (FAX model only).
• 2 Screws [2]
[4]

F-4-132
x2 3) Remove the Fixing Sub PCB [1].
[1] • 1 screw [2]
• 1 connector [3]

[1]

[2]
F-4-131
[2]

[3]

F-4-133

4-67
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing Sub PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4-68
Removing the Driver PCB 2) Remove the Driver PCB [1].
• 11 connectors [2]
■■Preparation • 1 Wire Saddle [3]
• 1 flat cable [4]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
• 3 screws [5]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
• 1 claw [6]
3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
[4]
8) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
9) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.

■■Procedure [6] [1]

1) Remove the flat cable guide case [1]. [2]


• 1 screw [2] x11
• 2 claws [3]

[3] [3]
[5]

[3]

x3

x2
[1]
[2]
[2] [5]

F-4-135

F-4-134

4-68
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Relay PCB > Procedure
4-69
Removing the Relay PCB 2) Remove the harness guide [1].
• 1 screw [2]
■■Preparation • 1 hook [3]

1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. [2]


2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.

■■Procedure [3]
1) Disconnect the flat cable [1] and the 7 connectors [2].

[2] [1]
[1]
x8 F-4-137
3) Remove the Relay PCB [1].
• 1 screw [2]
[2] • 1 harness guide [3]
• 1 protrusions [4]
[2]

[4] [3]
[2]

[1]
F-4-136

F-4-138

4-69
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Relay PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4-70
Removing the Control Panel Unit 1) Remove the claw [1] to remove the Reader Shaft Retainer [2].
2) While supporting the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [3], remove the Reader Support
■■Procedure Shaft [4].
3) Bring down the Reader Support Shaft [4] to close the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [3].

CAUTION:

When removing the Control Panel Unit, the Screw Face Seal [2] on the back side of the
Reader Unit [1] needs to be removed. Be sure to prepare a new Screw Face Seal to [3]
[1] [4]
reaffix it later.When reaffixing, be sure to use a new Screw Face Seal. Do not reuse the [2]
removed Screw Cover Seal.

[2]
[1]

F-4-140
4) ADF+Open the ADF+Reader Unit [1], and remove the 3 Screw Face Seals [2] at the bottom
of the Reader Unit.

CAUTION:

F-4-139 Do not reuse the removed Screw Cover Seal [2].

[2]
[1]

F-4-141

4-70
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4-71
5) Remove the screws at the bottom of the Reader Unit [1]. 7) Shift the Control Panel Unit [1], and disconnect the Faston Connector [2].
• 2 Binding Screw [2] • 14 Claws [3]
• 4 Screws [3]

[1]

x6
[2]

[3]
[2] [3]

[3]

x14
[1]

F-4-142
6) Open the ADF Unit/Copyboard [1] and place a sheet of paper [2] on the copyboard.

[1]
[3] [3]
F-4-144

[2]

F-4-143

4-71
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4-72

CAUTION: CAUTION:

Do not touch the IC part [A] of the LCD Flat Cable [1]. Be sure to perform the following when connecting the Flat Cable [1] to the connector
with a lock [2].
Be sure to insert the Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after checking
that both sides (edges) [A] of the Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves [B] of the
connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].

[1] [3] [2]


[B]
[2]
[A]

[B]
[A]
[1] [1]
F-4-145

[3] [2]
[B]
8) Turn the Control Panel Unit [1] over, and disconnect the Flat Cable [2]. [2]
[A]
CAUTION:

Do not damage and cut the Flat Cable [2].


[B]
[A]
[1] [1]
[3] F-4-147

[1]
[2]

F-4-146

4-72
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4-73
Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control 1) Remove the Control Panel LCD PCB [1].
• 1 Wire Saddle [2]
Panel Key PCB • 1 Connector [3]
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [4]
■■Preparation
• 1 LCD Flat Cable [5]
1) Remove the the Control Panel Unit. Refer to page 4-70 • 3 Screws [6]

[6]
■■Procedure
[2]
CAUTION: [4]

Do not touch the IC part [A] of the LCD Flat Cable [1].
x2

x3
[1] [1]
[3]
[5]

F-4-149
2) Remove the Control Panel LCD PCB Mounting Plate [1].
• 3 Screws [2] (Binding)

[1]

F-4-148
x3

[1]
F-4-150

4-73
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4-74
3) Remove the Control Panel Key PCB [1].
CAUTION:
• 10 Screws [2] (Binding)

[2] [2] [2] Be sure to perform the following when connecting the LCD Flat Cable [1] to the
connector with a lock [2].
Be sure to insert the LCD Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after
x10 checking that both sides (edges) [A] of the LCD Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves
[B] of the connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].

[3]
[2]
[B]
[2] [A]

[1]
[B]
F-4-151 [A]
[1] [1]

[3]
[2]
[B]
[2] [A]

[B]

[A] [1] [1]

F-4-152

4-74
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn) > Procedure
4-75
Removing the FAX PCB (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn) Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn)
■■Preparation ■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. 1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57. 2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57. 3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58. 4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61. 5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
■■Procedure
1) Remove the Fax PCB [1].
■■Procedure
• 1 Flat Cable [2] 1) Remove the Off Hook PCB [1].
• 1 Grounding Wire [3] • 2 Connector [2]
• 1 Connector [4] • 2 Screws [3]
• 4 Screws [5]

[3]

[4] x2
x3

x2
x4 [5] [2]
[5]
[1]
[2]
[1]

[5] [3]
[2] F-4-154

F-4-153

4-75
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-76
Removing the Main Drive Unit ■■Procedure
1) Remove the Harness Guide and plate [1].
■■Preparation
• 1 Connector [2]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. • 1 Harness Guide [A]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17. • 2 Screws [3]
3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
8) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
9) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.
10) Removing the Drum Motor. Refer to page 4-102.
11) Removing the Developing Motor. Refer to page 4-100
12) Removing the Driver PCB. Refer to page 4-10.
13) Removing the FAX PCB. (FAX model only)Refer to page 4-75.
14) Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit. Refer to page 4-86.
15) Removing the Fixing Sub PCB. Refer to page 4-67.
16) Removing the Fixing Motor Unit. Refer to page 4-111 [A] x2 [1]
17) Removing the Low Voltage Unit. Refer to page 4-65.
18) Removing the DC Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-61 [1]
19) Removing the Relay PCB. Refer to page 4-69
[3]
20) Removing the Off Hook PCB.(FAX model only)Refer to page 4-75

[3]
[2]

F-4-155

4-76
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-77
2) Free the harness [1]. 4) Free the harness [1] from the Harness Guide [A].
• 4 Harness Guides [A]

[A] [1]

x4
[1]

[A] [A]

[1]

F-4-156 F-4-158

3) Free the harness [1] from the guides [A] and [B] (MF8540Cdn only). 5) Free the harness [1] extruding out of the rear side [B] and [C] of the machine from the
Harness Guide [A].

x2

[1]
[B]

[1]
[1] [C]
[1]
[1]
[1]
[A] [A]
[B] [1]

F-4-157 F-4-159

4-77
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-78
6) Remove the Harness Guide and Power Auxiliary Plate [1]. 7) Remove the DC Controller Support Plate [1].
• 2 Screws [2] • 1 Special Flat-head Screw [2]
• 2 Black Screws [3]
• 3 Screws [4]
• 2 Bosses [5]
• 1 Protrusion [6]

CAUTION:
[1]
Since the Special Flat-head Screw [2] adjusts the interval between the plate [1] and
[1] parts in the vicinity, be sure to install the Special Flat-head Screw [2] in the location it
was in before removal.

[1] [1] [6] [2] [3] [4]

x2
x6
[3]

[5]

F-4-160

[5]
[4]
F-4-161

4-78
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-79
8) Remove the Main Switch Unit [1].
CAUTION:
• 2 Screws [2]
When installing, be sure to place the [A] part of DC Controller Support Plate under the [B] • 1 Hook [3]
part of the Harness Guide. • 1 Reuse Band [4]

[B] [A]

F-4-162
[3]
x2 [4]

[2]
[1] [1]

F-4-163

4-79
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-80
9) Remove the Main Switch Unit Connecting Plate [1]. 11) Remove the wire harness guide [1].
• 3 Screws [2] • 2 claws [2]
• 1 hook [3]
[2] [1]

x3 [2]
x2 [3]

[1]

[2]
[2]

F-4-164
F-4-166
10) Remove the Right Frame Supporting Plate [1].
12) Remove the sheet [1].
• 3 screws [2]
• 3 Hooks [2]

[2]
[2]

x3

[2]

[1]

F-4-167

[1] [2]

F-4-165

4-80
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-81
13) Free the harness [1] and [2] from the Harness Guide [A] and [B]. 15) Remove the wire harness [1] from the wire harness guide [2], and remove the wire
harness guide [2] in the arrow direction.
• 1 claw [3]
[B] • 2 fixing guides [4]
x2 [2]

[4]

[1] [A]
x2
[4]

[2]
[1] [2]

F-4-168
[1]
14) Remove the Harness Guide [1].
• Harness Guide [A]
[3]
• 2 Boss [2]
• 2 Hooks [3]
F-4-170

[1] [3]

[2] [2]

[A]

F-4-169

4-81
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-82
16) Remove the wire harness [1], and remove the Drive Unit [2].
CAUTION:
• 5 fixing guides [3]
When removing the Main Drive Unit, the Contact Spring [1] may come off so be sure • 1 Connector [4]
not to lose it. When it comes off, attach it on the protrusion [A] on the plate at the right • 6 screws [5]
side of the host machine. • 1 claw [6]

[3]
x5
[1]

[3]

[4]

[3]

[A]
[1]
[5]

[6]
F-4-171
x6
[5]

[5]
[5]
[2]

[5] [5]
F-4-172

4-82
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-83

CAUTION: Installing the Main Drive Unit 4) The directions of the groove [A] of the gear [1] of the Main Drive Unit and the groove
[B] of the Gear Cover of the Main Drive Unit are aligned.
1. Before installing it, be sure that the [Main Drive Unit side] is in the state of steps 1
through 4, while the [Host machine side] is in the state of steps 5 and 6. If the directions are not aligned, rotate the gear [2] to align the directions of the
groove [A] of the gear and groove [B] of the Gear Cover.

[Main Drive Unit side]


1) 4 Arm Shafts [1] are on the right side. [2]
[1] [1]
2) 1 Front Door Arm [2] is pulled out.
3) 1 link [3] is on the right side.
[A]
[A]

[B] [B]

[3]
[2]

[1] [1] [1] [1]

F-4-173

F-4-174

4-83
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-84

[Host machine side] 2.Be sure to keep the following in mind when installing.
5) The direction of the joint [1] on the host machine side is as shown in the figure below • Fit the joint [1] of the gear of the Main Drive Unit with the joint [2] of the host
(at this time, the hole [A] of the plate and hole [B] of the joint [1] are aligned in a machine.
straight line). • Fit the hole [3] of the link with the shaft [4] of the host machine.
If the direction is not correct, rotate the joint [1] to the direction as shown in the figure • Fit the hole [5] of the Front Door Arm with the shaft [6] of the host machine.
below.

[2] [1]

[1] [A] [1] [A]


[B]
[B]
[4] [3]
[5]

[6]

F-4-176

F-4-175

6) The Front Cover is open.

4-84
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Duplex Reverse Drive Unit > Procedure
4-85
Removing the Duplex Reverse Drive Unit CAUTION:

■■Preparation Be sure to insert the 2 harnesses [1] at the bottom of the Guide [A] when installing.

1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.


2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
5) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25.
6) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27.

■■Procedure [A] [A]

1) Remove the wire harness [1] from the wire harness cover [2].
• 2 connectors [3] [1] [1]

[3]
F-4-178
x2
[2]
2) Open [1] the Duplex Feed Unit, and remove the Duplex Reverse Drive Unit [2].
• 3 screws [3]

[1] x3
[1]
[3]
F-4-177
[2]

[1]

F-4-179

4-85
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Duplex Reverse Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit > Procedure
4-86
Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan 2) Remove the Cooling Fan Unit [1].
• 1 Connector [2]
Unit • 2 Screws [3]
• 2 Harness Guides [A]
■■Preparation
• 1 Harness Guide [B]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57.
3) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
4) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58. [B]
5) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.

[1]
■■Procedure [2]
1) Free the Grounding Wire [1] from the Harness Guide [A]. (Fax model only)
• 1 Connector [2] [3]
x2 [A]

[3]

F-4-181

[A]

[1]

[2]

F-4-180

4-86
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit > Procedure
4-87
3) Remove the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan [1].
• 1 claw [2]
• 2 protrusions [3]

[3]
[1]

[2]

F-4-182

CAUTION:

When installing the Cooling Fan, be careful of the installation direction.


• Place the Fan Cable [1] in the indicated position.
• Make sure that the fan label [2] faces to the inside of the host machine.

[1]

[2]

F-4-183

4-87
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Duplex Feeding Fan > Procedure
4-88
Removing the Duplex Feeding Fan 2) Free the harness [2] from the spring [1].

■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-25.
5) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25. [2]
6) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27.

■■Procedure
1) Remove the spring [1]. [1]
• 3 bosses [2]
F-4-185
3) Remove the fixing guide [1] and free the harness [2] from the harness guide.
• 3 fixing guides [3]
[1]

[2]
x3

[2]

[2]

[3]
F-4-184 [1]

F-4-186

4-88
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Duplex Feeding Fan > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Speaker (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn) > Procedure
4-89
4) Remove the 2 claws [1] to remove the Duplex Feeding Fan [2].
Removing the Speaker (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn)
[1]
■■Preparation
[2]
x2 1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57.

■■Procedure
1) Remove the Speaker [1].
• 1 connector [2]
[2] • 1 wire saddle [3]
• 2 claws [4]

F-4-187

CAUTION:

When installing the Duplex Feeding Fan, be careful of the installation direction. [4] [2]
• Place the Fan Cable [1] in the indicated position.
• Make sure that the fan label [2] faces to the Duplex Feeding Unit side.

x2
[2] [3]

[4] [1]

[1] F-4-189

F-4-188

4-89
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Speaker (MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-90

Laser Exposure System Removing the Laser Scanner Unit


■■Preparation
Location
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
[1] 3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
8) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25.
9) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27.
10) Removing the Duplex Printing Reverse Drive Unit. Refer to page 4-85.
11) Removing the Fixing Assembly. Refer to page 4-104.
12) Removing the Delivery Unit. Refer to page 4-128.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, be sure to perform the following procedure.
• After Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit (Refer to page 4-94)

F-4-190

No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during


parts replacement
[1] Laser Scanner Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-90) (Refer to page 4-94)
Configuration
T-4-21

4-90
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-91
2) Remove the Harness Guide [1] and free the harness [2] and the Flat Cable [3].
CAUTION:
• 2 Flat Cables [4]
The ITB Unit is under the Laser Scanner Unit. Ensure to close a Cartridge Tray when • 5 Connectors [5]
performing this procedure, because there is a possibility that the ITB Unit might be • 3 Fixation Guides [6]
damaged when the Laser Scanner Unit is mistakenly dropped during installation/ • 6 Claws [7]
removal.

[4] [5] [5] [5]


[1] x6
x3

[2] [3]
x2 [3]
[7]
[7] x5 [5]
[1]
[7]

[6]
[2]
[7]
F-4-193
3) Remove the Harness Guide [1].
F-4-191 • 1 Screw [2]
• 1 Spring [3]
• 2 Hooks [4]
1) Remove the wire harness cover plate [1].
• 2 screws [2]

[2]
[3]
[1]
x2

[2]
[2]

[1] [4]

F-4-194

F-4-192

4-91
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-92
4) Remove the Upper Front Supporting Plate [1].
CAUTION:
• 4 screws [2]
Be sure to put the flag [1] of the Harness Guide through the hole [A] of the plate, and [2]
hook the spring [2] on the flag [3] of the Laser Scanner Unit when installing.

x4
[2]

[1]

F-4-197
[A] [1]

F-4-195

[2] [3]

F-4-196

4-92
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-93
5) Remove the Scanner Fixing Spring [1] on the right side from 1 hook [2]. 7) Remove the Scanner Fixing Spring [1] in the rear from 1 hook [2].
6) Remove the Scanner Fixing Spring [3] on the left from the 1 hook [4].

[1] [2]
[1]

[2]

F-4-199

8) Remove the Laser Scanner Unit [1].


[3]
[1]

[4]

F-4-198

F-4-200

4-93
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > After replacing laser exposure units
4-94
MAI-S-K0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 K)
CAUTION::
MAI-S-Y1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 Y)
Insert 2 bosses [1] into 2 boss holes [2] when installing. MAI-S-M1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 M)
MAI-S-C1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 C)
MAI-S-K1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 K)
[1] MAI-S-Y2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 Y)
MAI-S-M2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 M)
[2]
MAI-S-C2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 C)
MAI-S-K2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 K)

2) After values are registered, affix the label [1] packaged with the unit on the inside [2] of the
right cover.
• MF8500 series

[2] [1]
[1]
F-4-201

■■After replacing laser exposure units


1) Register values indicated on the label packaged with the Laser Scanner Unit in the
following service mode items.
COPIER>ADJUST>SCNR>
SUB-S-Y0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 Y)
SUB-S-M0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 M)
SUB-S-C0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 C) F-4-202

SUB-S-K0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 K)


SUB-S-Y1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 Y)
SUB-S-M1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 M)
SUB-S-C1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 C)
SUB-S-K1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 K)
SUB-S-Y2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 Y)
SUB-S-M2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 M)
SUB-S-C2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 C)
SUB-S-K2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 K)
MAI-S-Y0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 Y)
MAI-S-M0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 M)
MAI-S-C0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 C)

4-94
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > After replacing laser exposure units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-95

Image Formation System Removing the ITB Unit


■■Preparation
Location
1) Removing the Cartridge Tray. Refer to page 4-30.

[1]
■■Procedure
[2]

[3] CAUTION:

Be sure not to touch the surface of the ITB and the Secondary Transfer Roller when
disassembling/assembling.

1) Pull out the Patch Density/Registration Sensor Unit [1] toward the front.
• 2 Screws [2]
• 2 Bosses [3]
[5] • 2 Protrusions [4]

[2]
[2]
[3] [1]
x2 [3] [1]

[4]

F-4-203

No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment


during parts
replacement [4]
[1] ITB Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-95) -
Configuration F-4-204
[2] Drum Motor Main Drive M1 (Refer to page 4-102) -
Unit NOTE:
[3] Developing Motor Main Drive M2 (Refer to page 4-100) - When it is difficult to pull out the Patch Density/Registration Sensor Unit toward the
Unit front and there is a risk of contact with the ITB, refer to "Removing the Patch Density
[4] Patch Density/Registration Product - (Refer to page 4-98) - and Registration Sensor Unit" so that the Patch Density/Registration Sensor Unit [1]
Sensor Unit Configuration can be further pulled out. (Refer to page 4-98)
[5] Secondary Transfer Outer Secondary - (Refer to page 4-103) -
Roller Transfer Feed
Unit
T-4-22

4-95
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-96
2) Disconnect the connector [1].
CAUTION:

Be careful not to hit the ITB [1] against the Patch Density/Registration Sensor Unit [2] at
the lower side and the frame [3] at the upper side when installing/removing.

[1] [3] [1]

F-4-205
3) Lift the 2 parts [A] at the front side of the ITB Unit to release the 2 protrusions [1].
[2]
[A]
F-4-207

[1] [1]

F-4-206

4-96
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-97
4) Open the Rear Cover [1].
CAUTION:
5) Hold the 2 parts [A] at the front side of the ITB Unit to tilt the ITB Unit [2].
6) Slide the 2 parts [B] at the rear side of the ITB Unit along the rails [3], and remove the ITB Be sure to install the harness [1] to the guide [A] of the ITB Unit when installing.
Unit [2] by pulling it out.

[3] [B]

[1] [A]
[1]
[2]
F-4-209
[A]
[A]

[B] [3]

F-4-208

4-97
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Patch Density and Registration Sensor unit > Procedure
4-98
Removing the Patch Density and Registration Sensor 2) Move the Patch Density and Registration Sensor Unit [1].
• 2 Screws [2]
unit • 2 Bosses [3]
• 2 Protrusions [4]
■■Preparation
[2]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
[3]
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24. x2
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32. [2]
[3]
5) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB. Refer to page 4-63. [4]
8) Removing the Cartridge Tray. Refer to page 4-30.
[1] [1]
[4]
■■Procedure

CAUTION: F-4-211

Be sure not to touch the surface of the ITB and the Secondary Transfer Roller when 3) Disconnect the connector [1].
disassembling/assembling.

1) Remove 1 connector [1], and remove the wire harness [2] from the wire harness guide [3].
• 8 fixing guides [4]
[1]
[2]
[2]
[1]
x5 x3

[4] F-4-212

[4]
[3]
F-4-210

4-98
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Patch Density and Registration Sensor unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Patch Density and Registration Sensor unit > Procedure
4-99
4) Lift the 2 parts [A] at the front side of the ITB Unit to release the 2 protrusions [1].
NOTE:
When it is difficult to put the connector [1] of the Patch Density/Registration Sensor Unit
[2] through the hole [A], refer to the following steps to remove the Front Cover Link Arm
[A] (Left) so that the connector [1] can be put through the hole [A] more easily.

●● Removing the Front Cover Link Arm (Left)


1) Remove the Front Cover. (Refer to page 4-23)
2) Lift the Patch Density/Registration Sensor Unit [1] to remove the Front Cover Link Arm (Left)
[2].
[1] [1] • 3 Screws [3]

[2] [1] [1]

x1

F-4-213
5) Put the connector [1] through the hole [A] and remove the Patch Density/Registration Patch
Sensor Unit [2].
[3]
F-4-215

[A]

[1]

[2]

F-4-214

4-99
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Patch Density and Registration Sensor unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Developing Motor > Procedure
4-100
Removing the Developing Motor ■■Procedure
1) Remove the fixing guide [1] and the wire harness [2].
■■Preparation
• 1 screw [3]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. • 11 connectors [4]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
x8
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8580Cdw only). Refer to page 4-57.
[4]
8) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
[4]
9) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.

[4]

[1]
[2]

[4]
[3]

x2

[4]
F-4-216

4-100
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Developing Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Developing Motor > Procedure
4-101
2) Remove the wire harness guide [1].
CAUTION:
• 1 claw [2]
• 2 hooks [3] Be sure to identify the Drum Motor and the Developing Motor by the difference in gears.
• Gear [1] of the Drum Motor: White, with a groove [A] on its side
[2] [1]
• Gear [2] of the Developing Motor: Black, with no groove

[1] [2]

[3]
[3]

F-4-217 [A]
3) Remove the Developing Motor [1].
• 3 screws [2]
F-4-219

[1]
x3

[2]

F-4-218

4-101
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Developing Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Drum Motor > Procedure
4-102
Removing the Drum Motor ■■Procedure
1) Remove the fixing guide [1] and the wire harness [2].
■■Preparation
• 1 screw [3]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. • 11 connectors [4]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
x8
6) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB (MF8580Cdw only). Refer to page 4-57.
[4]
8) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
[4]
9) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.

[4]

[1]
[2]

[4]
[3]

x2

[4]
F-4-220

4-102
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Drum Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Drum Motor > Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
4-103
2) Remove the wire harness guide [1].
CAUTION:
• 1 claw [2]
• 2 hooks [3] Be sure to identify the Drum Motor and the Developing Motor by the difference in gears.
• Gear [1] of the Drum Motor: White, with a groove [A] on its side
[2] [1]
• Gear [2] of the Developing Motor: Black, with no groove

[1] [2]

[3]
[3]

F-4-221 [A]
3) Remove the Drum Motor [1].
• 3 screws [2]
F-4-223

[1]
x3
■■Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller

CAUTION:

Secondary Transfer Outer Roller is included in Secondary Transfer FeedUnit so when


replacing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller, be sure toreplace the Secondary
Transfer Feed Unit itself. Refer to page 4-127.
[2]

F-4-222

4-103
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Drum Motor > Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4-104

Fixing System Removing the Fixing Assembly


■■Preparation
Location
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
[1] [2]
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
5) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25.
6) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27.
7) Removing the Duplex Printing Reverse Drive Unit. Refer to page 4-85.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

When removing the fixing unit, be sure to turn OFF the power.
Since the fixing assembly is extremely hot just after the printing, do not handle it unless
it cools down completely.
If you touch the high-temperature assembly, it may cause a burn.

1) Remove the claw [2] of the harness guide [1] and disconnect the connector [3].

[3]
[3]
[4]
F-4-224

No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment


during parts
replacement
[1] Fixing Assembly Product - (Refer to page 4-104) - [2]
Configuration
[2] Fixing Motor Unit Product M4 (Refer to page 4-111) -
Configuration
[1]
[3] Fixing Pressure Roller Fixing - (Refer to page 4-110) -
Assembly
[4] Fixing Film Unit Fixing - (Refer to page 4-106) -
F-4-225
Assembly
T-4-23

4-104
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4-105
2) Free the harness [1] from the harness guide [2]. 3) Remove the Fixing Assembly [1].
• 3 connectors [3] • 2 screws [2]
• 2 fixing guides [4]
• 1 wire saddle [5]

[1]
x2
[4] [2]

x3 [5]

x3 [3]
[1]

[2]
[2] [3]
F-4-228

F-4-226

CAUTION:

When the fixing assembly is installed, handle the harness [1] like the figure to prevent
papers from the interference at the transit

[1]

[1]

F-4-227

4-105
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-106
Removing the Fixing Film Unit 2) Remove the gear [1], 2 Parallel Pins [2], E-Ring [3], cam [4], and bushing [5].
• 1 Claws [6]
■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. [5]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
5) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25. [2]
[4]
6) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27. [1] [3]
7) Removing the Duplex Printing Reverse Drive Unit. Refer to page 4-85. [2]
[6]
8) Removing the Fixing Assembly. Refer to page 4-104.

■■Procedure
1) Remove the 2 Pressure Springs [1] on the right and left and the 2 Pressure Plates [2].
F-4-230
• 4 Hooks [3]
• 4 Bosses [4]
CAUTION:
• 2 Protrusions [5]
At installation, be sure to match the direction of the cam [4] with that of the cam [6] on
[5] [4] [3] [3] [4] the other side of the Fixing Assembly.

[5]

[6]
[4]
[2]

[2]

[3] [1] [1] [3]

F-4-229 [4]

F-4-231

4-106
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-107
3) After sliding the shaft [1] to remove the Parallel Pins [2] and the cam [3], remove the shaft [1]
CAUTION:
and the Sensor Flag [4].
Be sure to prevent the guide [1] from hitting against the Fixing Film Unit [2] when
installing/removing.
[1] [4] [3] [2]
[2] [1]

F-4-232

CAUTION:
F-4-234

At installation, be sure to align the protrusion of the cam [1] with the groove of the
Sensor Flag [2].
4) While securing the harness [1] to the guide [A], remove the harness [1] and the guide [2].
• Harness Guide [B]

[2]

[1]

F-4-233

[1] [2] [B] [A]

F-4-235

4-107
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-108
5) Free the harness (black) [1] from the Harness Guide [A], [B], [C] and [D]. 8) Remove the harness [1] and the guide [2].
• 1 Claws [3]
[A] [B] [D] • 2 Bosses [4]

[1]

[C]

F-4-236
6) Free the harness (purple) [1] from the Harness Guide [A] and [C]. [3]

7) Free the harness (green) [2] from the Harness Guide [A], [C] and [D]. [1]

[2]
[A] [D]

[1]

[4] [2] [4]

F-4-238

[2] [1] [C]

F-4-237

4-108
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-109
9) Remove the spring [1] and the Fixing Film Unit [2].
CAUTION:
• 2 Hooks [3]
When installing/removing the Fixing Film Unit, be sure not to touch the Fixing Film [1]. • Harness Guide [A]

[1] [2]

[A]
F-4-239
[3]

[3] [1]

F-4-240

CAUTION:

Be careful not to lose the spring because the spring is small.

4-109
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller > Procedure
4-110
Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller ■■Procedure
■■Preparation CAUTION:
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
Be sure not to touch the surface of the Fixing Pressure Roller.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24. 1) Remove the Fixing Pressure Roller [1].
5) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25. • 2 Bushings [2]
6) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27. • 1 Gear [3]
7) Removing the Duplex Printing Reverse Drive Unit. Refer to page 4-85.
8) Removing the Fixing Assembly. Refer to page 4-104. [3]

9) Removing the Fixing Film Unit. Refer to page 4-106.


[1]

[2]

F-4-241

4-110
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Motor Unit > Procedure
4-111
Removing the Fixing Motor Unit ■■Procedure
1) Free the harness [1] to remove the Sub Power Supply PCB Holder [2].
■■Preparation
• 2 Claws [3]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. • 2 Bosses [4]
2) Removing the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-57.
3) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
4) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
5) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.
6) Removing the FAX PCB. Refer to page 4-75.
7) Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit. Refer to page 4-86.
8) Removing the Fixing Sub PCB. Refer to page 4-67.

x2 [1]
[3]

x2 [2]

[4] [4]

F-4-242

4-111
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Motor Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Motor Unit > Procedure
4-112
2) Remove the Fixing Motor unit [1].
CAUTION:
• 3 screws [2]
In installation, put the edge of the spring [1] and the projection [2] of the gear into the
hole on the sheet metal.

x3

[2]

[1]
[1]

F-4-243 [2]

CAUTION:
F-4-245

When removing the Fixing Motor Unit, do not lose the spring [1] in the backside.

[1]

F-4-244

4-112
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Motor Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System
4-113

Pickup Feeder System


■■Location

[4] No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment


[3]
during parts
replacement
[2] [1] Cassette Separation Roller Paper Pickup - (Refer to page 4-115) -
Unit
[2] Cassette Pickup Roller Paper Pickup - (Refer to page 4-114) -
Unit
[3] Paper Pickup Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-120) -
Configuration
[1] [5] [4] Pickup Motor Product M5 (Refer to page 4-118) -
Configuration
[5] MP Paper Pickup Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-125) -
Configuration
[6] [6] MP Paper Pickup Roller MP Paper - (Refer to page 4-117) -
Pickup Roller
Unit
[7] MP Separation Pad MP Paper - (Refer to page 4-117) -
[7]
Pickup Unit
[8]
[8] Delivery Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-128) -
Configuration
[9] Secondary Transfer Feed Product - (Refer to page 4-127) -
[9] Unit Configuration
[10] Duplex Feed Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-130) -
Configuration
[11] Re-Pickup Guide Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-131) -
Configuration
T-4-24

[10]
[11]

F-4-246

4-113
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller > Procedure
4-114
Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller 6) Place a host machine [1] as the Left Cover faces to the bottom.

■■Procedure CAUTION:

When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
CAUTION: from opening. In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the
main body to its original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause
Be sure not to touch the surface of the Cassette Pickup Roller [1] and the Cassette
damage on the main body or injuries by catching the fingers.
Separation Roller [2].

[1] [2]

[1]

F-4-247

F-4-248

1) Turn ON the power switch.


2) Execute the following items in Service mode.
COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > FD-R-CHG
3) The Pickup Roller rotates and stops at the replacement position.
4) Disconnect the Inlet Connector.
5) Remove the cassette.

CAUTION:

Before tilting a host machine, remove toner cartridges (Y, M, C, Bk).

4-114
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4-115
7) Open 2 projections [1], and remove the Pickup Roller [2].
Removing the Cassette Separation Roller
• 2 Claws [3]
• 2 Hooks [4] ■■Procedure

CAUTION:

x2 Be sure not to touch the surface of the Cassette Pickup Roller [1] and the Cassette
Separation Roller [2].
[1] [4]

[1] [2]

[2]

[1] [3]

F-4-249
8) After replacing the Pickup Roller, turn ON the power, and return it to its original position
from the replacement position.

F-4-250

CAUTION:

When tilting the host machine, remove the Toner Cartridge (Y, M, C, Bk) beforehand.

1) Remove the cassette.

4-115
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4-116
2) Make the Left Cover face down and place the host machine [1]. 4) Open the Holder [1] remove the Cassette Separation Roller [2].
• 2 Claws [3]
CAUTION: • 1 projection [4]

When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
from opening.
In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the main body to its x2 [3]
original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause damage on the main
body or injuries by catching the fingers.

[2]

[1] [4]
[1] [3]
F-4-253

CAUTION:

At installation, be sure to align the protrusion [A] of the Cassette Separation Roller [2]
with the groove [B] of the holder while opening the holder [1].

[B]
[2]

F-4-251
3) Remove the 2 projections [1] to remove the Cover [2].
[1]

[1]
[2]

[A]

[1] F-4-254

F-4-252

4-116
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the MP Tray Separation Pad > Procedure
4-117
Removing the MP Tray Pickup Roller Removing the MP Tray Separation Pad
■■Procedure ■■Procedure

CAUTION: CAUTION:

Do not touch the surface of the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller. Do not touch the surface of the Multi-purpose Tray Separation Pad.

1) Put a Screwdriver into the gap [2] between the MP Tray Separation Pad [1] and the Pad
1) Turn ON the power switch.
Holder.
2) Execute the following items in Service mode.
COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > FD-R-CHG
3) The Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller rotates to the replacement position.
4) Remove the cassette. [2]
5) Lower the Multi-purpose Tray [1]. [1]
6) Remove the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller [2].
• 2 Claws [3]
• 2 Shafts [4]

x2 [3]

[2] F-4-256
2) Turn the Screwdriver in the direction of the arrow to remove the MP Tray Separation Pad [1].
[4] • 4 claws [2]
[3]

[1]
[1]
x4
F-4-255
7) After replacing the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller, turn OFF and then ON the power, and
then return it to its original position from the replacement position.

[2]

F-4-257

4-117
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the MP Tray Separation Pad > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Motor > Procedure
4-118
Removing the Pickup Motor ■■Procedure
1) Remove the wire harness [2] from the wire harness guide [1].
■■Preparation
• 8 connectors [3]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. • 1 Wire Saddle [4]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17. • 10 fixing guides [5]
3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32. [3]
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
6) emoving the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
x4
7) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
8) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
9) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.
10) Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit. Refer to page 4-86
[5]

[3]

[5]
[5]

x9 x4
[4]

[3]
[5]

[2]

[5]
[5]
[1]

F-4-258

4-118
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Motor > Procedure
4-119
2) Free the harness [1] and [2] from the Harness Guide [A] and [B]. 4) Remove the Pickup Motor [1].
• 2 Screws [2]
• 1 Connector [3]
[B]
x2 [2]

[2] [3]
x2 [1]
[1] [A]

[1] [2]

F-4-259
3) Remove the Harness Guide [1].
• Harness Guide [A]
• 2 Boss [2]
• 2 Hooks [3] F-4-261

[1] [3]

[2] [2]

[A]

F-4-260

4-119
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-120
Removing the Pickup Unit 1) Remove the wire harness [2] from the wire harness guide [1].
• 8 connectors [3]
■■Preparation • 1 Wire Saddle [4]
• 10 fixing guides [5]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
[3]
3) Removing the Right Front Cover. Refer to page 4-22.
4) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
5) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24. x4
6) emoving the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
7) Removing the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8580Cdw only) Refer to page 4-57.
8) Removing the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-58.
9) Removing the Main Controller Support Plate. Refer to page 4-61.
[5]
10) Removing the Fixing/Fixing Power Supply Cooling Fan Unit. Refer to page 4-86

[3]
■■Procedure [5]
[5]
CAUTION:
x9 x4
Be sure not to touch the Secondary Transfer Roller [1] and the ITB [2].
[4]

[3]
[5]
[2]
[2]

[5]
[5]
[1]
[1]

F-4-263

F-4-262

4-120
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-121
2) Free the harness [1] and [2] from the Harness Guide [A] and [B]. 4) Release 2 claws [1], and turn the guide [2] to align the hook [4] with the hole on the arm [3],
and remove the arm [3].
• 3 hooks [5]
[B]
x2 [2]

[1]
[1]
x2
[A]
[4]

[1] [2]

F-4-264 [2]
3) Remove the Harness Guide [1]. [3]
[5]
• Harness Guide [A]
• 2 Boss [2] F-4-266

• 2 Hooks [3]
CAUTION:

[1] [3] For protection, install each cover before tilting the machine.
• Close the Rear Cover [1].
• Install the Upper Cover [2].
• Install the Left Cover [3].
• Close the Front Cover [4].

[2] [2]
[2]

[A]

F-4-265 [1]

[4]
[3]

F-4-267

4-121
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-122
5) Please the machine as the Left Cover faces to the bottom. 7) Remove the 2 arms [1] and the 2 springs [2].
• 2 Shafts [3]
• 5 Hooks [4]

[1] [4]

[3] [1] [2] [4]

F-4-268
[3] [4] [2]
6) Remove the 2 stoppers [2].
• 2 Bosses [3]

[3] [2]

[1] [4]

F-4-270
8) Put the harness [1] through the hole [A] of the Side Plate, and remove the Pickup Unit [2].
• 6 Screws [3]

[3] [1]

x6

[1]
[3] [2]
[2]
[A]
F-4-269 [3]
F-4-271

4-122
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Installation Method
4-123
■■Installation Method 2) Place the edge [A] of the guide of the Pickup Unit over the spring [1] of the host machine.

CAUTION:

Be sure not to touch the Pickup Roller [1] and the Secondary Transfer Roller [2].

[2]

[A] [A]

[1]
F-4-272

1) Open the Rear Cover [1], Put the harness [2] through the hole [A] of the Side Plate, and
[1] [1]
Install the Pickup Unit [3] to the host machine.

[2] F-4-274

[A]
[3] [1]
F-4-273

4-123
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Installation Method
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Installation Method
4-124
3) Place the Sensor Flag Cover [B] of the Pickup Unit over the plate [C] of the Roller Unit of 4) Place the edge [D] of the Feed Guide of the Pickup Unit over the edge [E] of the Roller Unit
the host machine. of the host machine.

[C] [D]

[D] [E]
[E]

[B] [C] [B]

F-4-275 F-4-276
5) Align the 4 protrusions [1], and secure the Pickup Unit with the 6 screws [2].

[2]

x6 [1]

[1]

[2]
F-4-277

4-124
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Installation Method
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-125
Removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit 3) Move the MP Tray Pickup Unit [1] in the direction of the arrow.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

When tilting the host machine, make sure to remove the Toner Cartridge (Y, M, C, Bk)
beforehand.

1) Remove the cassette.


2) Make the Left Cover face down and place the host machine [1].
[1]
CAUTION:
F-4-279
When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
from opening.
In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the main body to
its original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause damage on the
main body or injuries by catching the fingers.

[1]

F-4-278

4-125
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-126
4) Remove the 2 Links [1] (left and right) from the bushings [2] of the MP Tray Pickup Unit. 5) Push a flat-blade screwdriver to the stopper [1] and remove the MP Tray Pickup Unit [2] in
the direction of the arrow.
CAUTION:

When removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit, be careful not to lose the link.
[2] [1]

[1]

[2]

[2]

F-4-281

[2]

[1]

F-4-280

4-126
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the MP Tray Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit > Procedure
4-127
Removing the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit 2) Remove the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit [1].
• 1 screw [2]

CAUTION: CAUTION:
Secondary Transfer Outer Roller is included in Secondary Transfer Feed Unit so when When removing the screw, be careful not to lose the guide cap [1] because the guide
replacing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller, be sure to replace the Secondary cap is removed together with the
Transfer Feed Unit itself.

■■Procedure
1) Open the Rear Cover [1].

[1]
we r c s

[1]

F-4-283

[1]

F-4-282

[2]

F-4-284

4-127
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Delivery Unit > Procedure
4-128
Removing the Delivery Unit 2) Release the 2 claws [1], and disconnect the connector [2].

■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. x2
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
[1] [1]
3) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
4) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
5) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25.
6) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. .Refer to page 4-27
7) Removing the Duplex Printing Reverse Drive Unit. Refer to page 4-85.
8) Removing the Fixing Assembly. Refer to page 4-104. [2]
9) Removing the ADF Unit + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-32.
10) Removing the Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-28.
F-4-286
3) Remove the wire harness [1] from the wire harness guide.
■■Procedure • 3 connectors [2]
1) Remove the frame [1]. • 6 fixing guides [3]
• 6 screws [2]

[2]
[1]

x6 x3 x6 [3]
[2]
[2]

[2] [2] [3]


[1]
[2]

F-4-287

F-4-285

4-128
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Delivery Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Delivery Unit > Procedure
4-129
4) Remove the Delivery Unit [1].
• 3 screws [2]

[2]

x3 [2]

[1]

F-4-288

4-129
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Delivery Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Duplex Feed Unit > Procedure
4-130
Removing the Duplex Feed Unit ■■Procedure
1) Shift the Duplex Feed Unit [1] in the direction of the arrow and remove the 2 bearings [2].
■■Preparation
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit. Refer to page 4-127.
4) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
5) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
6) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25.

[2]
[2]
[1]
F-4-289

2) Align the claw [1] with the hole of the link [2] and remove the Duplex Feed Unit [3] in the
direction of the arrow.

[3]

[1]

[2]

F-4-290

4-130
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Duplex Feed Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Re-pickup Guide Unit > Procedure
4-131
Removing the Re-pickup Guide Unit ■■Procedure
1) Remove the Re-pickup Guide Unit [1].
■■Preparation
• 3 connectors [2]
1) Removing the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-20. • 4 screws [3]
2) Removing the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-17.
3) Removing the Secondary Transfer Feed Unit. Refer to page 4-127.
[3]
4) Removing the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-24.
5) Removing the Rear Cover. Refer to page 4-24. [3] [1]
x3
6) Removing the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-25.
7) Removing the Rear Cover Rib Unit. Refer to page 4-27.
8) Removing the Duplex Feed Unit. Refer to page 4-130.
x4
[3]

[2]

[3]

F-4-291

CAUTION:

Be sure to insert the 2 harnesses [1] at the bottom of the Guide [A] when installing.

[A] [A]

[1] [1]

F-4-292

4-131
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Re-pickup Guide Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External / Internal Cover(MF8200 series) > Front Side
4-132

List of Parts

List of External / Internal Cover(MF8200 series)


■■Front Side
[3] [4] No. Parts Name Remarks Reference
[2] [5]
[22] [1] ADF Front Upper Cover MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
[6] /8240Cw/8230Cn
[1]
[7] [2] ADF Upper Cover MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[8] [3] Side Guide (Front) MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
[13]
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[4] Side Guide (Rear) MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[12] [5] Document Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[6] Extension Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[7] Sub Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[9] [8] Delivery Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
[11] /8240Cw/8230Cn
[10] [9] Right Cover - (Refer to page 4-147)
[10] Multi-Purpose Tray Pickup Cover - -
[11] Paper Guide - -
[12] Control Panel Lower Cover - -
[14] [13] Control Panel - (Refer to page 4-196)
[14] Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-156)
[15] [15] USB Port - -
[21] [16] Right Front Cover - -
[17] Front Cover - (Refer to page 4-150)
[18] Cassette - -
[19] Mulyi-Purpose Tray Transport - (Refer to page 4-237)
Guide
[20] Left Cover - (Refer to page 4-144)
[20] [21] Reader Cover - -
[22] Platen Cover MF8210Cn -
T-4-25
[16]
[17]
[18]
[19]

F-4-293

4-132
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External / Internal Cover(MF8200 series) > Front Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External / Internal Cover(MF8200 series) > Rear Side
4-133
■■Rear Side
[10] [1]
[9]

[8]
[2]

[7]

[6] [3]
[5]
[4]
F-4-294

No. Parts Name Remarks Reference


[1] ADF Rear Cover MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[2] Rear Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-153)
[3] Rear Cover - (Refer to page 4-155)
[4] Rear Lower Cover - (Refer to page 4-154)
[5] Power Socket - -
[6] Telephone Line Jack - -
[7] External Device Jack - -
[8] Handset Terminal - -
[9] LAN Port - -
[10] USB Port - -
T-4-26

4-133
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of External / Internal Cover(MF8200 series) > Rear Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Main Unit (MF8200 series) > 2/2
4-134
List of Main Unit (MF8200 series) ■■2/2
■■1/2
[7]
[1]
[8]

[2]

[3]
[9]

[4] [10]

[13]

[6]
[5] [12]

F-4-295
[11]
No. Parts Name Remarks Reference Adjastment during
parts replacement
F-4-296
[1] ADF Unit MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-160) (Refer to page 4-36)
/8240Cw/8230Cn No. Parts Name Remarks Reference Adjastment during
[2] Platen Cover MF8210Cn - - parts replacement
[3] Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-160) (Refer to page 4-37) [7] Sub Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-209) -
[4] Control Panel Unit - (Refer to page 4-196) - [8] Main Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-202) -
[5] Multi-purpose Tray Unit - (Refer to page 4-237) - [9] Low Voltage Power Supply Unit - (Refer to page 4-190) -
[6] Pickup Unit - (Refer to page 4-242) - [10] Fixing Power Supply Unit - (Refer to page 4-195) -
T-4-27 [11] ITB Unit - (Refer to page 4-218) -
[12] Laser Scanner Unit - (Refer to page 4-213) (Refer to page 4-94)
[13] Fixing Assembly - (Refer to page 4-225) -
T-4-28

4-134
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Main Unit (MF8200 series) > 2/2
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/speaker (MF8200 series)
4-135
List of Motor/Fan (MF8200 series) List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/
M704
speaker (MF8200 series)
M703
M721 H801
SL706
TH802
M701
SW2

M720

SW1

FM1 SW4
M702

SP1
SL705
F-4-297
F-4-298
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment
during No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment
parts during
replacement parts
M701 Main Motor Main Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-210) - replacement
M702 Pickup Motor Pickup Unit - - - H801 Fixing Heater Fixing Film Unit - - -
M703 Fixing Motor Product - (Refer to page 4-232) - TH802 Thermistor Fixing Film Unit - - -
configuration SP1 Speaker Product MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-212) -
M704 Laser Scanner Laser Scanner - - - configuration
Motor Unit SL706 Developing Sub Drive Unit - - -
M720 Reader Motor Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-178) - Separation
M721 ADF Motor ADF Paper MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-172) - Solenoid
Feeder Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn SL705 Cassette Pickup Pickup Unit - - -
FM1 Fan Product - (Refer to page 4-211) - Solenoid
configuration SW2 Front Cover Product - - -
T-4-29
Sensor configuration
SW4 Main Power Product MF8280Cw/8250Cn - -
Switch configuration /8240Cw/8210Cn
SW1 Main Power Product MF8230Cn - -
Switch configuration
T-4-30

4-135
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Clutch / Solenoid/Heater/Thermistor/Switch/speaker (MF8200 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Sensor (MF8200 series)
4-136
List of Sensor (MF8200 series)
PS702 SR611 No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment
PS703 SR603 during
parts
PS701
replacement
SR606
PS701 CIS Unit Reader Unit - - -
SR609
Homeposition
SR605
Sensor
SR610 PS702 Document End ADF Paper Feeder MF8280Cw/8250Cn - -
Sensor Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
PS703 Document Sensor ADF Paper Feeder MF8280Cw/8250Cn - -
Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
SR604
SR601 Cassette Paper Pickup Unit - - -
SR608
Detection Sensor
SR602 Registration Pickup Unit - - -
SR607 Detection Sensor
SR603 Fixing Loop Sensor Product - - -
configuration
SR604 MP Tray Paper Multi-purpose Tray - - -
SR602 Detection Sensor Unit
SR605 MP Tray Pre- Multi-purpose Tray - - -
SR601 Registration Unit
UN6
Detection Sensor
SR606 Developing Product - - -
UN7 Homeposition configuration
UN3 Sensor
F-4-299
SR607 Rear Cover Sensor Product - - -
configuration
SR608 Fixing Pressure Product - - -
Release Sensor configuration
SR609 Fixing Delivery Fixing Assembly - - -
Sensor
SR610 Media Width Sensor Fixing Assembly - - -
(L)
SR611 Media Width Sensor Fixing Assembly - - -
(R)
UN6 Patch Registration ITB Unit - - -
Sensor
UN7 Patch Sensor ITB Unit - - -
UN3 Environment High Voltage Power - - -
Sensor Supply PCB
T-4-31

4-136
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of Sensor (MF8200 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > PCB (MF8200 series)
4-137
PCB (MF8200 series)
UN20 No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjastment during
UN16 parts replacement
UN1 DC Controller Product - (Refer to page 4-186) (Refer to page 4-61)
PCB configuration
UN1 UN2 Driver PCB Product - (Refer to page 4-187) -
configuration
UN3 High Voltage Product - (Refer to page 4-193) -
Power Supply configuration
PCB
UN24 UN4 Low Voltage Low Voltage - - -
Power Supply Power Supply
PCB Unit
UN5 Fixing Power Fixing Power - - -
Supply PCB Supply Unit
UN11 Laser Driver Laser Scanner - - -
UN2 PCB Unit
UN20 Main Controller
Product - (Refer to page 4-183) (Refer to page 4-58)
PCB configuration
UN21 Control PanelControl Panel - (Refer to page 4-199) -
LCD PCB Unit
UN3 UN11
UN22 Control PanelControl Panel - (Refer to page 4-199) -
UN21 Key PCB Unit
UN16 Wireless LAN Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-182) -
PCB configuration /8240Cw
UN22
UN24 USB Host PCB Product - - -
configuration
UN25 FAX-NCU PCB Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-201) -
configuration /8250Cn
UN26 Off Hook PCB Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-201) -
configuration /8250Cn
T-4-32

UN5
UN4

UN25 UN26
F-4-300

4-137
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > PCB (MF8200 series)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 1/4
4-138
List of connector (MF8200 Series)
■■1/4
J922 J703
J912 J407
J951
J108
J115 J120
J109 J922
J120

J810
J107

J104
J810
J119

J407

J404
J621
J704 J501 J1001
J611
F-4-301

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J107 UN1 DC Controller PCB J912 UN20 Main Controller PCB
J108 UN1 DC Controller PCB J501 UN11 Laser Driver PCB
J109 UN1 DC Controller PCB J704 M704 Laser Scanner Motor
J404 UN2 Driver PCB J703 M703 Fixing Motor
J407 UN2 Driver PCB J407 SL706 Developing Separation Solenoid
J115 UN1 DC Controller PCB J1001 UN3 High Voltage Power Supply PCB
J104 UN1 DC Controller PCB J951 SR611 Media Width Sensor (R)
J119 UN1 DC Controller PCB J611 UN7 Patch Sensor
J119 UN1 DC Controller PCB J621 UN6 Patch Registration Sensor
J120 UN1 DC Controller PCB J120 SR606 Developing Homeposition Sensor
J810 UN3 High Voltage Power Supply PCB J810 - Fixing Unit Sensor
J922 UN20 Main Controller PCB J922 SP1 Speaker MF8280Cw/8250Cn
T-4-33

4-138
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 1/4
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 2/4
4-139
■■2/4
J914 J929
J301
J915
J301
J105
J104 J311

J103
J401
J117 MF8230Cn

J801
J393
J802 J392
MF8280Cw/8250Cn
/8240Cw/8210Cn

J391
J211

J391
J210
J373
J203 J351
J401
J352
J605 J604
F-4-302

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J103 UN1 DC Controller PCB J373 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB
J104 UN1 DC Controller PCB J802 J802 TH802 Thermistor
J105 UN1 DC Controller PCB J203 UN5 Fixing Power Supply PCB
J117 UN1 DC Controller PCB J604 SR604 MP Tray Paper Detection Sensor
J117 UN1 DC Controller PCB J605 SR605 MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
J301 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J301 - INLET 200V
J391 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J393 SW1 Main Power Switch MF8230Cn
J929 UN20 Main Controller PCB J392 SW1 Main Power Switch MF8230Cn
J391 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J391 SW4 Main Power Switch MF8280Cw/8250Cn
/8240Cw/8210Cn
J311 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J211 UN5 Fixing Power Supply PCB
J351 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J914 UN20 Main Controller PCB
J352 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J915 UN20 Main Controller PCB
J401 UN4 Low Voltage Power Supply PCB J401 UN2 Driver PCB
J210 UN5 Fixing Power Supply PCB J801 H801 Fixing Heater
T-4-34

4-139
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 2/4
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 3/4
4-140
■■3/4
J901
J924 J951
J961
J908 J409
J952
J701

J130
J603
J972
J116

J140 J130

J408 J602
J402

J402

J403 J116

F-4-303

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J116 UN1 DC Controller PCB J116 SR601 Cassette Paper Detection Sensor
J116 UN1 DC Controller PCB J602 SR602 Registration Detection Sensor
J116 UN1 DC Controller PCB J603 SR603 Fixing Loop Sensor
J130 UN1 DC Controller PCB J130 SW2 Front Cover Sensor
J140 UN1 DC Controller PCB J408 UN2 Driver PCB
J402 UN2 Driver PCB J402 FM1 Fan
J403 UN2 Driver PCB J701 M701 Main Motor
J901 UN20 Main Controller PCB J409 - CIS Unit
J908 UN20 Main Controller PCB J972 UN24 USB Host PCB
J924 UN20 Main Controller PCB J951 UN21 Control Panel LCD PCB
J961 UN22 Control Panel Key PCB J952 UN21 Control Panel LCD PCB
T-4-35

4-140
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 3/4
4 Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 4/4
4-141
■■4/4
J904 J903

J918
J1
J942
J1305
J910
J941
J1302
J921
J1404 J2001

J1312

J406 J1402 J2003

J405

J702

J406
F-4-304

J No. Symbol Name Relay connector J No. Symbol Name Remarks


J405 UN2 Driver PCB J702 M702 Pickup Motor
J406 UN2 Driver PCB J406 SL705 Cassette Pickup Solenoid
J903 UN20 Main Controller PCB J1302 PS703 Document Sensor MF8280Cw/8250Cn
/8240Cw/8230Cn
J903 UN20 Main Controller PCB J1305 M721 ADF Motor MF8280Cw/8250Cn
/8240Cw/8230Cn
J903 UN20 Main Controller PCB J1310 J1312 PS702 Document End Sensor MF8280Cw/8250Cn
/8240Cw/8230Cn
J904 UN20 Main Controller PCB J1402 J1402 M720 Reader Motor
J904 UN20 Main Controller PCB J1401 J1404 PS701 CIS Unit Homeposition Sensor
J918 UN20 Main Controller PCB J941 UN25 FAX-NCU PCB MF8280Cw/8250Cn
J921 UN20 Main Controller PCB J2003 UN26 Off Hook PCB MF8280Cw/8250Cn
J942 UN25 FAX-NCU PCB J2001 UN26 Off Hook PCB MF8280Cw/8250Cn
J910 UN20 Main Controller PCB J1 UN16 Wireless LAN PCB MF8280Cw/8240Cw
T-4-36

4-141
4
Disassembly/Assembly > List of Parts > List of connector (MF8200 Series) > 4/4
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Front Side
4-142

External Cover, Internal Cover

Location
■■Front Side
[3] [4] No. Parts Name Remarks Reference
[2] [5]
[22] [1] ADF Front Upper Cover MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
[6] /8240Cw/8230Cn
[1]
[7] [2] ADF Upper Cover MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[8] [3] Side Guide (Front) MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
[13]
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[4] Side Guide (Rear) MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[12] [5] Document Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[6] Extension Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[7] Sub Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[9] [8] Delivery Tray MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
[11] /8240Cw/8230Cn
[10] [9] Right Cover - (Refer to page 4-147)
[10] Multi-Purpose Tray Pickup Cover - -
[11] Paper Guide - -
[12] Control Panel Lower Cover - -
[14] [13] Control Panel - (Refer to page 4-196)
[14] Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-156)
[15] [15] USB Port - -
[21] [16] Right Front Cover - -
[17] Front Cover - (Refer to page 4-150)
[18] Cassette - -
[19] Mulyi-Purpose Tray Transport - (Refer to page 4-237)
Guide
[20] Left Cover - (Refer to page 4-144)
[20] [21] Reader Cover - -
[22] Platen Cover MF8210Cn -
T-4-37
[16]
[17]
[18]
[19]

F-4-305

4-142
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Front Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Rear Side
4-143
■■Rear Side
[10] [1]
[9]

[8]
[2]

[7]

[6] [3]
[5]
[4]
F-4-306

No. Parts Name Remarks Reference


[1] ADF Rear Cover MF8280Cw/8250Cn -
/8240Cw/8230Cn
[2] Rear Upper Cover - (Refer to page 4-153)
[3] Rear Cover - (Refer to page 4-155)
[4] Rear Lower Cover - (Refer to page 4-154)
[5] Power Socket - -
[6] Telephone Line Jack - -
[7] External Device Jack - -
[8] Handset Terminal - -
[9] LAN Port - -
[10] USB Port - -
T-4-38

4-143
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Location > Rear Side
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Procedure
4-144
Removing the Left Cover 5) Remove the 4 claws [1] at the upper side of the Left Cover.
6) Remove the 3 claws at the rear side of the Left Cover.
■■Procedure

NOTE:: [1]
The following shows the 11 claws of the Left Cover.

x3

x3
[1]

F-4-307 [2]
[1]

1) Remove the Cassette [1].


2) To remove the claw at the lower side of the Left Cover, move the Host Machine for about
5cm from the base.
3) Open the Reader Unit [2].
F-4-309
4) Open the Front Cover [3].

[2]

[3]

[1]

t 5cm
abou
F-4-308

4-144
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Procedure
4-145
7) Remove the claw [1] at the lower side of the Left Cover. 9) Close the Front Cover [1], and then hold the Left Cover [2] to remove.
8) While supporting the Left Cover, remove the 2 claws [2] at the upper front side of the Left • 1 claw [3]
Cover.

x2
[1]
[2]

[3]
[2]

F-4-311

[1]

F-4-310

4-145
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Installing the Left Cover
4-146
■■Installing the Left Cover 5) Install the Left Cover [1].
• 5 claws [2]
1) To remove the claw at the lower side of the Left Cover, move the Host Machine for about
[2]
5cm from the base.
2) Open the Front Cover [1].
3) Install the 3 claws [2] at the front side of the Left Cover. x5

x3
[2]

[1]

[2]
F-4-314

t 5cm [1]
abou
F-4-312
4) Fit in the claw [1] at the lower side of the Left Cover.

x2

[1]

F-4-313

4-146
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Left Cover > Installing the Left Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Procedure
4-147
Removing the Right Cover 5) Remove the 2 screws [1], and release the 5 claws [2].

■■Procedure
x5 x2
NOTE::
The following shows the 9 claws of the Right Cover.

[2]

[2]
[1]

F-4-317
6) Release the claw [1] and claw [2] while opening the Right Cover.

[1]
F-4-315 x2

[2]
1) Remove the Cassette [1].
2) To remove the claw at the lower side of the Right Cover, move the Host Machine for about
5cm from the base.
3) Open the Reader Unit [2].
4) Open the Front Cover [3].

[2]

F-4-318

[3]

[1]

abo
ut 5
cm
F-4-316

4-147
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4-148
7) Release the claw [1] while opening the Right Cover. ■■Installing the Right Cover
8) Close the Front Cover [2], release the claw [3], and then remove the Right Cover [4].
1) Open the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Cover [1] and attach the 2 claws [2] on the lower side
and 2 claws [3] on the front side of the Right Cover.

[1]
x4
[3]
[2]

[1] about
[4] 5cm

F-4-320

CAUTION:

To install the Right Cover to the Host Machine, be sure to install [A] part of the Right
Cover to be attached outside of [B] part.
[2] [3]

F-4-319

[B] [B]

[A] [A]

F-4-321

4-148
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4-149
2) Insert the 5 claws [1] on the upper side of the Right Cover and install the Right Cover [2].
• 2 screws [3]

[1] [1]

x5

x2
[3]

[2]
F-4-322

4-149
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Right Cover > Installing the Right Cover
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Covent Cover > Procedure
4-150
Removing the Front Covent Cover 4) Remove the cartridges

■■Procedure CAUTION:

1) Remove the Cassette [1]. Since the Cartridge Tray interferes with the stopper when removing the stopper, do not
2) Open the Front Cover [2]. pull out the Cartridge Tray until it hits the end.

5) Insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the clearance [A] between the Right Stopper [1] and rail.
6) Remove the Right Stopper [1] while pushing the [B] part.
• 1 Claws [2]
[2] • 1 Protrusion [3]
[1]

[A]
[B]

[3]

F-4-323
3) Pull the Cartridge Tray [1].

[2] [1]

[1]
F-4-325

F-4-324

4-150
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Covent Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Covent Cover > Procedure
4-151
7) Insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the clearance [A] between the Left Stopper [1] and rail. 10) Close the Front Cover [1].
8) Remove the Left Stopper [1] while pushing the [B] part. 11) Open the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Slot Cover [2] and Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Tray [3].
• 1 Claws [2]
• 1 Protrusion [3] [1]

[A] [2]
[B]

[3]

[3] [1] [2]


F-4-328
12) While lifting the Feeding Guide [1], remove the 3 claws [2].
F-4-326 13) Close the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Slot Cover [3]
9) Remove the Cartridge Tray [1].

[1]

x3
[3]

[1]

[2]

F-4-329

F-4-327

4-151
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Covent Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Covent Cover > Procedure
4-152
14) Open the Front Cover [1] to remove the Feeding Guide [2]. 17) Remove the Fixation Pin [1] of the Right Arm.
• 1 Claw [2]

[2] [1]
[2]

[1]

F-4-330
15) Put the Front Cover [1] back to position A. F-4-332

16) Remove the Right Arm [2] of the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Slot Cover to remove the 18) Remove the Left Holder [2] while holding the Front Cover [1].
Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Slot Cover [3]. • 2 Shafts [3]
• 2 Shafts [4] • 1 Claw [4]

[3]
[2]
[2]
[1]

[4]

[A]
[4] [3]

[4] [3] [1]


F-4-333
F-4-331

4-152
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Front Covent Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Upper Cover > Procedure
4-153
19) Push and remove the Left Arm [1].
Removing the Rear Upper Cover
• 1 Shaft [2]
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.

■■Procedure
[1] 1) Open the Rear Cover [1].

[2]

F-4-334
[1]
20) Remove the Front Cover [1].
• 1 Shaft [2]

[2] F-4-336
2) Remove the Rear Upper Cover [1].
• 1 screw [2]
• 5 claws [3]

[3]

[1]
[1] [3]

F-4-335
x5
[3]

[2]

F-4-337

4-153
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Upper Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Lower Cover > Procedure
4-154
Removing the Rear Lower Cover 2) Open the Rear Cover and remove the Rear Lower Cover [1] in the direction of the arrow.
• 1 boss [2]
■■Preparation • 4 claws [3]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
x4
[1]
■■Procedure
[3]
1) Close the Rear Cover [1] and remove the 2 screws [2].

x2
[1] [2]

F-4-339

[2]

[2]
F-4-338

4-154
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Lower Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Cover > Procedure
4-155
Removing the Rear Cover CAUTION:

■■Preparation When installing the Rear Door, be sure to install [A] part to be attached outside of [B]
part.
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144. [A]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153. [A]
[B]
4) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154.
[B]

■■Procedure
1) Remove the Rear Cover [2] from the shafts [1] of the Rear Lower Cover.

[2]

F-4-341

[1]

F-4-340

4-155
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Rear Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Upper Cover > Procedure
4-156
Removing the Upper Cover 3) Remove the Upper Cover [1].
• 8 screws [2]
■■Preparation • 1 claw [3]

1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147. [2]


[2]
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153. x8
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit.Refer to page 4-158

■■Procedure
1) Open the Front Cover.
[2]
2) Remove the USB Host PCB [1].
• 1 screw [2]
[1]
[3]

F-4-343

CAUTION:

When installing the Upper Cover [1], make sure that the claw [2] is surely fitted.

[2]
[1]
[2]
[1]

F-4-342

F-4-344

4-156
4
Disassembly/Assembly > External Cover, Internal Cover > Removing the Upper Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Location
4-157

Document exposure/feeder system

Location
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
[1]
parts replacement

[2]
[1] ADF Unit Product MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-160) (Refer to page 4-36)
Configuration /8240Cw/8230Cn
[2] ADF Paper ADF Unit MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-169) -
[3] Feeder Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
[6] [3] ADF Roller ADF Unit MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-164) -
Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
[7] [4] ADF Pickup ADF Roller MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-166) -
Roller Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
[4] [5] ADF ADF Roller MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-166) -
Separation Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
[5] Roller
[12] [6] ADF Motor ADF Paper MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-172) -
Feeder Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
M721
[7] ADF ADF Paper MF8280Cw/8250Cn (Refer to page 4-167) -
Separation Feeder Unit /8240Cw/8230Cn
Pad
[8] Reader Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-160) (Refer to page 4-37)
Configuration
[9] CIS Unit Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-175) (Refer to page 4-51)
[10] Reader Reader Unit M720 (Refer to page 4-178) -
Motor
[11] Reader Unit Reader Unit - (Refer to page 4-173) (Refer to page 4-48)
[11]
Upper Cover
[12] Platen Cover Product MF8210Cn - -
Configuration
T-4-39

[8]
[10]
[9]
F-4-345

4-157
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Location
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-158
Removing the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit 4) Remove the handle [1].
• 2 screws [2]
■■Preparation [1]
[2]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144. x2
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Be sure to perform "After replacing ADF unit (Refer to page 4-36)" and "After replacing
reader unit (Refer to page 4-37)" when replacing the ADF Unit and Reader Unit,
respectively.

F-4-347
5) Remove the Controller Cover [1].
1) Remove the claw [1] to remove the Reader Shaft Retainer [2].
• 7 screws [2]
2) While supporting the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [3], remove the Reader Support
• 2 hooks [3]
Shaft [4].
3) Bring down the Reader Support Shaft [4] to close the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [3]. [2]

[3]
[4] x7
[3] [3]
[1]
[1]

[2]

[2] [2]

F-4-346
F-4-348

4-158
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-159
6) Disconnect the connector [1], connector (only for models with ADF) [2], and 2 Flat Cables [3].
CAUTION:
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [4]
• 1 Ferrite Core [5] Be sure to perform the following when connecting the Flat Cable [1] to the connector
• 2 Harness Guides [6] with a lock [2].
Be sure to insert the Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after checking
[6] that both sides (edges) [A] of the Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves [B] of the
connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].
[5]
x4 [1] [1]
[3]

x3 [A]
[A] [B]

[B]

[2] [4]
[2] [3] [2]
[1]

F-4-349 [1] [1]

[A]
[A] [B]

[B]

[2] [3] [2]

F-4-350

4-159
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-160
7) Disconnect the grounding [1] and grounding [2] (only for models with ADF).
Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit
• 2 Screws [3]
8) Open and remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [4]. ■■Preparation
• 2 Hooks [5]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
[4] 2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158
[3]

■■Procedure
x2
CAUTION:
[5]
[5] Be sure to perform "After replacing ADF unit (Refer to page 4-36)" and "After replacing
reader unit (Refer to page 4-37)" when replacing the ADF Unit and Reader Unit,
respectively.
[1] [2]

F-4-351
1) Place the ADF Unit and Reader Unit in the open status as shown in the figure below (only
for models with ADF).

F-4-352

4-160
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4-161
2) Remove the Reader Unit Lower Cover [1] (only for models with ADF). 4) Open the ADF Unit/Copyboard and separeate it to the dirrection of the arrow from the
• 1 Screw [2] Reader Unit [2].
• 4 Claws [3]
• 2 Harnesses [4]
• 2 Flat Cables [5]
• 2 Grounding Wires [6] [1]

[3]

[4]

[1] [5]
[5]
[3]
x6
[2]
[6]
[2]
F-4-355
[3]
NOTE:
If ADF Unit/Copyboard [1] is not opened to the position[A], it cannot be separate from
[3] the Reader Unit, because of the 2 claws [2].
F-4-353
3) Remove the cable [1] and the grounding wire [2] (only for models with ADF).
• 6 wire guides [3]

[1]
x6 [2]
[A]
[3]

[3] [1]

[2]
[3]
F-4-356
[3]

[2]
F-4-354

4-161
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > After replacing reader units
4-162
■■After replacing ADF units ■■After replacing reader units
1) After executing the white level adjustment with the following service mode 1, check the 1) Release 2 claws [1] and Remove the Scoopup sheet holder [2], Enter the setting value of
auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service label. the Standard White Plate.
1. White level adjustment
[2]
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning]) x2
[1]
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard [1]

scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
F-4-357
using DF)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X (X signal data for the standard white plate)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Y (Y signal data for the standard white plate)
2) Execute the reading position adjustment with the following service mode.
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Z (Z signal data for the standard white plate)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>) MEMO
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning The value of W-PLT-X: The first four digits of the value on the label
position in FEEDER mode) The value of W-PLT-Y: The four digits in the middle of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Z: The last four digits of the value on the label
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)

3) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading.
2) Execute the white level adjustment.
• FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
reading)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)
• FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)

3) After executing the reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, check
the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service
label.
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value
reference)

4-162
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > After replacing reader units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > After replacing reader units
4-163
4) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with 6) Read the image and execute the adjustment with the following service mode.
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service • FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
mode 2 and write the value in the service label. reading)
1. White level adjustment • FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
using DF)

5) Enter the value on the label packed with the part in the following service mode item.
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning
position in FEEDER mode)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> 50-RG (Color displacement correction value between RG
in the vertical scanning direction (50%))
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>50-GB (Color displacement correction value between GB
in the vertical scanning direction (50%))
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>100-RG (Color displacement correction value between RG
in the vertical scanning direction (100%))
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>100-GB (Color displacement correction value between GB
in the vertical scanning direction (100%))
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL>OFST-P-Y (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-M (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-C (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-K (Adjustment of test chart reading density)

4-163
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Separating the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit > After replacing reader units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Roller Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-164
Removing the ADF Roller Unit 3) Remove the plastic E-ring [1] and slide the bushing [2].

(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)
■■Procedure
[2]
CAUTION:
[1]
Do not touch the surface of the roller.

1) Open the ADF Upper Cover [1].


[1]

F-4-360
4) Remove the ADF Roller Unit [1].
• 1 plastic E-ring [2]
• 1 bushing [3]

[2]
[3]
[1]
F-4-358
2) Remove the gear [1] and the bushing [2].
• 1 claw [3]

[2] [1]

F-4-361

[3]

F-4-359

4-164
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Roller Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Roller Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-165

CAUTION: CAUTION:

Be careful not to lose the spring [1] attached to the ADF Roller Unit. • When installing, match the spring [1] of the ADF Roller Unit to the boss [2].

[1]

[2]

[1]

F-4-362 F-4-363
• Be sure to put the Sensor Flag [1] above the ADF Roller Unit [2] at installation work.

[1]
[1]

[2] [2]
F-4-364

4-165
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Roller Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF separation roller
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-166

Removing the ADF Pickup Roller Removing the ADF separation roller
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)

■■Preparation ■■Preparation
1) Remove the ADF roller unit. Refer to page 4-164.
1) Remove the ADF roller unit. Refer to page 4-164.

■■Procedure ■■Procedure

CAUTION:
CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of the roller.
Do not touch the surface of the roller.

1) Remove the bushing [1] and 2 plastic e-rings [2].


1) Insert the end of the flat-blade screwdriver into the [A] part to remove the ADF Pickup
Roller Unit [1]. [2]

[1]
F-4-367
[1] 2) Slide the Roller Shaft [1] to remove the parallel pin [2].
[A]
CAUTION:

F-4-365 Be careful not to lose the parallel pin [2] at assembly/disassembly.


2) Remove the ADF Pickup Roller [1].
[1] [2]
[1]

F-4-366 F-4-368

4-166
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF separation roller
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Separation Pad
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-167
3) Turn the Roller Shaft [1] in the direction of the arrow and fit the projection [2] to the hole of
Removing the ADF Separation Pad
the Roller Holder to remove.
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)
■■Procedure
[2] [1]

CAUTION:

Do not touch the surface of the roller or pad.

1) Open the ADF Upper Cover [1].


[1]

F-4-369
4) Remove the ADF Separation Roller [1].
[1]

F-4-371
2) Unhook the hook [1] using the flat-head screw driver and remove the ADF Front Cover [1]
in the direction of the arrow.
F-4-370

[2]

[1]

F-4-372

4-167
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Separation Pad
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Separation Pad
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-168
3) Remove the Feed Guide [1] in the direction of the arrow.
CAUTION:
• 2 bosses [2]
• 1 claw [3] • Be careful not to lose the spring [2] attached to the Separation Pad Holder [1].

[2] [2]

[1]

[2]

[1]
[3]

F-4-373
F-4-375
4) Reverse the Feed Guide. • When installing, match the spring [1] to the boss [2] of the Feed Guide.
5) Remove the Separation Pad Holder [1].
• 2 Claws [2]
• 2 Shafts [3]

x2 [1] [3]
[1]
[2]
[2]
[2]

[3]

F-4-376

F-4-374

4-168
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Separation Pad
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-169
6) Remove the Separation Pad [1].
Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
• Pad retainer [2]
• Sheet [3] (MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn)
[2]
■■Procedure
1) Open the ADF Upper Cover [1].

[3] [1]

[1]

F-4-377

F-4-378
2) Remove the hook [1] using flat-head driver, and remove the ADF Front Cover [2] in the
direction of the arrow.

[2]

[1]

F-4-379

4-169
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-170
3) Lift the ADF Tray [1] until it stops and release the hook [2] to tip the tray into the 4) Remove the boss [1] to remove the ADF Rear Cover [2] in the direction of the arrow.
perpendicular position and remove by pulling upward. • 4 claws [3]
• 1 Claw [3]

[1] [1]
x4 [1]

[3]

[3] [3]

[2]
F-4-381
5) Remove the harness [1] and the grounding cord [2].
• 1 screw (binding) [3]
• 3 connectors [4]

[3]

[2] [3] [2]


[4]
x3
F-4-380

[1] [4]
F-4-382

4-170
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-171
6) Remove the 3 screws [1] of the ADF Pickup Feed Unit. 7) Close the ADF Upper Cover [1] to remove the ADF Pickup Feed Unit [2].

[2]

x2

[1]

[1]

F-4-384
8) Remove the ADF Upper Cover Unit [1].
• 2 bosses [2]

[1]

[2]
[2]

[1]

F-4-383

F-4-385

4-171
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Feed Unit
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Motor
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4-172
Removing the ADF Pickup Motor CAUTION:
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) • When installing the ADF Pickup Motor, be sure to hook the gear [1] of the motor on
the belt [2].
■■Preparation
1) Remove the ADF Pickup Feed Unit. Refer to page 4-169
[2]
■■Procedure
[1]
NOTE:
When removing the ADF Pickup Motor, it is not necessary to remove the ADF Upper
Cover Unit described in the previous step.

1) Remove the ADF Motor [1] in the direction of the arrow.


• 2 screws [2]
• 1 belt [3]

F-4-387
[3] • When installing the ADF Pickup Motor, be sure to install with the connector [1] on the
x2 [2]
right side.

[1]

[1] [2]

F-4-386

[1]

F-4-388

4-172
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the ADF Pickup Motor
(MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > Procedure
4-173
Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover 2) Remove the Scoopup sheet holder [1].
• 2 claws [2]
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144. x2 [1]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158
5) Separate the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-160

■■Procedure [2]

CAUTION:

Be sure to perform "After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit (Refer to page 4-48)"
when replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit, respectively. F-4-390
3) Remove the Reader Unit Upper Cover [1].
• 2 screw [2]
• 5 claws [3]

CAUTION:
CAUTION:
To replace the Copyboard Glass, be sure to replace the Copyboard Glass together with
Because the Copyboard Glass [2] is attached to the Upper Cover [1], be careful not to
the Reader Unit Upper Cover.
drop or damage the Upper Cover.

1) Remove the 3 screws [1] at the bottom of the Reader Unit..


[3] [2]
[2]
[1]
x3 x2 [3]

x5

[3]
[1]

F-4-391
F-4-389

4-173
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
4-174
■■After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit 3) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
1) Enter the setting value of the Standard White Plate.
mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
1. White level adjustment
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
F-4-392
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X (X signal data for the standard white plate) 2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Y (Y signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Z (Z signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
MEMO using DF)
The value of W-PLT-X: The first four digits of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Y: The four digits in the middle of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Z: The last four digits of the value on the label

2) After executing the CCD reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1,
check the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the
service label.
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value
reference)

4-174
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Unit Upper Cover > After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4-175
Removing the CIS Unit 3) Remove the CIS Unit Mount [1] and remove the flat cable [2].
• 1 guide [3]
■■Preparation
CAUTION:
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144. • When assembling/disassembling the copyboard glass, take care not to lose the 2
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153. CIS unit spacers [1].
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158 • When assembling/disassembling the copyboard glass, do not touch the copy reading
5) Separate the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-160 area [2] of the CIS unit.
6) Remove the Reader Unit Upper Cover Unit. Refer to page 4-173.
[2]

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Be sure to perform "After replacing CIS unit (Refer to page 4-51)" when replacing the
[1]
CIS unit, respectively.
[1]

F-4-394
1) Pull the Drive Belt [1] to move the CIS Unit [2].
2) Loosen the screw [3] and move the Pulley Holder [4] in the direction of the arrow to remove
the Drive Belt [1]. [3]

[1] [3] [4]


[1]

[2]

[2] [1]

F-4-395
F-4-393

4-175
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4-176
4) Bring up the CIS Unit [1] to remove in the direction of the arrow.
CAUTION:

• When installing the CIS Unit [1], be sure to replace the CIS Spacer [2] together with
[1] the CIS Unit [1] (included in the pacage of the Service Parts).

[3]

F-4-396

CAUTION:

When replacing the CIS Unit [1], be sure to replace the CIS Unit [1] and the CIS Spacer F-4-398

[2], which are included in the package of the service part, at the same time. • When the CIS Spacers are mixed up or lost, check the CIS Rank Label [3] to use,
If a different spacer is used, image reading error may occur. and use the appropriate CIS Spacer that fits the rank of the CIS Unit.

Rank Color of spacer Dimension (Height


of spacer)
rank A light gray 1.17 mm
rank B dark gray 1.27 mm
rank C brown 1.37 mm
T-4-40

[2]
[1]
[2]

F-4-397

4-176
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the CIS Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the CIS Unit > After replacing CIS units
4-177
3) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
CAUTION:
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
When installing the CIS Unit, be sure to check that the projection [1] is fitted to the dent [2] mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
to install. 1. White level adjustment
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.

[2] [1] 2. Checking the setting value


[2] [1]
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
F-4-399 • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
■■After replacing CIS units using DF)

1) Execute the white level adjustment. If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the
operation again. 4) Execute the reading position adjustment with the following service mode.

• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment) • COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start

• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment) position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning

2) After executing the reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, check position in FEEDER mode)

the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service • COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)

label.
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto 5) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading.

execution) • FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF

2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value reading)

reference) • FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)

4-177
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the CIS Unit > After replacing CIS units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4-178
Removing the Reader Scanner Motor 2) Pull the Drive Belt [1] to move the CIS Unit [2].
3) Loosen the screw [3] and move the Pulley Holder [4] in the direction of the arrow to remove
■■Preparation the Drive Belt [1].

1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.


[1] [3] [4]
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
[1]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158
5) Separate the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-160
6) Remove the Reader Unit Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-173.

■■Procedure
[2]
1) Free the harness [2] while holding the Reader Unit [1].
• 1 Connector [3]
• 3 Harness Guides at the [A] location
F-4-401
4) Remove the gear [1].
CAUTION:
• 1 claw [2]
To prevent parts on the top side of the Reader Unit, do not tip the Reader Unit [1] into
the perpendicular position.

[1]

[2]

x3 [1]

F-4-402

[A] [2] [3]

F-4-400

4-178
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4-179
5) Remove the Shaft Retaining Plate [1]. 7) Move the Motor Mounting Plate [1] and turn it over.
• 1 screw [2] • 2 screws [2]
• 1 Grounding Plate [3]

[2]
x2
[2]

[1]
[1]

[3]
F-4-403
F-4-405
6) Move the Sensor Mount [1].
8) Pass the connector [1] through the hole [A].
• 1 screw [2]
9) Remove the Reader Scanner Motor [3] from the Motor Mounting Plate [2].
[2] • 2 screws [4]

[1]
[1]

x2 [4]

[1]

[A]

[3]
[2]

F-4-404

F-4-406

4-179
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Document exposure/feeder system > Removing the Reader Scanner Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (1/2)
4-180

Controller System

Location
■■(1/2)

[1] [2] [3]


No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
parts replacement
[1] Controller Cover Product - (Refer to page 4-182) -
Configuration
[2] Main Controller Product UN20 (Refer to page 4-183) (Refer to page 4-58)
PCB Configuration
[3] Wireless LAN Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-182) -
[4] PCB Configuration /8240Cw
UN16

[4] Speaker Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-212) -


Configuration /8250Cn
[5]
SP1
[6] [5] Control Panel Control Panel UN22 (Refer to page 4-199) -
Key PCB Unit
[7]
[6] Control Panel Control Panel UN21 (Refer to page 4-199) -
LCD PCB Unit
[7] Control Panel Product - (Refer to page 4-196) -
Unit Configuration
[8]
[8] DC Controller Product UN1 (Refer to page 4-186) (Refer to page 4-61)
PCB Configuration
[9] Driver PCB Product UN2 (Refer to page 4-187) -
[9] Configuration
[10] Fan Product FM1 (Refer to page 4-211) -
Configuration
[11] High Voltage Product UN3 (Refer to page 4-193) -
[10] Power Supply Configuration
PCB
[11] T-4-41

F-4-407

4-180
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (1/2)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (2/2)
4-181
■■(2/2)
[13] [14] No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
[15] parts replacement
[12] [12] Sub Drive Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-209) -
Configuration
[13] FAX-NCU PCB Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-201) -
Configuration /8250Cn
UN25
[14] Off Hook PCB Product MF8280Cw (Refer to page 4-201) -
Configuration /8250Cn
UN26
[15] Main Motor Product M701 (Refer to page 4-210) -
Configuration
[16] Main Drive Unit Main Drive Unit - (Refer to page 4-202) -
[17] Low Voltage Product - (Refer to page 4-190) -
[16] Power Supply Configuration
Unit
[18] Fixing Power Product - (Refer to page 4-195) -
Supply Unit Configuration
T-4-42

[18] [17]

F-4-408

4-181
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Location > (2/2)
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Wireless LAN PCB
(MF8280Cw/8240Cw) > Procedure
4-182
Removing the Controller Cover Removing the Wireless LAN PCB
■■Preparation (MF8280Cw/8240Cw)
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147. ■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
■■Procedure 2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182
1) Remove the Controller Cover [1].
• 7 Screws [2] ■■Procedure
• 2 Hooks [3]
1) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB [1].
[2] • 1 Screw [2]
[3] [3] • 1 Flat Cable [3]
x7
[1] [1]
[2]
[3]

[2]

F-4-409

F-4-410

4-182
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Wireless LAN PCB
(MF8280Cw/8240Cw) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > Preparation
4-183
Removing the Main Controller PCB ■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
CAUTION: 2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.
3) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
Be sure to perform "Before Replacing the Main Controller PCB (Refer to page 4-58)"
when replacing the Main Controller PCB, respectively.

■■Before Replacing the Main Controller PCB


Back up user data (settings, registered data, etc.) and service mode data for setting and
registration after PCB replacement. Take notes if data is unable to back up.
1) In Remote UI, perform the following procedure to export the user data (login in
administrator mode).
In Setting/Registration > Import/Export > Menu > Export, select an item and then start
export.
2) In service mode, perform the following procedure to export the service mode data (and
then import it after replacement).
FUNCTION > SYSTEM > EXPORT
3) Record the default settings shown on the service label [1] (these are entered after
replacement).
4) Write down the machine's serial number and the data of Settings/Registration > System
Settings > Device Information> Location (these are entered after replacement).

[1]

F-4-411

4-183
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > Preparation
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > Procedure
4-184
■■Procedure CAUTION:
1) Remove the Main Controller PCB [1].
Be sure to perform the following when connecting the Flat Cable [1] to the connector
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [2]
with a lock [2].
• 3 Flat Cables [3]
Be sure to insert the Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after checking
• 1 Flat Cables [4] (Fax model only) that both sides (edges) [A] of the Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves [B] of the
• 4 Connectors [5] connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].
• 2 Connectors [6] (Fax model only)
• 1 Connector [7] (ADF model only) [1] [1]
• 1 Connector [8] (MF8230Cn only)
• 6 Screws [9] (TP)
[A]
• 1 Screw [10] (Binding)
[A] [B]
• 1 Hook [11]
[B]

[2] [3] [2]

[1] [1]

[A]
[2]
[A] [B]

[3] [11] [9] [B]


[5] [7]

x12 x7 [2]
[5] [2] [3]
F-4-413

[10]
[3]
[6]

[1]
[4]

[5] [8] [5] [9]


F-4-412

4-184
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > After replacing main controller PCBs
4-185
■■After replacing main controller PCBs 4. Migrating the serial number
1) Enter the serial number (8-digit alphanumeric) in Settings/Registration > System
1. Setting of destination/paper size group
Settings > Device Information > Location.
1) COPIER > OPTION > BODY > LOCALE (to set destination groups)
2) Select COPIER > OPTION > SERIAL > SN-MAIN. Then, press the OK key to write the
[Settings]
serial number entered in step 1 in the Main Controller PCB. After it has been written,
1: Japan, 2: North America, 3: Korea, 4: China, 5: Taiwan, 6: Europe, 7: Asia,
the serial number entered in "Location" in step 1 is deleted.
8: Oceania
3) Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
2) COPIER > OPTION > BODY > SIZE-LC (to set paper size groups)
4) Execute COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P> SPEC to output the spec report to check
[Settings]
the serial number BODY.No..
1: AB series, 2: Inch series, 3: A series, 4: AB/Inch series
5) Enter the data of the installation location (which was written down in "Before replacing
2. Clearing Setting/Registration data
the Main Controller PCB") in Settings/Registration > System Settings > Device
1) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > ALL (to clear all data)
Information > Location.
Once executed, the following data are cleared according to the values of LOCALE and
SIZE-LC set in step 1.
5. Migrating user data
• Setting / Registration data (the default value for each destination is set).
In Remote UI, perform the following procedure to import the user data (login in
• Service mode data (the default value for each destination is set).
administrator mode).
• Job IDs
In Setting/Registration > Import/Export > Menu > Import, select an item and then start
• Log data
import.
• Dates
2) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > R-CON (to clear default setting values for the
6. Migrating service mode data
reader/DF)
In service mode, perform the following procedure to import the service mode data.
3. Adjustment, input of default setting values
FUNCTION > SYSTEM > IMPORT
1) Close the ADF.
2) COPIER> FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC, BW-AGC (to adjust white levels)
7. Reinstall the drivers.
The white level is adjusted.
1) Uninstalling Old Drivers.
3) Enter default setting values indicated on the service label in the corresponding service
• Printer Driver
mode items.
• FAX Driver
4) COPIER> FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN (to back up DC controller setting
• Scanner Driver
values)
• Network Scan Utility. (for machines with network connection)
Purpose: to be prepared for replacing DC controller PCBs
* As for the procedure, refer to "Uninstalling the Software" in the Starter Guide.
5) Turn off and on the power.
2) Install the drivers which have been uninstalled in step 1.
6) Start in the initial installation mode. Follow instructions shown on the screen for setup.
* As for the procedure, refer to the following items in the Starter Guide.
(setting of date/time, auto-gradation correction)
• In case of network connection: "Installing via Network Connection"
• In case of USB connection: "Installing with USB Connection"

4-185
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Controller PCB > After replacing main controller PCBs
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the DC Controller PCB > Procedure
4-186

MEMO Removing the DC Controller PCB


MAC address information is changed after replacement of the Main Controller PCB.
Therefore, when the PC and the machine are connected by the network, the PC will
not be able to recognize the machine on the network. When the PC and the machine CAUTION:
are connected by the USB memory device, the PC will not be able to recognize the
Be sure to perform "Before Replacing the DC Controller PCB (Refer to page 4-61)"
machine if the USB ID is changed. It becomes therefore necessary to reinstall the
driver. when replacing the DC Controller PCB, respectively.

In the case of a model without fax for EUR (MF8540/MF8230), perform the following works. ■■Before replacing the DC Controller PCB
1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to store the DC Controller setting values.
MEMO
After replacing the Main Controller PCB, the value of the service mode (SDTM-DSP) COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN
to set whether to display or hide the automatic shutdown menu becomes "0" (default
value).
In that case, the automatic shutdown menu is not displayed on the LUI of the machine.
■■Preparation
To display the automatic shutdown menu on the LUI of the machine, it is necessary to 1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
execute this process.

■■Procedure
8. Setting of automatic shutdown menu display
1) Remove the DC Controller PCB [1].
Set 1 for automatic shutdown menu display in service mode (default: 0).
• 4 Flat Cables [2]
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > SDTM-DSP
• 10 Connectors [3]
9. Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
• Harness Guide [A]
10. Checking the setting of Auto Sleep Time
• 4 Screws [4]
In setting menu, check that the setting value of Auto Sleep Time is 1. (If the setting value is 0,
automatic shutdown does not work.) [3] [2] [4]
Menu > Timer Settings > Auto Shutdown Time

x14 [3]
[2]

[3] [4]
[4]
[1]

x3
[3]

[4] [2] [3] [A] F-4-414

4-186
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the DC Controller PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4-187
■■After replacing the DC Controller PCB Removing the Driver PCB
1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to restore the DC Controller setting
■■Preparation
values.
COPIER > FUINCTION > VIFFNC > RSTR-DCN 1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.

MEMO ■■Procedure
After executing the Printer Recovery Setting, be sure to wait for about 15 seconds
because of internal process/operation. 1) Free the harness [1] and 1 Flat Cable [2].
• 3 Connectors [3]
• 2 Connectors [4] (Fax model only)
2) Turn OFF and then ON the power. • 1 Connectors [5] (MF8230Cn only)
3)* Execute the following: Menu > Adjustment/Maintenance > Print Color Displacement • 1 Harness Guide [A]
Correction • 1 Harness Guide [B]
4)* Execute the following: Menu > Adjustment/Maintenance > Auto Gradation Correction >
Quick Correction [A] [3]
5) Turn OFF and then ON the power.

x7
[2]

x2 [1]
[4]

[B] [3] [5] [3]

F-4-415

4-187
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4-188
2) Remove the Speaker Holder [1]. 4) Remove the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit Cover [1].
• 2 Screws [2] • 4 Claws [2]
• 2 Hooks [3] • 2 Protrusions [3]

[3] [3] [2] [3] [2]

x2 [2] x4
[2]
[2]
[1]

[1]

F-4-416
3) Free the harness [1].
• 2 Connectors [2]
• 1 Harness Guide [A] F-4-418

• 1 Harness Guide [B] 5) Shift the Harness Guide [1].


• 3 Connectors [2]
• 1 Boss [3]
• 4 Hooks [4]
x2 [2]

[A]
x2 x3 [1] [3]
[2]

[B]
[1] [4]

F-4-417
[4]

F-4-419

4-188
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4-189
6) Remove the Driver PCB [1].
CAUTION:
• 1 Flat Cable [2]
• 7 Connectors [3] When installing the Harness Guide [1] shifted in step 5 to the plate of the host machine,
• 2 Screws [4] be sure to install it as shown in the figure below because the 2 hooks [2] are hidden
• 1 Claw [5] under the Main Controller Support Plate [3].
• 1 Hook [6]

[3]

[1] [2] [3]


x8 [3]

[2]
x2

[4]
[6] [1]
[5]
F-4-421
[4]
After moving the Harness Guide [1] in the direction of the arrow and hooking the 2
F-4-420
hooks [2] and the 2 hooks [3], insert the boss [4].

[3]

[4]

[2] [1]

F-4-422

4-189
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Driver PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4-190
Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit 2) Free the harness [1] from the guides [A], [B], and [C].
• 6 Connectors [2]
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147. [2] [A] [B] [C]
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153. x6
4) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154.
5) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.
6) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
x3
7) Remove the Main Controller PCB.Refer to page 4-183
8) Remove the Off Hook PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201
9) Remove the Fax PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201 [2] [1]
F-4-424

■■Procedure 3) Remove the Fixing Power Supply Cover [1].


• 2 Screws [2]
1) Remove the Fax PCB Mounting Plate [1].
• 4 Screws [2]
• 2 Hooks [3]

x2

x4 [1]

[3]

[2]
F-4-425
[1]
[2]

F-4-423

4-190
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4-191
4) Remove the Harness Guide [1]. 6) Shift the Fax Cover Plate [1], and remove the Harness Guide [2].
• 1 Connector [2] • 3 Screws [3]
• 1 Hook [3] • 1 Boss [4]
• 2 Hooks [5]

x3
[1]
[3]
[5]
[3]
[4]
[2]

[5]
[1] [2]
[3]
F-4-426
F-4-428
5) Free the harness [1] from the guide [B] by putting it through the hole [A] of the plate.
7) Free the harness [1].
• 2 Connectors [2]
• 1 Harness Guide [A]
x2 • 1 Harness Guide [B]

[1]

x2 [2]

x2
[A]
[B]
F-4-427

[B] [1] [A]


F-4-429

4-191
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4-192
8) Remove the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit Cover [1]. 9) Pull out the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit [1] for about 2 cm.
• 4 Claws [2] • 1 Connector [2]
• 2 Protrusions [3] • Harness Guide [A]
• 5 Screws [3]
[3] [2] [3] [2]
• 2 Hooks [4]

x5

[2]
[2]

[A]

[4]

x5
[2]

[3]
[1]
[1]
F-4-430 [3]

F-4-431

4-192
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4-193
10) Free the Power Supply Harness [1] by putting it through the hole [A] of the plate.
Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB
• 1 Connector [2]
11) Remove the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit [3]. ■■Preparation
• 1 Connector [4]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158
x2 5) Remove the Upper Cover.Refer to page 4-156
[1]

■■Procedure
1) Disconnect the flat cable [1].
• 1 guide [2]
[4] [A]
[2]
[3] [2] [1] [2]

F-4-432

x2

F-4-433

4-193
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4-194
2) Remove the Harness [1]. 5) Remove the High Voltage Power Supply PCB [1].
• 1 Connector [2] • 3 screws (binding) [2]
• Harness Guide [A] • 1 screw (W SEMS) [3]
• 6 claws [4]
[1] [A]
[4]
[2]

x4
[2]

x6
[1]

[4] [2]

[2] [3]
[4]
F-4-434
F-4-436
3) Remove the Sub PCB [1].
4) Free the harness [3] from the harness guide [2].
CAUTION:
• 1 screw [4]
When installing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB [1], be sure to check that the
contact springs [3] are in contact with the 20 round holes.

[1]

[4]

[3] [2]
[2] [3]

F-4-435 [1]
F-4-437

4-194
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the High Voltage Power Supply PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4-195
Removing the Fixing Power Supply Unit 2) Remove the Harness Guide [1].
• 1 Connector [2]
■■Preparation • 1 Hook [3]
3) Remove the Fixing Power Supply Unit [4].
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
• 2 Connectors [5]
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
• 4 Screws [6]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154.

■■Procedure
x2
1) Remove the Fixing Power Supply Cover [1]. [4]
• 2 screws [2] [5]

[3]

x2 [5]
x4 [2]
[6]
[6]
[1]
[1] [6]
F-4-439

[2] [2]

F-4-438

4-195
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fixing Power Supply Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4-196
Removing the Control Panel Unit 1) Remove the claw [1] to remove the Reader Shaft Retainer [2].
2) While supporting the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [3], remove the Reader Support
■■Procedure Shaft [4].
3) Bring down the Reader Support Shaft [4] to close the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit [3].

CAUTION:

When removing the Control Panel Unit, the Screw Face Seal [2] on the back side of the
Reader Unit [1] needs to be removed. Be sure to prepare a new Screw Face Seal to [3]
[1] [4]
reaffix it later.When reaffixing, be sure to use a new Screw Face Seal. Do not reuse the [2]
removed Screw Cover Seal.

[2]
[1]

F-4-441
4) ADF+Open the ADF+Reader Unit [1], and remove the 3 Screw Face Seals [2] at the bottom
of the Reader Unit.

CAUTION:

F-4-440 Do not reuse the removed Screw Cover Seal [2].

[2]
[1]

F-4-442

4-196
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4-197
5) Remove the screws at the bottom of the Reader Unit [1]. 7) Shift the Control Panel Unit [1], and disconnect the Faston Connector [2].
• 1 Binding Screw [2] • 14 Claws [3]
• 8 Screws [3]

[1]

x6
[2]

[3]
[2] [3]

[3]

x14
[1]

F-4-443
6) Open the ADF Unit/Copyboard [1] and place a sheet of paper [2] on the copyboard.

[1]
[3] [3]
F-4-445

CAUTION:

Do not touch the IC part [A] of the LCD Flat Cable [1].

[2]

[1]
F-4-444

F-4-446

4-197
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4-198
8) Turn the Control Panel Unit [1] over, and disconnect the Flat Cable [2].
CAUTION:
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [3]
Be sure to perform the following when connecting the Flat Cable [1] to the connector
CAUTION: with a lock [2].
Be sure to insert the Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after checking
Do not damage and cut the Flat Cable [2].
that both sides (edges) [A] of the Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves [B] of the
connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].

[3] [2]
[3]
[B]
[2]
[1] [A]
[2]

[B]
[A]
[1] [1]

[3] [2]
[B]
F-4-447 [2]
[A]

[B]
[A]
[1] [1]

F-4-448

4-198
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4-199
Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control 1) Remove the Control Panel LCD PCB [1].
• 1 Wire Saddle [2]
Panel Key PCB • 1 Connector [3]
• 1 Flat Cable Connector Lock [4]
■■Preparation
• 1 LCD Flat Cable [5]
1) Remove the the Control Panel Unit. Refer to page 4-196 • 3 Screws [6]

[6]
■■Procedure
[2]
CAUTION: [4]

Do not touch the IC part [A] of the LCD Flat Cable [1].
x2

x3
[1] [1]
[3]
[5]

F-4-450
2) Remove the Control Panel LCD PCB Mounting Plate [1].
• 3 Screws [2] (Binding)

[1]

F-4-449
x3

[1]
F-4-451

4-199
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4-200
3) Remove the Control Panel Key PCB [1].
CAUTION:
• 10 Screws [2] (Binding)

[2] [2] [2] Be sure to perform the following when connecting the LCD Flat Cable [1] to the
connector with a lock [2].
Be sure to insert the LCD Flat Cable [1] into the connector with a lock [2], and after
x10 checking that both sides (edges) [A] of the LCD Flat Cable [1] are fitted in the 2 grooves
[B] of the connector with a lock [2], lock the Flat Cable Connector Lock [3].

[3]
[2]
[B]
[2] [A]

[1]
[B]
F-4-452 [A]
[1] [1]

[3]
[2]
[B]
[2] [A]

[B]

[A] [1] [1]

F-4-453

4-200
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Control Panel LCD PCB and Control Panel Key PCB > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8280Cw/8250Cn) > Procedure
4-201
Removing the FAX PCB (MF8280Cw/8250Cn) Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8280Cw/8250Cn)
■■Preparation ■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147. 1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.
3) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182. ■■Procedure
4) Remove the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-183.
1) Remove the Off Hook PCB [1].
• 2 Connectors [2]
■■Procedure • 2 Screws [3]
1) Remove the Fax PCB [1].
• 1 Flat Cable [2]
• 1 Connector [3] [1]
[2]
• 4 Screws [4] x2

[3] [1]
x2
x2

x4 [4]
[3]

F-4-455

[2]
[4]

F-4-454

4-201
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Off Hook PCB (MF8280Cw/8250Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-202
Removing the Main Drive Unit ■■Procedure
1) Pull out the Cartridge Tray [1].
■■Preparation
2) Remove the ITB Fixing Holder [2].
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147. • 1 Screw [3]
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144. • 2 Hooks [4]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158
5) Remove the Upper Cover.Refer to page 4-156
6) Remove the DC Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-186. [1]
7) Remove the Driver PCB. Refer to page 4-187 [4]
8) Remove the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit. Refer to page 4-190.
9) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
10) Remove the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-183.
11) Remove the Off Hook PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201
12) Remove the Fax PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201

[3] [2]

F-4-456
3) Disconnect the Flat Cable [1].
• 2 Guides [2]

[1]
[2]

x2

F-4-457

4-202
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-203
4) Free the harness [1] from the guide [A]. 8) Free the harness [1] from the guide [A].
5) Free the harness [2] from the guides [A], and [B]. 9) Remove the Harness Support Plate [2].
6) Free the harnesses [3] and [4] from the guides [A], [B], and [C]. • 1 Screw [3]

[4] [2]
[4]

[3] [1]
[3]

[1]
[1]

[A]
[C]

[B] [2]

[A] [3] [2]

F-4-458 F-4-460

7) While lifting the Connecting Plate [1], remove the Flag Unit [2]. 10) While lifting the Connecting Plate [1], remove the Sub Drive Unit Cover [2].
• 3 Screws [2] • 2 Screws [3]
• 1 Boss [3]
[3]
[1]
[3] [4] [3] [2]
x2
x3 [2] [1]
[1]

[1]
[2] [2]
[3]
F-4-461

F-4-459

4-203
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-204
11) Place a sheet of paper [1] over the hole [A], and remove the Link Shaft Stopper [2].
CAUTION:
• 2 Claws [3]
When installing the Link Shaft, be sure to fit the boss [1] of the Link Shaft to the groove [2]
NOTE: of the arm of the Main Drive Unit.
The reason a sheet of paper [1] is placed over the hole [A] is to prevent the Link Shaft
Stopper [2] from falling in the machine.
[2]
[1]

x2
[3]

[A]

[1]
[2] F-4-464

F-4-462
12) Remove the Link Shaft [1].
• 2 Bosses [2]

[2]

[1]

F-4-463

4-204
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-205
13) Remove the Main Switch Unit [1]. 15) Free the harness [1].
• 2 Screws [2] • 1 Connector [2]
• Guide [A]
16) Free the harness [3].
• Guides [A] and [B]
x2

[1] [2]

[B]
[2] [3]
x2

F-4-465
14) While lifting the Frame Plate [1], remove the DC Controller Support Plate [2].
• 2 Screws [3] [1] [A]
• 1 Protrusion [4]
F-4-467
17) Remove the Harness Guide [1].
[1]
• 1 Claw [2]
x2 [4]
• 2 Hooks [3]

[2]
[2]

[3]
[1]
[3]
F-4-466

F-4-468

4-205
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-206
18) While lifting the Frame Plate [1], remove the Fax Cover Plate [2]. 20) Remove the Harness Guide [1].
• 2 Screws [3] • 1 Boss [2]
• 1 Boss [4] • 3 Hooks [3]
• 1 Protrusion [5]
• 1 Hook [6]
[2]
[4] [5]
[3]

[1]
x2 [3] [3]
[6]
[2] [3]

[1]

[2]
F-4-471

F-4-469 21) Remove the Harness Guide [1].


19) Remove the Harness Guide [1]. • 2 Bosses [2]
• 1 Boss [2] • 1 Hook [3]
• 2 Hooks [3]

[2] [1]

[2]
[3] [1]

[3]

[3]

F-4-472
F-4-470

4-206
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-207
22) Release the 2 hooks [1] of the Main Drive Unit from the claw [2] in the direction of the
CAUTION:
arrow, and remove the Main Drive Unit [3].
• 7 Screws [4] At installation, check that the hook [2] of the gear [1] of the Sub Drive Unit is in the
correct position as shown in the figure below.
If not, rotate the gear [1] in the direction of the arrow to set the hook [2] in the correct
position.

[2]

[1]
[1]

[2]
[2]

[1] [2] [1]

[3]
x7

[4]

[4] [4]

F-4-473 F-4-474

4-207
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4-208

CAUTION:

• Be sure to check that the ITB Link [2] of the Main Drive Unit [1] is set at the correct
position as shown in the figure below.If not, turn the ITB Link [2] in the direction of
the arrow to be set at the correct position.
• Be sure to check that the Cartridge Cover Link [3] of the Main Drive Unit [1] is set at
the correct position as shown in the figure below.If not, pull out the Cartridge Cover
Link [3].
• Be sure to install the shaft [4] of the Main Drive Unit by fitting it in the hole [5] of the
Side Plate.

[2]

[2]

[5] [4]

[2] [1]

[3] [3]

F-4-475

4-208
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Sub Drive Unit > Procedure
4-209
Removing the Sub Drive Unit CAUTION:

■■Preparation • When installing the Sub Drive Unit, go through the following steps.

1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147. 1) Install the bushing [2] and the Parallel Pin [3] to the shaft [1].
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144. 2) At installation, rotate the shaft [1] and the gear [4] to make the directions of the
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153. Parallel Pin [3] and the pin reception horizontally-aligned.
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158 • Depending on the direction of the shaft [1], the Parallel Pin [3] may fall. Be careful
5) Remove the Upper Cover.Refer to page 4-156 not to drop or lose it.
6) Remove the DC Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-186.
7) Remove the Driver PCB. Refer to page 4-187
8) Remove the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit. Refer to page 4-190.
9) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
10) Remove the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-183.
11) Remove the Off Hook PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201
12) Remove the Fax PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201
13) Remove the the Main Drive Unit. Refer to page 4-202
[4] [5]

■■Procedure
1) Remove the Sub Drive Unit [1].
• 2 Screws [2]
• 1 Parallel Pin [3]
• 1 Bushing [4]

[1]
x2 [1]
[4] [2] [3]
[3]
F-4-477

[2]

F-4-476

4-209
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Sub Drive Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Motor > Procedure
4-210
Removing the Main Motor 2) Remove the Main Motor [1].
• 1 Connector [2]
■■Preparation • 4 Screws [3]

1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.


[3]
2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.
3) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
4) Remove the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-183.

■■Procedure x4
[2]
[1]
1) Free the harness [1], Flat Cable [2] and remove the Main Controller Support Plate [3].
• Guide [A]
• Guide [B]
• 6 Screws [4]

[3] [3]

F-4-479
x2 [1] x6
[2] [4]

[A]

[4]
[B] [1]

F-4-478

4-210
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Main Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fan > Procedure
4-211
Removing the Fan 2) Free the Fan Retainer Spring [1] from the 2 guides [A] of the Fan Duct.
3) While lifting the edge [B] of the Low Voltage Power Supply Unit Cover, free the Fan
■■Preparation Retainer Spring [1] from the hole [C] of the plate.
• 1 Claw [3]
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.

■■Procedure [1] [1]


1) Free the harness [1].
• 1 Connector [2]
• Guide [A]
[A]
[A]
[2]

[1]
[2] [B]
[A]

[C]

F-4-480

F-4-481

4-211
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Fan > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Speaker (MF8280Cw/8250Cn) > Procedure
4-212
4) Remove the fan [1].
Removing the Speaker (MF8280Cw/8250Cn)
• 2 Claws [2]
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.
x2
[1]
■■Procedure
1) Remove the Speaker [1].
• 1 Connector [2]
[2] • Guide [A]
• 2 Claws [3]

[2]

F-4-482
[A]

[3]
CAUTION:

When installing the fan [1], be sure to set its orientation as shown in the figure below.
• Face the label [2] inside.
• Face the harness [3] upward.
x2
[3] [1]

F-4-484

[2]
[1]

F-4-483

4-212
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Controller System > Removing the Speaker (MF8280Cw/8250Cn) > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-213

Laser Exposure System Removing the Laser Scanner Unit


■■Preparation
Location
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
[1]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153
4) Remove the ADF Unit/Copyboard + Reader Unit. Refer to page 4-158
5) Remove the Upper Cover.Refer to page 4-156

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, be sure to perform the following procedure.
• After Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit (Refer to page 4-94)

CAUTION:

• The ITB Unit is under the Laser Scanner Unit. Ensure to close a Cartridge Tray when
performing this procedure, because there is a possibility that the ITB Unit might be
damaged when the Laser Scanner Unit is mistakenly dropped during installation/
removal.
F-4-485
• Be sure not to disassemble the Laser Scanner Unit because it requires adjustment.
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment during
parts replacement
[1] Laser Scanner Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-213) (Refer to page 4-94)
Configuration
T-4-43

4-213
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-214
1) Disconnect the Flat Cable [1]. 4) Free the harness [1] from the guide [A].
2) Disconnect the 2 Flat Cables [2]. 5) Free the harness [2] from the guide [A] and [B].
• 2 Guides [3] 6) Free the harness [3] and [4] from the guide [A], [B], and [C].

[3] [4]
[4]

x2 [3]

[1]
[1]
x2
[C]

[B] [2]

[A] [3] [2]


[1] [2]
F-4-488
F-4-486
7) While lifting the Connecting Plate [1], remove the Flag Unit [2].
3) Disconnect the 4 connectors [1].
• 3 Screws [2]
• 1 Boss [3]
[1]
[3] [4] [3]
x4
x3
[1]

[1] [1]
[2] [2]
[3]
F-4-487

F-4-489

4-214
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-215
8) Free the harness [1] from the guide [A]. 11) Remove the spring [1].
9) Remove the Harness Support Plate [2]. • 1 Hole [A] of the Sensor Arm
• 1 Screw [3] • 1 Hook [2]

[2]

[1]
[3]

[A]

F-4-490
10) While lifting the Connecting Plate [1], remove the Sub Drive Unit Cover [2].
• 2 Screws [3]

[3]
[1]
[2] [1] [2]
x2 [A] [1]
[2] [1]

F-4-492

F-4-491

4-215
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4-216
12) Remove the Scanner Fixation Spring [1] on the right side. 15) Remove the Laser Scanner Unit [1].
• 1 Hook [2] • 2 Bosses [2]
• 1 Groove [A] • 3 Protrusions [3]
13) Remove the Scanner Fixation Spring [3] on the left side.
[3]
• 1 Hook [4] [1]
• 1 Groove [B]
14) Remove the Scanner Fixation Spring [5] on the rear side.
• 1 Hook [6]
• 1 Groove [C]

[5]
[2]
[6]
[C]
[4]
F-4-494

[B]

[3]

[3]

[A]

[1]

F-4-493

4-216
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > After replacing laser exposure units
4-217
■■After replacing laser exposure units 2) After values are registered, affix the label [1] packaged with the unit on the inside [2] of the
right cover.
1) Register values indicated on the label packaged with the Laser Scanner Unit in the
• MF8200 series
following service mode items.
COPIER>ADJUST>SCNR>
SUB-S-Y0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 Y)
SUB-S-M0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 M)
SUB-S-C0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 C) [2]

SUB-S-K0(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 K) [1]


SUB-S-Y1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 Y)
SUB-S-M1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 M)
SUB-S-C1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 C)
SUB-S-K1(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 K)
SUB-S-Y2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 Y)
SUB-S-M2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 M)
SUB-S-C2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 C)
SUB-S-K2(Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 K) F-4-495
MAI-S-Y0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 Y)
MAI-S-M0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 M)
MAI-S-C0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 C)
MAI-S-K0(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 K)
MAI-S-Y1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 Y)
MAI-S-M1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 M)
MAI-S-C1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 C)
MAI-S-K1(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 K)
MAI-S-Y2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 Y)
MAI-S-M2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 M)
MAI-S-C2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 C)
MAI-S-K2(Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 K)

4-217
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Laser Exposure System > Removing the Laser Scanner Unit > After replacing laser exposure units
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-218

Image Formation System Removing the ITB Unit


■■Preparation
Location
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-156.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Do not touch the ITB.

[2]
CAUTION:

While removing the cartridges, be sure not to scratch the drum surface. And cover the
drum surface.

1) Open the Front Cover [1].


2) Pull out the Cartridge Tray [1].

CAUTION:

Since the Cartridge Tray interferes with the stopper when removing the stopper, do not
[1]
pull out the Cartridge Tray until it hits the end.
F-4-496

No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment


during parts
replacement
[1] ITB Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-218) -
Configuration
[2] Secondary Transfer Outer Product - (Refer to page 4-223) -
Roller Configuration
T-4-44

[1] [2]

F-4-497

4-218
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-219
3) Remove the cartridges 8) Remove the Cartridge Tray [1].
4) Insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the clearance [A] between the Right Stopper [1] and rail.
5) Remove the Right Stopper [1] while pushing the [B] part.
• 2 Claws [2]
• 1 Protrusion [3]

[1]

[A]
[B]

[3]

F-4-500
9) Free the harness [1].
[2] [1]
• 1 Connector [2]
• 1 Harness Guide [A]

F-4-498
[2]
6) Insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the clearance [A] between the Left Stopper [1] and rail.
7) Remove the Left Stopper [1] while pushing the [B] part.
• 2 Claws [2]
• 1 Protrusion [3]

[A]
[B]
[1]

[A]

F-4-501

[3] [1] [2]

F-4-499

4-219
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-220
10) Remove the ITB Fixing Holder [1].
CAUTION:
• 1 screw [2]
Do not place the Drive Link [2] of the ITB Unit on the edge of the rail [B]; otherwise, the
ITB Unit [1] falls.

[1]

[2] [1]

F-4-502

CAUTION:

When removing the ITB Unit [1], do not touch the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller [2].

[2] [2]

[B]
[B]

F-4-504

[1]

[2]
F-4-503

4-220
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-221
11) Hold the 2 parts [A] of the ITB Unit to pull out the ITB Unit [1]. Then, place the ITB Drive 12) Put the connector [1] through the hole [A] of the guide, and secure the harness [2] to the
Link [2] at the center of the rail [B]. plate [3] of the ITB Unit using tapes [4].

CAUTION:
[A]
When installing/removing the ITB Unit, be sure to secure the harness [2] using tapes to
prevent it from being caught inside the host machine.

[1]
[3]
[2] [2] [2]
[4]

[A]

[B] [B]

[1]
F-4-505

[A] [1]

F-4-506

4-221
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4-222
13) Hold the 2 parts [A] of the ITB Unit and pull out the ITB Unit [1] horizontally by approx. 5
CAUTION:
cm.
• When holding the ITB Unit [1], be sure not to hold the plate [A] and [B]; otherwise, the 14) Hold the 2 guides [B] at the both ends of the ITB Unit, and remove the ITB Unit [1].
plate [A] may be deformed. [A] [B]

[1] [B]

m
5c
[1]
[A]

F-4-507
• When installing/removing the ITB Unit [1], be sure not to tilt it; otherwise, the surface
[A] of the ITB may be damaged.

[A] [A]

[1] [1]

F-4-508

4-222
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the ITB Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller > Procedure
4-223
Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller 2) Remove the 2 stoppers [1].
• 2 claws [2]
■■Procedure 3) Remove the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller [3].

1) Open the Rear Cover [1].

[1]

[2]

[1]

F-4-509

[1]

[2]

[3]

F-4-510

4-223
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller > Procedure
4-224

CAUTION:

When installing the Secondary Transfer External Roller, take note of the direction of the
Secondary Transfer Roller [1].

[1]
long short

F-4-511

4-224
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Image Formation System > Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4-225

Fixing System Removing the Fixing Assembly


■■Preparation
Location
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
[1] [2]
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154.

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Take some time until the fixing assembly gets cooler and then remove it because the
fixing assembly right after the power supply is turned off is at high heat

1) Remove the Fixing Power Supply Cover [1].


• 2 screws [2]

x2

[1]
[3]

[4]
F-4-512

No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment [2] [2]
during parts
F-4-513
replacement
[1] Fixing Assembly Product - (Refer to page 4-225) -
Configuration
[2] Fixing Motor Product M703 (Refer to page 4-232) -
Configuration
[3] Fixing Pressure Roller Fixing - (Refer to page 4-231) -
Assembly
[4] Fixing Film Unit Fixing - (Refer to page 4-228) -
Assembly
T-4-45

4-225
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4-226
2) Free the 1 harness [1]. 3) Free the 2 harnesses [1].
• 2 connectors [2] • 2 connectors [2]
• Harness guide [A] • Guide [B]
• Guide [C]
[1] • 1 Wire Saddle [3]

x2

[1]

[2]
[A]

[1]
[B]

x2
[1]

x3 [2] [1]

[C]

[3]
F-4-514

F-4-515

4-226
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4-227
4) Remove the Fixing Assembly [1].
• 4 screws [2]

x4
[2]

[2]
[1]

F-4-516

4-227
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Assembly > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Replacing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-228
Replacing the Fixing Film Unit ■■Procedure
■■Preparation CAUTION:
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
When installing/removing the Fixing Film Unit [1], be sure not to touch the Fixing Film [2].
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154. [2]
5) Remove the Fixing Assembly. Refer to page 4-225.
[1]

F-4-517

CAUTION:

When removing the Spring Retainer Holders [1] and the springs [2], be sure to hold
them to prevent them from coming off because pressure is applied to them.

[1]

[2]

F-4-518

4-228
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Replacing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Replacing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-229
1) Remove the 2 Spring Retainer Holders [1] (right and left) and the 2 springs [2].
CAUTION:
2) Remove the 2 Pressure Plates [3] (right and left).
• 2 Protrusions [4] At installation, be sure to match the protrusion [1] of the Spring Retainer Holder with the
cut-off parts [2] of the Fixing Frame.

[1]

[4] [2]

[2]
[1]

[3] [1]
[4]

[2]

[3]

F-4-519
[1]

[2]

F-4-520

4-229
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Replacing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Replacing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4-230
3) Remove the gear [1].
CAUTION:
• 1 Claw [2]
4) Remove the Shaft Unit [3] and the bushing [4]. At installation, be sure to combine the Guide Retainer Plate [1] with the Fixing Guide
(Upper) [2] before installing them to the Fixing Assembly.
• 3 Protrusions [3]

[3] [2] [3]

[1]

[2] [4] [3]

F-4-521 [1]
5) Remove the Guide Retainer Plate [1] and the Fixing Guide (Upper) [2]. F-4-523
• 2 Screws [3]
• 2 Protrusions [4]

[3] 6) Remove the gear [1].


• 1 Claw [2]

x2 [4]
[2]

[2]
[1]
[1]

F-4-522

F-4-524

4-230
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Replacing the Fixing Film Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller > Procedure
4-231
7) Disconnect the connector [1].
Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller
■■Preparation
1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
2) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
3) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
4) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154.
5) Remove the Fixing Assembly. Refer to page 4-225.
6) Remove the Fixing Film Unit. Refer to page 4-228.

■■Procedure
[1] 1) Remove the Fixing Pressure Roller [1].
• 1 Bushing [2]
F-4-525
8) Free the harness [1] from the guide [A]. [1]
9) Remove the Fixing Film Unit [2].
[2]

[2]

[1]

[A]
F-4-527

F-4-526

4-231
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Pressure Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Motor > Procedure
4-232
Removing the Fixing Motor 2) Slide the Fixing Motor [1] in the upper right direction to remove.
• 1 connector [2]
■■Preparation • 2 screws [3]

1) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.


2) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182.
3) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
4) Remove the Main Controller PCB. Refer to page 4-183.

[1]
■■Procedure
x2
1) Free the harness [1], Flat Cable [2] and remove the Main Controller Support Plate [3].
• Guide [A]
[3]
• Guide [B]
• 6 Screws [4] [2]
[3] [3]

F-4-529
x2 [1] x6
[2] [4]

[A]

[4]
[B] [1]

F-4-528

4-232
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Fixing System > Removing the Fixing Motor > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller > Procedure
4-233

Pickup Feeder System Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller


■■Procedure
Location
CAUTION:

Be sure not to touch the surface of the Cassette Pickup Roller [1] and the Cassette
Separation Roller [2].

[1] [2]

[1]

F-4-531

[2]
1) Turn ON the power switch.
2) Execute the following items in Service mode.
COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > FD-R-CHG
3) The Pickup Roller rotates and stops at the replacement position.
4) Turn OFF the power.

[4] [3] CAUTION:


F-4-530
Before tilting a host machine, remove toner cartridges (Y, M, C, Bk).
No. Parts Name Main Unit Remarks Reference Adjustment
during parts
replacement
[1] Pickup Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-242) -
Configuration
[2] Multi-purpose Tray Unit Product - (Refer to page 4-237) -
Configuration
[3] Cassette Separation Roller Pickup Unit - (Refer to page 4-235) -
[4] Cassette Pickup Roller Pickup Unit - (Refer to page 4-233) -
T-4-46

4-233
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller > Procedure
4-234
5) Remove the cassette [1]. 7) Open 2 projections [1] of the holder in the arrow direction, and remove the cassette Pickup
Roller [2].
• 2 Claws [3]
• 2 Hooks [4]

[1] x2

[1] [4]

F-4-532 [2]
6) Place a host machine [1] as the Left Cover faces to the bottom. [3]
[1]

CAUTION: F-4-534

When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
from opening.
In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the main body to its
original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause damage on the main
body or injuries by catching the fingers.

[1] [1]

F-4-533

4-234
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Pickup Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4-235
Removing the Cassette Separation Roller 1) Remove the cassette [1].

■■Procedure

CAUTION:

Be sure not to touch the surface of the Cassette Pickup Roller [1] and the Cassette
Separation Roller [2]. [1]

[1] [2]

F-4-536
2) Make the Left Cover face down and place the host machine [1].

CAUTION:

When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
from opening.
F-4-535
In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the main body to its
original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause damage on the main
body or injuries by catching the fingers.
CAUTION:

Before tilting a host machine, remove toner cartridges (Y, M, C, Bk).

[1] [1]

F-4-537

4-235
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4-236
3) Remove the 2 projections [1] to remove the Cover [2].
CAUTION:

At installation, be sure to align the protrusion [A] of the Cassette Separation Roller [2]
with the groove [B] of the holder while opening the holder [1].
[1]
[B]
[2]

[1]
[2]

[1]

F-4-538 [A]
4) While opening the holder [1], remove the Cassette Separation Roller [2].
• 2 Claws [3]
• 1 Protrusion [4] F-4-540

[1]
x2 [2]

[3]

[4]

[3]

F-4-539

4-236
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Cassette Separation Roller > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Procedure
4-237
Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit 2) Open the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Cover.
3) Move the 2 Multi-purpose Tray Paper Width Guide Plates [1] to the center as shown in the
■■Preparation figure below.

1) Remove the Toner Cartridges (Bk, C, M and Y).

CAUTION:

When installing/removing the Toner Cartridge, be careful not to damage the


Photosensitive Drum because it is exposed. Also, be sure to block light.
[1]

2) Remove the cassette.

■■Procedure
1) Place the host machine with the Left Cover [1] down.

F-4-542
CAUTION:

When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
from opening.
In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the main body to its
original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause damage on the main
body or injuries by catching the fingers.

[1]
F-4-541

4-237
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Procedure
4-238
4) Lower the claw [1], move the shaft [3] at the lower side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit [2] 5) While pushing the shaft [2] at the lower side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit [1] down,
to the leading edge [A] of the claw [1], and then push the shaft [4] at the upper side of the remove the shaft [3] at the upper side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit from the groove [B],
Multi-purpose Tray Unit all the way to the groove [B]. and insert it into [C] part.

[B] [3]
[B]

[4]

[C]

[2]
[1]

[3] [1]
[2]

[A]

F-4-543 F-4-544

4-238
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Installation Method
4-239
6) Remove the Multi-purpose Tray Unit [1]. ■■Installation Method
1) Set the 2 links [1] of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit as shown in the figure below.

[1]

[1]

F-4-545

[1]

F-4-546

4-239
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Installation Method
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Installation Method
4-240
2) Insert the shaft [2] at the upper side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit [1] into the groove [A], 3) Fit the 2 grooves [2] of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit [1] to the 2 protrusions [3] of the links of
and the shaft [3] at the lower side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit into the groove [B]. the Multi-purpose Tray Unit.

[2]
[A]

[2] [3]

[1]

[1]

[3]

[B] [3]

F-4-547
[2]

F-4-548

4-240
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Installation Method
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Installation Method
4-241
4) Move the shaft [2] at the upper side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit [1] to the groove [C], and
the shaft [3] at the lower side of the Multi-purpose Tray Unit to the groove [D].

[C] [2]

[1]

[D] [3]

F-4-549
5) Perform the step 3 and earlier steps of the Removing Procedure in reverse order.

4-241
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Unit > Installation Method
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-242
Removing the Pickup Unit ■■Procedure
1) Remove the Fax PCB Mounting Plate [1].
■■Preparation
• 4 Screws [2]
1) Remove the Toner Cartridges (Bk, C, M and Y). • 2 Hooks [3]

CAUTION:

When installing/removing the Toner Cartridge, be careful not to damage the


Photosensitive Drum because it is exposed. Also, be sure to block light.
x4
[3]

2) Remove the cassette.


3) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to page 4-147.
4) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to page 4-144.
5) Remove the Rear Upper Cover. Refer to page 4-153.
6) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. Refer to page 4-154.
7) Remove the ITB Unit.Refer to page 4-218 [1]
[2]
8) Remove the Fixing Power Supply Unit.Refer to page 4-195
F-4-550
9) Remove the Controller Cover. Refer to page 4-182
2) Free the harness [1] from the guides [A], [B], and [C].
10) Remove the Wireless LAN PCB.(MF8280Cw/8240Cw only) Refer to page 4-182.
• 4 Connectors [2]
11) Remove the Main Controller PCB.Refer to page 4-183
12) Remove the Off Hook PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201
13) Remove the Fax PCB.(Fax model only) Refer to page 4-201

x4 [2]
[A]
[1]

x3
[2]

[C]
[B]
F-4-551

4-242
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-243
3) Free the harness [1] from the guide [E] by putting it through the hole [D] of the plate. 5) Remove the Sensor Cover Plate [1].
4) Free the harness [2] from the guide [F]. • 1 Screw [2]
• 1 Wire Saddle [3]

[1]

[2]

F-4-553
6) Remove the Sensor Cover [1].
• 1 Claw [2]
• 1 Hook [3]
[F]
[D] [3] [1]
x2 x2

[1]

[3]

[E] [2]

F-4-552
[2]

F-4-554

4-243
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-244
7) Disconnect the connector [2] of the sensor [1]. 8) Install the Right Cover [1], and close the Front Cover [2].
• 4 Claws [3] • 9 Claws

CAUTION:
[1] [1]
When installing the Right Cover [1], be careful not to trap the harness [2].
x4
[2]
[3]

[1]

F-4-555

[2]

F-4-556

x9

[2]

[1]
F-4-557

4-244
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-245
9) Place the host machine with the Right Cover [1] down. 11) Remove the 2 springs [1] using a pair of needlenose pliers.
• 4 Hooks [2]
CAUTION:

When laying down the main body, be sure to secure the ADF Unit with tape to prevent
from opening.
[1]
In case that the ADF Unit is not secured with tape, when returning the main body to its
original position, the ADF Unit is closed swiftly, so this might cause damage on the main
body or injuries by catching the fingers.

[2]

[1]

[1]

F-4-558
10) Move the 2 Multi-purpose Tray Paper Width Guide Plates [1] to the inside as shown in the
[2]
figure below.

F-4-560

[1]

F-4-559

4-245
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4 Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
4-246
12) Remove the Pickup Unit [1].
2) Push the lower side of the Pickup Unit [1], and fit the protrusion [2] of the host
• 2 Screws [2]
machine into the hole [A] of the plate.
• 2 Bosses [3]

[3]

x2 [3]

[1]
[1]
[1]

[2]

[A] [2]
[3]
[3]
F-4-563
F-4-561
3) Push the upper side of the Pickup Unit [1] to fit the protrusion [2] of the host machine
CAUTION: into the hole [B] of the plate, and secure with the 2 screws [3] removed previously.

When installing the Pickup Unit, go through the following steps.


1) Align the 2 bosses [1] of the Pickup Unit with the 2 edges [A] of the cut-off of the host [B] [2]
machine, and install the Pickup Unit [2] on the host machine. x2

[1]

[3]

[A] [2]
[1]

F-4-564

[1]

F-4-562

4-246
4
Disassembly/Assembly > Pickup Feeder System > Removing the Pickup Unit > Procedure
5 Adjustment

■Overview

■Adjustment at Parts
Replacement

5
Adjustment
5 Adjustment > Overview
5-2

Overview

Category Parts replacement Reference


Controller System Main Controller PCB
Laser Exposure System Laser Scaner Unit
Image Formation System Developing Assembly, Developing Sleeve Unit
Drum Unit
ITB
Patch Sensor
T-5-1

5-2
5
Adjustment > Overview
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Document Exposure / Feed System > After replacing reader units
5-3

Adjustment at Parts Replacement ■■After replacing reader units


1) Release 2 claws [1] and Remove the Scoopup sheet holder [2], Enter the setting value of
Document Exposure / Feed System the Standard White Plate.

[2]
■■After replacing ADF units
1) After executing the white level adjustment with the following service mode 1, check the
x2
auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service label. [1]
[1]
1. White level adjustment
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
2. Checking the setting value F-5-1
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF) • COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X (X signal data for the standard white plate)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF) • COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Y (Y signal data for the standard white plate)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF) • COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Z (Z signal data for the standard white plate)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
using DF) MEMO
The value of W-PLT-X: The first four digits of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Y: The four digits in the middle of the value on the label
2) Execute the reading position adjustment with the following service mode. The value of W-PLT-Z: The last four digits of the value on the label
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning 2) Execute the white level adjustment.
position in FEEDER mode) • COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed) • COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)

3) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading. 3) After executing the reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, check
• FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service
reading) label.
• FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment) 1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value
reference)

5-3
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Document Exposure / Feed System > After replacing reader units
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Document Exposure / Feed System > After replacing reader units
5-4
4) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with 6) Read the image and execute the adjustment with the following service mode.
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service • FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
mode 2 and write the value in the service label. reading)
1. White level adjustment • FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
using DF)

5) Enter the value on the label packed with the part in the following service mode item.
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning
position in FEEDER mode)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> 50-RG (Color displacement correction value between RG
in the vertical scanning direction (50%))
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>50-GB (Color displacement correction value between GB
in the vertical scanning direction (50%))
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>100-RG (Color displacement correction value between RG
in the vertical scanning direction (100%))
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD>100-GB (Color displacement correction value between GB
in the vertical scanning direction (100%))
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL>OFST-P-Y (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-M (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-C (Adjustment of test chart reading density)
• COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL> OFST-P-K (Adjustment of test chart reading density)

5-4
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Document Exposure / Feed System > After replacing reader units
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Document Exposure / Feed System > After replacing CIS units
5-5
■■After Replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit 3) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
1) Enter the setting value of the Standard White Plate.
mode 2 and write the value in the service label.
1. White level adjustment
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
F-5-2
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-X (X signal data for the standard white plate) 2. Checking the setting value
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Y (Y signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > W-PLT-Z (Z signal data for the standard white plate) • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
MEMO • COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
The value of W-PLT-X: The first four digits of the value on the label using DF)
The value of W-PLT-Y: The four digits in the middle of the value on the label
The value of W-PLT-Z: The last four digits of the value on the label

■■After replacing CIS units


2) After executing the CCD reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, 1) Execute the white level adjustment. If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the
check the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the operation again.
service label. • COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC (Color AGC adjustment)
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto • COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > BW-AGC (B&W AGC adjustment)
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value 2) After executing the reading position adjustment with the following service mdoe 1, check
reference) the auto setting value with the following service mode 2 and write the value in the service
label.
1. COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment auto
execution)
2. COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS (reading position adjustment value
reference)

5-5
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Document Exposure / Feed System > After replacing CIS units
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Controller System > Main controller PCBs
5-6
3) Set a blank paper on the Copyboard Glass, and execute the white level adjustment with
Controller System
the following service mode 1. Then, check the auto setting value with the following service
mode 2 and write the value in the service label. ■■Main controller PCBs
1. White level adjustment
Before Replacing the Main Controller PCB
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL1 (White level adjustment [copyboard
Back up user data (settings, registered data, etc.) and service mode data for setting and
scanning])
registration after PCB replacement. Take notes if data is unable to back up.
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL3 (White level adjustment BW [copyboard
scanning])
1) In Remote UI, perform the following procedure to export the user data (login in
Then, set a blank paper on the DF, and execute the following service mode.
administrator mode).
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL2 (White level adjustment [DF scanning])
In Setting/Registration > Import/Export > Menu > Export, select an item and then start
• COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD > DF-WLVL4 (White level adjustment BW [DF
export.
scanning])
If it fails, turn OFF/ON the power and execute the operation again.
2) In service mode, perform the following procedure to export the service mode data (and
2. Checking the setting value
then import it after replacement).
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R (RED shading target value when using DF)
FUNCTION > SYSTEM > EXPORT
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G (GREEN shading target value when using DF)
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B (BLUE shading target value when using DF)
3) Record the default settings shown on the service label [1] (these are entered after
• COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW (Monochrome shading target value when
replacement).
using DF)

4) Write down the machine's serial number and the data of Settings/Registration > System
4) Execute the reading position adjustment with the following service mode.
Settings > Device Information> Location (these are entered after replacement).
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y (Value adjustment for image reading start
position [vertical scanning direction] <X-axis direction>)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-Y-DF (Adjustment of surface horizontal scanning
position in FEEDER mode)
• COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY > ADJ-X-MG (Fine-adjustment of optical motor speed) [1]

5) Execute the original stop position and feed speed adjustment at stream reading.
• FEEDER > ADJUST > DOCST (Image reading start position adjustment at ADF
reading)
• FEEDER > ADJUST > LA-SPEED (Original feed speed adjustment)

F-5-3

5-6
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Controller System > Main controller PCBs
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Controller System > Main controller PCBs
5-7
After Replacing the Main Controller PCB 4. Migrating the serial number
1. Setting of destination/paper size group 1) Enter the serial number (8-digit alphanumeric) in Settings/Registration > System Settings
1) COPIER > OPTION > BODY > LOCALE (to set destination groups) > Device Information > Location.
[Settings] 2) Select COPIER > OPTION > SERIAL > SN-MAIN. Then, press the OK key to write the
1: Japan, 2: North America, 3: Korea, 4: China, 5: Taiwan, 6: Europe, 7: Asia, serial number entered in step 1 in the Main Controller PCB. After it has been written, the
8: Oceania serial number entered in "Location" in step 1 is deleted.
2) COPIER > OPTION > BODY > SIZE-LC (to set paper size groups) 3) Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
[Settings] 4) Execute COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P> SPEC to output the spec report to check the
1: AB series, 2: Inch series, 3: A series, 4: AB/Inch series serial number BODY.No..
2. Clearing Setting/Registration data 5) Enter the data of the installation location (which was written down in "Before replacing
1) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > ALL (to clear all data) the Main Controller PCB") in Settings/Registration > System Settings > Device Information
Once executed, the following data are cleared according to the values of LOCALE and > Location.
SIZE-LC set in step 1. 5. Migrating user data
• Setting / Registration data (the default value for each destination is set). In Remote UI, perform the following procedure to import the user data (login in
• Service mode data (the default value for each destination is set). administrator mode).
• Job IDs In Setting/Registration > Import/Export > Menu > Import, select an item and then start
• Log data import.
• Dates 6. Migrating service mode data
2) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > R-CON (to clear default setting values for the In service mode, perform the following procedure to import the service mode data.
reader/DF) FUNCTION > SYSTEM > IMPORT
3. Adjustment, input of default setting values
1) Close the ADF.
2) COPIER> FUNCTION > CCD > CL-AGC, BW-AGC (to adjust white levels)
The white level is adjusted.
3) Enter default setting values indicated on the service label in the corresponding service
mode items.
4) COPIER> FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN (to back up DC controller setting
values)
Purpose: to be prepared for replacing DC controller PCBs
5) Turn off and on the power.
6) Start in the initial installation mode. Follow instructions shown on the screen for setup.
(setting of date/time, auto-gradation correction)

5-7
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Controller System > Main controller PCBs
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Controller System > DC Controller PCB
5-8
7. Reinstall the drivers. ■■DC Controller PCB
1) Uninstalling Old Drivers.
Before replacing the DC Controller PCB
• Printer Driver
1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to store the DC Controller setting values.
• FAX Driver
COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN
• Scanner Driver
• Network Scan Utility. (for machines with network connection)
After replacing the DC Controller PCB
* As for the procedure, refer to "Uninstalling the Software" in the Starter Guide.
1) In service mode, perform the following procedure to restore the DC Controller setting
2) Install the drivers which have been uninstalled in step 1.
values.
* As for the procedure, refer to the following items in the Starter Guide.
COPIER > FUINCTION > VIFFNC > RSTR-DCN
• In case of network connection: "Installing via Network Connection"
• In case of USB connection: "Installing with USB Connection"
MEMO
After executing the Printer Recovery Setting, be sure to wait for about 15 seconds
MEMO because of internal process/operation.
MAC address information is changed after replacement of the Main Controller PCB.
Therefore, when the PC and the machine are connected by the network, the PC will
not be able to recognize the machine on the network. When the PC and the machine
are connected by the USB memory device, the PC will not be able to recognize the 2) Turn OFF and then ON the power.
machine if the USB ID is changed. It becomes therefore necessary to reinstall the 3)* Execute the following: Menu > Adjustment/Maintenance > Print Color Displacement
driver.
Correction
4)* Execute the following: Menu > Adjustment/Maintenance > Auto Gradation Correction >
Quick Correction
In the case of a model without fax for EUR (MF8540/MF8230), perform the following works. 5) Turn OFF and then ON the power.

MEMO
After replacing the Main Controller PCB, the value of the service mode (SDTM-DSP)
to set whether to display or hide the automatic shutdown menu becomes "0" (default
value).
In that case, the automatic shutdown menu is not displayed on the LUI of the machine.
To display the automatic shutdown menu on the LUI of the machine, it is necessary to
execute this process.

8. Setting of automatic shutdown menu display


Set 1 for automatic shutdown menu display in service mode (default: 0).
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > SDTM-DSP
9. Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
10. Checking the setting of Auto Sleep Time
In setting menu, check that the setting value of Auto Sleep Time is 1. (If the setting value is 0,
automatic shutdown does not work.)
Menu > Timer Settings > Auto Shutdown Time

5-8
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Controller System > DC Controller PCB
5 Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Laser Exposure System > After replacing Laser Scanner Unit
5-9
Laser Exposure System 2) After values are registered, affix the label [1] packaged with the unit on the inside [2] of the
right cover.
■■After replacing Laser Scanner Unit • MF8500 series

1) Register values indicated on the label packaged with the Laser Scanner Unit in the
following service mode items. [2] [1]
COPIER>ADJUST>SCNR>
SUB-S-Y0 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 Y)
SUB-S-M0 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 M)
SUB-S-C0 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 C)
SUB-S-K0 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position0 K)
SUB-S-Y1 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 Y)
SUB-S-M1 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 M)
SUB-S-C1 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 C)
SUB-S-K1 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position1 K)
SUB-S-Y2 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 Y)
F-5-4
SUB-S-M2 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 M)
• MF8200 series
SUB-S-C2 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 C)
SUB-S-K2 (Laser output correction value, vertical scanning irradiation position2 K)
MAI-S-Y0 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 Y)
MAI-S-M0 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 M)
MAI-S-C0 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 C) [2]
MAI-S-K0 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position0 K) [1]
MAI-S-Y1 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 Y)
MAI-S-M1 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 M)
MAI-S-C1 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 C)
MAI-S-K1 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position1 K)
MAI-S-Y2 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 Y)
MAI-S-M2 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 M)
MAI-S-C2 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 C)
MAI-S-K2 (Laser output correction value, horizontal scanning irradiation position2 K) F-5-5

5-9
5
Adjustment > Adjustment at Parts Replacement > Laser Exposure System > After replacing Laser Scanner Unit
6 Trouble Shooting

■Test

Print
■Trouble shooting items

■Special Management Mode

■Version Upgrade

6
Trouble Shooting
6 Trouble Shooting > Test Print > Engine test print
6-2

Test Print 3) The engine test chart is printed in the horizontal line patterns on a sheet as shown below.

Engine test print


The engine test print is to check normal operation of the device.
Print the engine test chart in the following steps.

• MF8500 series
1) Detach the right cover. Refer to page 4-20.
2) Turn on the device on standby to press the test print switch [1] on the right side of the
device.

F-6-2

F-6-1

6-2
6
Trouble Shooting > Test Print > Engine test print
6 Trouble Shooting > Test Print > Controller test print > Overview
6-3
• MF8200 series
Controller test print
1) Leave the front cover(1) and the rear cover(2) open to turn on the power.
■■Overview
This product provides the following 6 test chart types to determine causes of faulty images.
The data for test charts are created in the main controller. If no problem is found on the output
(1) test charts, the cause may lie in the PDL input or the reader.
TYPE NO. Test chart type Purpose
0 Pascal correction chart 1 For checking density characteristic
(Error diffusion)
1 Pascal correction chart 2 For checking density characteristic
(Screen)
2 Color chart For checking color reproduction
(2) characteristic
3 Color displacement correction chart For checking color displacement
correction
4 Rainbow chart (vertical scanning For checking color displacement
F-6-3
direction) (Vertical scanning)
2) Close the Front Cover (1) and the Rear Cover (2) within 5 seconds since the Control Panel 5 Rainbow chart (horizontal scanning For checking color displacement
direction) (Horizontal scanning)
lights up white. 6 Grid Bk For checking geometric characteristics
3) The engine test chart is printed in the horizontal line patterns on a sheet as shown below. and thin lines
T-6-1

F-6-4

6-3
6
Trouble Shooting > Test Print > Controller test print > Overview
6 Trouble Shooting > Test Print > Controller test print > Selecting test chart
6-4
■■Selecting test chart
1) Select TESTMODE>PRINT>PG-TYPE in Service mode.
2) Enter TYPE NO from the numeric keypad and press [OK] key.
3) Go to the following Service mode to set up for test print. If no setting is made in Service
mode, the test chart is output based on the default value of each Service mode item.
TESTMODE > PRINT
Item Description Default value
COUNT Enter the number of sheets to output. 1
Settings: 1-99
PHASE Select [1-side] or [2-side]. 0
[MF8500 series only] [2-side] selected for 1-side devices is invalid.
Settings: 0=1-side, 1=2-side
MODE Specify how to form the image to be output. 0
Regardless of PG-TYPE settings (0 or 1), the image is
processed in the fixed method.
Settings:
0: T-MIC
1: High LPI screen
2: Low LPI screen
3: T-BIC
THRU Select ON or OFF for gamma correction. 0
Setting:
0: Normal gamma
1: Through (linear) gamma
NRKE Flag to switch the color displacement correction processing 1 0
0: Adopt without processing
1: Adopt with processing
BLND Flag to switch the color displacement correction processing 2 0
0: Adopt without processing
1: Adopt with processing
FEED Select the paper source and press [Start] key to output in the 1
specified settings as set in above steps.
When the multi-purpose tray is selected, the sheet is fed
only when paper in the specified size is set in the tray. When
Cassette 2 is selected but the device has only a cassette,
paper is fed from Cassette 1.
*Any paper source with color paper is invalid for printing.
Setting:
0: MPTray
1: Cassette 1
2: Cassette 2
T-6-2

4) Select TESTMODE>PRINT>PG-TYPE>START.

6-4
6
Trouble Shooting > Test Print > Controller test print > Selecting test chart
6 Trouble Shooting > Trouble shooting items > Confirming nip width
6-5

Trouble shooting items Confirming nip width


This product does not provide the function to adjust nip width. Improper nip width, however,
Recurring faulty image may cause faulty fixing.
To avoid potential faults, confirm the nip width of the fixing assembly in the following steps.
Foreign matters or lines on rollers along the paper feed path may cause faulty images in the
1) Output a A4 sheet printed in solid black using the cartridges for this product and bring it to
vertical scanning direction.
the customer site.
2) Set the solid black sheet face-down to the cassette of this product.
Field action
3) Use an external device to print out a solid white image on the sheet.
See the roller pitches listed in the tables below to clean and/or replace the corresponding
4) Open the front door after about 25 seconds from the step above and leave it for 10 seconds
parts.
or more in the device to take out the printed sheet.
5) Measure the glossy part on the printed sheet as shown in the figure below to confirm if the
• MF8500 series
width is in the tolerable ranges.
Roller pitch Parts • Center (a): 6.0+-1mm
about 44 mm Registration roller
• Sides (b), (c): 5.0-7.5mm
about 58 mm Secondary transfer external roller
about 75 mm Photosensitive drum • Difference (b-c): 1.0mm or less
about 22 mm Developing cylinder
about 58 mm Fixing film
c
about 63 mm Pressure roller
about 78 mm ITB (drive roller, secondary transfer internal roller)
T-6-3

Paper feed direction


• MF8200 series
Roller pitch Parts
Center of
about 44 mm Registration roller
A4 sheet
about 57 mm Secondary transfer external roller
about 27 mm Primary transfer roller
about 76 mm Photosensitive drum
about 22 mm Developing cylinder
about 57 mm Fixing film
about 57 mm Pressure roller
about 634 mm ITB
T-6-4
a

F-6-5

6-5
6
Trouble Shooting > Trouble shooting items > Confirming nip width
6 Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Operational Description
6-6

Special Management Mode Operational Description


Operational procedure of this mode is indicated below.
Overview
The Special Management Mode is the mode for taking a measure and solving the occurred
problem by a user. However, information about this mode is not disclosed to users.
User Screen
Basically, if a problem is not solved when using the target item or when printing with a
condition differs from the target item, be sure to return the setting to its original value.
Otherwise, errors such as image error may occur.
1) MENU key
[Return] key
2) [→] key
MEMO: 3) [3] key
• Items of the Special Management Mode can be set in service mode. 4) [6] key
COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN 5) [9] key
• When entering special management mode, if the “right key” is pressed for a specified 6) [ ] key
period of time (0.2 seconds) or more, the machine does not enter the mode.
Enter number & push OK

Supported models Enter the Special


Management Number [Return] key
The following table shows availability of service mode by model using the following symbols. with a numeric keypad,
and then
○ Supported press the [OK] key.
▲ Supported by model with FAX only xxxxx
– Not supported
T-6-5
0

(0 - 1)
Enter the numeric value,
and then press the [OK] key.

F-6-6

6-6
6
Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Operational Description
6 Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6-7
Menu List Item Name Description M82 M85
26433 Execution of drum idle rotation mode
  Details To execute idle rotation of the drum.
Use case When thin, sharp horizontal lines appear in halftone
Item Name Description M82 M85
images after a long downtime
14159 Fixing of USB device ID ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
  Details To fix the USB device ID to “000000000000”.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Driver for each machine is installed to a PC. However,
0: OFF, 1: ON
by fixing the serial number, the PC considers that any
Default value 0
connected machine to be the same machine; thus, there
will be no need to install the drivers many times. 14682 Execution of image fogging prevention mode 1
○ ○
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the value, and then press OK key.   Details To change the developing bias.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When toner is lightly transferred to the white area in case
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 of printing an image with large white area using glossy
0: OFF, 1: ON paper ○ ○
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
27767 Setting of highly-resistive paper Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
  Details To increase the secondary transfer bias.
Default value 0
Use case When a trace which looks like toner scattering occurs
around the text or print pattern depending on the paper 83279 Setting of Chinese paper
type or environment (especially in a low humidity   Details To change the transfer bias.
○ ○ Use case When a trace which looks like toner scattering occurs
environment)
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. around the text or print pattern in case of using Chinese
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 paper ○ ○
0: OFF, 1: ON Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
89793 Execution of re-transfer prevention mode 0: OFF, 1: ON
  Details To lower the primary transfer bias. Default value 0
Use case When re-transfer occurs due to strong primary transfer 50288 Execution of ITB cleaning failure prevention 2
bias   Details MF8200
- ○ To alleviate cleaning failure by increasing the current
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
(bias) applied to the Cleaning Blade and Primary
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Transfer Roller.
0: OFF, 1: ON
MF8500
Default value 0
To execute cleaning for one round of the ITB after
23846 Setting of moist paper printing 2 sheets. (It becomes 2 sheets intermittent
  Details To increase the secondary transfer bias. mode.)
Use case When color text or pattern using 2 or more colors of It is more effective than ICL-IMP. ○ ○
toner becomes lighter depending on the paper type or Use case When an image that was on 2 sheets before appears
environment (especially in a high humidity environment) ○ - lightly depending on paper type and print pattern
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. (especially high printing ratio)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 When the trailing edge of paper is soiled
0: OFF, 1: ON Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

6-7
6
Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6 Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6-8
Item Name Description M82 M85 Item Name Description M82 M85
41971 Execution of curl prevention mode 1 65677 Increase of paper leading edge margin
  Details To extend the initial rotation time and paper interval, and   Details To increase the margin on the leading edge of paper.
lower the control temperature. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased
Use case When paper which has been printed is curled toward the by 0.1 mm.
printed side depending on the paper type, environment If the setting is incompatible with 68676 (decrease
(especially in a low humidity environment) or print pattern - ○ of margin), the setting is disabled (the margin will be
standard). ○ ○
(especially high printing ratio)
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: OFF, 1: ON Display/adj/set range 0 to 20
Default value 0 Unit 0.1 mm
35607 Execution of down sequence prevention mode Default value 0
  Details To lower the control temperature of the Fixing Assembly 68676 Decrease of paper leading edge margin
without exception.   Details To decrease the margin on the leading edge of paper.
Use case When down sequence occurs As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is decreased
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. by 0.1 mm.
Caution Be sure to get approval from the user in advance by If the setting is incompatible with 65677(increase of
- ○ margin), the setting is disabled (the margin will be
explaining that there is a possibility that fixing failure may ○ ○
occur depending on the paper type by lowering the fixing standard).
control temperature. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: OFF, 1: ON Display/adj/set range 0 to 20
Default value 0 Unit 0.1 mm
37510 ON/OFF of ITB cleaning at paper size mismatch Default value 0
  Details Normally, when paper other than that of the specified size 68677 Increase of paper right and left margins
is fed, ITB cleaning is executed to remove toner.   Details To increase the margins on the right and left edges of
When 1 is set, ITB cleaning is not executed even if paper paper.
size is mismatched. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased
Productivity improves, but toner soiling may occur. by 0.1 mm.
Use case When paper size is mismatched ○ ○ If the setting is incompatible with 25607 (decrease of
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key. margins), the setting is disabled (the margins will be ○ ○
Caution Be sure to get approval from the user by telling that toner standard).
soiling may occur to improve productivity. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: ON, 1: OFF Display/adj/set range 0 to 20
Default value 0 Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0

6-8
6
Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6 Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6-9
Item Name Description M82 M85 Item Name Description M82 M85
25607 Decrease of paper right and left margins 15176 Extension of detection on absence of toner
  Details To decrease the margins on the right and left edges of   Details Error occurs when the drum running distance reaches a
paper. certain point in the case of toner absence.
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is decreased Turning this switch ON delays the occurrence of error
by 0.1 mm. (threshold value is changed).
If the setting is incompatible with 68677 (increase of Use case When delaying the display of “absence of toner” message ○ -
margins), the setting is disabled (the margins will be ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
standard). 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: OFF, 1: ON
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20 Default value 0
Unit 0.1 mm 89821 Shop demonstration mode
Default value 0   Details To display image data on color UI repeatedly to appeal
93822 Setting of department ID count all clear the product features to potential users.
  Details To set whether to disable clearing of all department ID Use case When appealing the product features to users at shops
counts. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. ○ ○
Caution Be sure to perform this mode after consulting with the ○ ○ Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
system administrator at user’s site. 0: OFF, 1: ON
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Supplement/memo When the setting value is 1 at startup, the shop
Default value 0 demonstration mode is enabled.
78788 Setting of department ID count clear 58122 Wrinkle prevention mode
  Details To set whether to disable clearing of department ID count.   Details To prevent envelope from getting wrinkles by keeping
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. the speed of the Fixing Motor constant and feeding an
Caution Be sure to perform this mode after consulting with the envelope with a little pulling tension applied to it.
○ ○
system administrator at user’s site. Use case When preventing envelope from getting wrinkles ○ -
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: OFF, 1: ON
41250 Reset of calibration Default value 0
  Details When the user allows printing at absence of toner, 71100 Setting of the duty of Off-hook PCB
calibration using toner is disabled.   Details This is the mode to make handsets of particular
As a remedy, calibration reset is executed by this switch. manufacturers to be rung when fax reception mode is set
Use case When the user allows printing after absence of toner is to "FAX/TEL switching".
displayed. ○ ○
Use case When fax reception mode is set to FAX/TEL switching
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 1 to 99
▲ ▲
0: OFF, 1: ON Default value 50
Default value 0 Supplement/memo When receiving a call, a handset connected to the host
machine is rung. However, if the connected handset is
manufactured by a particular manufacturer (e.g., SANYO,
Model No.: TEL-DH5, etc.), it may not be rung. To solve
the problem, set the value so that the handset can be
rung correctly.

6-9
6
Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6 Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6-10
Item Name Description M82 M85
00171 Change of the maximum value of auto sleep shift time
  Details To change the maximum value of auto sleep shift time in
Settings/Registration> Timer Settings> Auto Sleep Time.
Use case When changing the setting time to shift to auto sleep
mode
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: 0 to 60, 1: 0 to 240
Default value 0 (For Europe)
1 (For locations other than Europe)
80100 Mask setting at copyboard scanning
  Details To cancel the image mask occurs on the left edge at
copyboard scanning.
Use case Upon request from user who does not satisfy with the
mask on the left edge ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0: Mask value according to the specifications of each job
1: No mask (0 mm)
Default value 0
27354 For R&D use
  Details For R&D use ○ ○
Default value Default value is not changed.
T-6-6

6-10
6
Trouble Shooting > Special Management Mode > Menu List
6 Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Preparation > Preparation
6-11

Version Upgrade Preparation


■■System Requirements
Overview
• OS (one of the following)
This machine supports the following two methods for upgrading the firmware. • Microsoft Windows 2000 Server/Professional
1. User Support Tool (UST) • Microsoft Windows XP Professional/Home Edition
2. Via Internet • Microsoft Windows Server 2003
• Microsoft Windows Vista
• Microsoft Windows Server 2008
• Microsoft Windows 7
UST • Microsoft Windows Server 2012 Japanese version
• Microsoft Windows 8 Japanese version
• PC
• Compatible to the selected OS
• Memory (RAM): 32MB or more free space
Firm ware
• Hard Disk: 100MB or more free space
• Display: 640x480 pixels or more in resolution, 256 tones or more
• With USB ports
• UST file for this product*
USB cable *: Download the corresponding file from the system CD or the service site (ask the
service technician in charge for details)
PC
• USB cable (USB1.1/2.0)
F-6-7
Firmware configuration
■■Preparation
Firmware Function Stored in
Boot ROM Start the main controller. Main controller PCB 1) Start the PC.
Main Controller Control overall performance. Main controller PCB 2) Connect the device to the PC with the USB cable.
LANGUAGE Manage languages used in panel / Main controller PCB 3) Turn on the device on standby.
Remote UI and font data.
4) Press [Menu] key to upgrade firmware in User mode.
DEMO PRINT Manage data for demo printing. Main controller PCB System Settings > Update Firmware
DCON Control the printer unit. DC controller PCB
The message, “Will you restart the device to upgrade firmware?”, is shown on the display.
T-6-7
Select Yes.
Some UST versions meet less numbers of firmware than those listed above.
5) Press OK to automatically restart the device. “***DOWNLOAD MODE***” is shown on the
display.
6) Wait for the motor of the host machine to stop.

MEMO :
Press STOP key to cancel Download mode and return to the normal operation.

6-11
6
Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Preparation > Preparation
6 Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Downloading System Software
6-12
Downloading System Software 4) Select [USB Device] and click [Next] button.

1) Open UST.

USTUPD.exe

F-6-8
2) Take a note of the firmware version to upgrade and click [Next] button.

F-6-11
5) Click [Start] button.

F-6-9
3) Click [Next] button.

F-6-12

F-6-10

6-12
6
Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Downloading System Software
6 Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Upgrading via Internet
6-13
6) Click [Yes] button for the warning message to start download.
Upgrading via Internet
■■Overview
The firmware of the host machine can be upgraded via Internet without using PC by selecting
“Via Internet” in LUI.

Menu > System Management Settings > Update Firmware > Via Internet

MEMO :
• Refer to the User's Manual of the device for how to connect the device to the external
network.
• This is applicable either in a wired LAN environment or a wireless LAN environment.
F-6-13
7) Click [OK] button when download is completed.

■■Preparation
1) Check that there are no other jobs being executed.
F-6-14
2) In an environment where access is obtained via a proxy server, the proxy setting is made
8) Turn off and on the power to restart the device. from the remote UI.
3) Check that the serial number of the host machine is shown on the Main Controller PCB.
9) Output the spec report from Service mode to confirm if the firmware version is the same as
that on the note taken in Step 2).
COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> SPEC MEMO :
To upgrade the firmware of the host machine via Internet, the serial number of the
machine need to be written on the Main Controller PCB.
Execute COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P> SPEC, and check that the BODY No. is
registered.
If the BODY No. has not been registered, register the serial number according to
“registration of the serial number of the host machine" in "After replacing main controller
PCBs”.

6-13
6
Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Upgrading via Internet
6 Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Upgrading via Internet > Messages
6-14
■■Messages
The message displayed on the device LUI is as follows.

No. Error message The timing of Remedy


occurrence
1 Job in progress... If there is a job 1. Wait until the job is completed.
Wait a moment, then try again. being executed: 2. Cancel the job.
2 Cannot check the firmware Network error 1. Check whether the device can be
version. connected to the external network.
(Server communication error.) 2. Check whether the proxy setting has
been made (in case of access via a
proxy server).
3 Cannot download the firmware. 1. Check whether the device can be
(Error during download.) connected to the external network.
2. Check whether the proxy setting has
been made (in case of access via a
proxy server).
3. Check that the serial number of the
host machine is shown on the Main
Controller PCB.
4 ***DOWNLOAD MODE*** If update (writing) 1. Update the firmware again using
NETWORK AVAILABLE of the firmware UST.
IP ADRESS has ended in
IP address of the machine failure:
PRESS STOP KEY TO EXIT
5 ***DOWNLOAD MODE***
FAILED TO UPDATE
6 ***DOWNLOAD MODE*** If the update of -
UPDATE IS COMPLETE the firmware is
successful
T-6-8

6-14
6
Trouble Shooting > Version Upgrade > Upgrading via Internet > Messages
7 Error codes

■Overview

■Error Codes

■Jam Code

7
Error codes
7 Error codes > Overview > Jam code > Position code
7-2

Overview Jam code


■■Location code
Outline
Location information is displayed as 1-digit number as follows.
■■Outline Device Location code
Host machine 3
This section describes codes shown in case any problem is occurred.
ADF 4
Since this product does not collect logs for jams and alarms, no alarm code is shown.
T-7-2
Code type Description Reference
Error code Shown for any problem occurred in the device. List of error codes
Jam code This code is displayed when a jam occurs inside the machine. List of jam codes ■■Position code
Alarm code N/A - When jam occurs, pickup location is indicated with the following pickup position code.
T-7-1
Device Location code
ADF -
MP Tray 0
Cassette 1 1
Option Cassette (Cassette Feeding
2
Module-V1 MF8500)
Duplex (MF8500) 7
T-7-3

7-2
7
Error codes > Overview > Jam code > Position code
7 Error codes > Error Codes
7-3

Error Codes E Detail Item Description M82 M85


Code Code
E003 0001 Title Abnormally low temperature detected in fixing assembly – ○
Whenever an error occurs, firstly turn off and on the power to check if the error is persistent. (sub thermistor triggered)
Description Temperature drop detected by sub thermistor after
(Controller-related errors tend to recover by power-OFF/ON.)
attaining the target temperature (sub
• M82=MF8200 series thermistor triggered)
• M85=MF8500 series Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing assembly / DC controller
PCB
E Detail Item Description M82 M85 2.Replace fixing film units
Code Code 3.Replace fixing power supply units
E000 0000 Title Error in the fixing assembly start-up ○ ○ 4.Replace DC controller PCBs
Description Insufficient temperature rise detected by thermistor even E004 0000 Title Error in fixing power supply drive circuit ○ ○
after applying bias to the heater Description Error in zero-cross signal detection for the pre-defined
Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing assembly, DC controller duration
PCB, fixing power supply unit, etc. Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing assembly / DC controller
2.Replace fixing film units PCB
3.Replace fixing power supply units 2.Replace fixing power supply units
4.Replace DC controller PCBs E012 0000 Title Error in ITB motor startup ○ ○
E001 0000 Title Abnormally high temperature detected in fixing assembly ○ ○ Description Error in attaining the target ITB motor rotation detected
Description Abnormally high temperature detected by main thermistor based on ITB motor speed detection signal after ITB
Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing assembly / DC controller motor is actuated.
PCB Remedy 1.Check connectors of ITB motor / DC controller PCB
2.Replace fixing film units 2.Replace ITB motors
3.Replace fixing power supply units 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
4.Replace DC controller PCB E012 0001 Title Error in ITB motor startup ○ ○
E001 0001 Title Abnormally high temperature detected in fixing assembly – ○ Description Error in ITB motor rotation after attaining the target
(sub thermistor triggered) rotation detected based on ITB motor
Description Abnormally high temperature detected by sub thermistor speed detection signal.
(sub thermistor triggered) Remedy 1.Check connectors of ITB motor / DC controller PCB
Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing assembly / DC controller 2.Replace ITB motors
PCB 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
2.Replace fixing film units E014 0000 Title Error in fixing motor startup – ○
3.Replace fixing power supply units Description Error in attaining the target fixing motor rotation detected
4.Replace DC controller PCBs based on fixing motor speed detection signal after fixing
E003 0000 Title Abnormally low temperature detected in fixing assembly ○ ○ motor is actuated.
Description Temperature drop detected by main thermistor after Remedy 1.Check connectors of ITB motor / DC controller PCB
attaining the target temperature 2.Replace ITB motors
Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing assembly / DC controller PC 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
2.Replace fixing film/fixing power supply units E014 0001 Title Error in fixing motor startup – ○
3.Replace DC controller PCBs Description Error in fixing motor rotation after attaining the target
rotation detected based on fixing motor speed detection
signal.
Remedy 1.Check connectors of ITB motor / DC controller PCB
2.Replace ITB motors
3.Replace DC controller PCBs

7-3
7
Error codes > Error Codes
7 Error codes > Error Codes
7-4
E Detail Item Description M82 M85 E Detail Item Description M82 M85
Code Code Code Code
E015 0001 Title Error in developing roller contact ○ ○ E024 0003 Title Error in toner level sensor – –
Description Failed to detect changes in developing home position Description Abnormal output of toner level sensor (Black)
sensor signals within the pre-defined time after actuating Remedy 1.Replace toner cartridges
main motor to control the developing roller contact. 2.Replace high-voltage power supply PCBs
Remedy 1.Check connectors of developing home position sensor, 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
main motor and DC controller PCB. E052 0000 Title Error in 2-sided unit detection – ○
2.Replace developing home position sensors Description Failed to detect 2-sided unit
3.Replace main motors Remedy 1.Check connectors of 2-sided unit and DC controller PCB
4.Replace DC controller PCBs 2.Replace DC controller PCBs
E020 0000 Title Error in density sensor ○ ○ E066 0000 Title Error in environment sensor ○ ○
Description Failed to receive sufficient light to detect image density Description Error in environment sensor
Remedy 1.Check DC controller PCB onnectors. Remedy 1.Check connectors of environment sensor and DC
2.Replace ITB units controller PCB.
3.Replace DC controller PCBs 2.Replace environment sensor
4.Replace toner cartridges 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
E021 1003 Title Error in developing motor – ○ E070 0000 Title Error in ITB / TOP sensor ○ ○
Description Cause of developing motor rotation error: problem in Description Error in ITB / TOP sensor
developing motor / DC controller PCB Remedy 1.Check connectors of ITB unit and DC controller PCB.
Remedy 1.Check connectors of developing motor and DC controller 2.Replace ITB units
PCB. 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
2.Replace developing motor E078 0000 Title Error in primary transfer roller contact – ○
3.Replace DC controller PCB
Description Primary transfer roller contact mechanism does not
E021 2003 Title Error in developing motor – ○ normally function
Description Error in attaining the target developing motor rotation Remedy 1.Check contact mechanism
detected based on developing motor speed detection 2.Check connectors of ITB tension sensor, pickup motor
signal after developing motor is actuated. and DC controller PCB.
Remedy 1.Check connectors of developing motor and DC controller 3.Replace ITB tension sensors
PCB. 4.Replace pickup motors / DC controller PCBs
2.Replace developing motor E100 0000 Title Error in scanner motor/laser unit/BD ○ ○
3.Replace DC controller PCBs
Description Failure in Yellow optical unit
E024 0000 Title Error in toner level sensor – –
Remedy 1.Check connectors of laser scanner unit and DC
Description Abnormal output of toner level sensor (Yellow) controller PCB
Remedy 1.Replace toner cartridges 2.Replace laser scanner units
2.Replace high-voltage power supply PCBs 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
3.Replace DC controller PCBs E100 0001 Title Error in scanner motor/laser unit/BD ○ ○
E024 0001 Title Error in toner level sensor – – Description Failure in Magenta optical unit
Description Abnormal output of toner level sensor (Magenta) Remedy 1.Check connectors of laser scanner unit and DC
Remedy 1.Replace toner cartridges controller PCB
2.Replace high-voltage power supply PCBs 2.Replace laser scanner units
3.Replace DC controller PCBs 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
E024 0002 Title Error in toner level sensor – – E100 0002 Title Error in scanner motor/laser unit/BD ○ ○
Description Abnormal output of toner level sensor (Cyan) Description Failure in Cyan optical unit
Remedy 1.Replace toner cartridges Remedy 1.Check connectors of laser scanner unit and DC
2.Replace high-voltage power supply PCBs controller PCB
3.Replace DC controller PCBs 2.Replace laser scanner units
3.Replace DC controller PCBs

7-4
7
Error codes > Error Codes
7 Error codes > Error Codes
7-5
E Detail Item Description M82 M85 E Detail Item Description M82 M85
Code Code Code Code
E100 0003 Title Error in scanner motor/laser unit/BD ○ ○ E246 0000 Title System error – –
Description Failure in Black optical unit Description System error
Remedy 1.Check connectors of laser scanner unit and DC Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
controller PCB E247 0000 Title System error – –
2.Replace laser scanner units Description System error
3.Replace DC controller PCBs Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
E110 0000 Title Error in primary pseudo-BD correction ○ ○ E248 0001 Title Error in access to backup data for Reader (reading error – –
Description Scanner failed to be ready after starting up pseudo-BD at power-on)
control Description The Reader-related adjustment values could not be read.
Remedy 1.Replace laser scanner units Remedy 1. Clear the backup RAM of RCON.
2.Replace DC controller PCBs Execute COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>RCON.
E194 0000 Title Error in Patch Sensor – ○ 2. Enter all the values written on the service label in
Description Patch Sensor does not function normally service mode again.
Remedy 1.Check DC controller PCB connectors 3. Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
2.Replace ITB units E350 0000 Title System error – –
3.Replace DC controller PCBs Description System error
4.Replace toner cartridges Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
E196 0000 Title Error in DCON ROM ○ ○ E351 0000 Title System error ○ ○
Description Failed to update ROM of DC controller PCB Description System error
Remedy 1.Update the set of main controller firmware Remedy 1.Turn OFF and then ON the main power.
2.Replace DC controller PCB 2.Replace main controller PCBs
E196 1000 Title Error in DCON ROM ○ ○ E354 0000 Title System error – –
Description Error in writing in / reading from ROM (main) Description System error
Remedy 1.Update the set of main controller firmware Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
2.Replace DC controller PCBs E355 0000 Title System error – –
E196 2000 Title Error in DCON ROM ○ ○ Description System error
Description Error in writing in/reading from ROM (storing settings) Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
Remedy 1.Update the set of main controller firmware E355 0004 Title System error – –
2.Replace DC controller PCBs
Description System error
E198 0000 Title Failure in DC controller memory ○ ○
Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
Description Failure in DC controller memory
E355 0005 Title System error – –
Remedy Replace DC controller PCBs
Description System error
E202 0001 Title Error in reader HP sensor ○ ○
Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
Description Error in reader HP outward
E719 0000 Title Card Reader communication error (serial communication) – –
Failed to move to HP even when CIS unit moves
Description Communication with the Card Reader could not be started
backward.
at startup.
Remedy 1.Replace reader HP sensors
Remedy 1. Check the connection of the Card Reader-F1, and turn
2.Replace reader motors
OFF and then ON the main power switch.
3.Replace reader units
2. Remove the Card Reader-F1.
E202 0002 Title Error in reader HP sensor ○ ○
Description Error in reader HP homeward NOTE: After performing the remedy work above, go
Failed to move to HP even when CIS unit moves forward. through the following to clear the error: COPIER>
Remedy 1.Replace reader HP sensors FUNCTION> CLEAR> E719-CLR.
2.Replace reader motors
3.Replace reader units

7-5
7
Error codes > Error Codes
7 Error codes > Error Codes
7-6
E Detail Item Description M82 M85 E Detail Item Description M82 M85
Code Code Code Code
E733 0000 Title Error in printer communication ○ ○ E744 7000 Title Main Controller PCB error ○ ○
Description Failure between DC controller PCB and controller PCB Description An error in the microcomputer which retains fax job
Remedy 1.Check connectors of DC controller PCB and main information of the Main Controller PCB.
controller PCB Remedy 1. Install the firmware of BKUP.
2.Replace DC controller PCBs 2. Install the set of the controller firmware.
3.Replace main controller PCBs 3. Replace the Main Controller PCB.
E736 0000 Title Error in CCU communication ▲ ▲ E746 0000 Title Error in main controller PCBs ○ ○
Description Error in CCU-modem communication Description Communication error occurred in main controller PCB
Remedy 1.Update the set of main controller firmware (other than scanner-related)
2.Replace FAX-NCU PCBs Remedy Replace main controller PCBs
3.Replace main controller PCBs E766 xxxx*1 Title Error in firmware ○ ○
E736 0001 Title Error in ROM for backing up fax data ▲ ▲ Description Error in connection occurred due to main controller
Description An error occurred in ROM for backing up fax data software
Remedy 1. Install the set of the controller firmware. *: xxxx
2. Replace the Main Controller PCB. Task number related to Exception is shown in decimal
E744 0001 Title Error in language file/BootRom/USB memory – – Remedy 1.Power off/on
Description Error in language file version 2.Update firmware
The version of language file does not match to Bootable E766 8000 Title Error in firmware ○ ○
Remedy Update the set of main controller firmware Description Incorrect digital registration 3 point information
E744 0002 Title Error in language file/BootRom/USB memory – – Remedy 1.Power off/on
Description Error in language file size 2.Update firmware
Language file exceeds allowable size E766 9000 Title Error in firmware ○ ○
Remedy Update the set of main controller firmware Description Error in laser scanner unit power supply
E744 1001 Title Error in language file/BootRom/USB memory – – Remedy 1.Power off/on
Description Versions of Bootable and BootRom do not match 2.Update firmware
Remedy Update the set of main controller firmware E804 0004 Title Error in power supply cooling fan – –
E744 4000 Title Error in language file/BootRom/USB memory ○ ○ Description Power supply cooling fan does not rotate in the specified
Description Error in engine ID rotation speed.
Detected illegal engine connection Remedy 1.Check connectors of power supply cooling fan / DC
Remedy 1.Check DC controller controller PCB
2.Update DC controller firmware 2.Replace power supply cooling fans
3.Update the set of main controller firmware 3.Replace DC controller PCBs
E744 5000 Title Error in language file/BootRom/USB memory ○ ○ E805 0000 Title Main Fan error – –
Description Error in panel microcomputer Description The Main Fan was locked for a specified consecutive
Remedy 1.Check panel microcomputer to upgrade the version period of time.
2.Update the set of main controller firmware Remedy 1. Check the connection of the Main Fan.
3.Replace main controller PCBs 2. Replace the Main Fan.
E744 6000 Title Communication error with the Wireless LAN PCB ○ ○ E805 0005 Title Error in 2-sided cooling fan – ○
Description Unable to communicate with the Wireless LAN. Description 2-sided cooling fan does not rotate in the specified rotation
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the main power. speed.
2. Check the connection of the Wireless LAN. Remedy 1.Check connectors of 2-sided cooling fan / DC controller
3. Install the set of the controller firmware. PCB
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB. 2.Replace 2-sided cooling fans
3.Replace DC controller PCBs

7-6
7
Error codes > Error Codes
7 Error codes > Error Codes
7-7
E Detail Item Description M82 M85
Code Code
E806 0000 Title Error in fixing / fixing power supply cooling fan ○ ○
Description Fixing / fixing power supply cooling fan does not rotate in
the specified rotation speed.
Remedy 1.Check connectors of fixing/fixing power supply cooling
fan and DC controller PCB
2.Replace fixing / fixing power supply cooling fans
3.Replace DC controller PCBs
E808 0000 Title Error in low-voltage power supply – ○
Description Printer detected failure in low-voltage power supply
Remedy 1.Check connectors of power supply unit and DC
controller PCB
2.Replace power supply units
3.Replace DC controller PCBs
E840 0000 Title Error in pressure release mechanism ○ ○
Description Failed to control in home position (under pressure) after
starting home position control
Remedy 1.Replace fixing drive units
2.Replace fixing pressure release cams
T-7-4

7-7
7
Error codes > Error Codes
7 Error codes > Jam Code > MF8500 Series
7-8

Jam Code ACC Jam


Type Sensor Name/Detection Contents Sensor ID
ID Code
04 0001 Delay Document End Sensor Delay PS702
MF8500 Series 04 0002 Stationary Document End Sensor PS702
04 0004 Delay Document End Sensor Delay (2nd side) PS702
PS703 04 0005 Stationary Document End Sensor (2nd side) PS702
03 0040 Size error Size error -
03 0060 Size error Size error -
04 0071 Sequence Sequence Error -
04 0094 Power ON Document End Sensor / Document Sensor PS702/PS703
PS702 03 0104 Delay Registration Detection Sensor SR4
03 0105 MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor SR7
03 010C Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8
03 014C Delivery Full Sensor SR15
03 0184 Registration Detection Sensor SR4
03 0208 Stationary Registration Detection Sensor SR4
03 0210 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8
F-7-1 03 0217 Registration Detection Sensor SR1/SR4/SR7/
Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8/SR10
Fixing Loop Sensor
MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
Paper Feeder Pre-Registration Detection
Sensor
SR15 03 021C Wrap Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8
SR8 03 0248 Stationary Registration Detection Sensor SR4
03 0250 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8
03 0257 Registration Detection Sensor SR1/SR4/SR7/
Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8/SR10
Fixing Loop Sensor
MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
Paper Feeder Pre-Registration Detection
SR10 Sensor
03 025C Wrap Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8
03 02A4 Duplex revers Registration Detection Sensor SR4
03 1014 Power ON Registration Detection Sensor SR1/SR4/SR7/
03 1054 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR8/SR10
SR14
SR4 03 1094 Fixing Loop Sensor
SR7 MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
03 10D4
Paper Feeder Pre-Registration Detection
Sensor
SR12 SR13 03 1118 Door Open Front Cover Sensor SR2/SR4/SR8/
SR1 03 1158 Registration Detection Sensor SR12
03 1198 Pre-registration Detection Sensor
F-7-2 Fixing Delivery Sensor
03 11D8
T-7-5

7-8
7
Error codes > Jam Code > MF8500 Series
7 Error codes > Jam Code > MF8200 Series
7-9
MF8200 Series ACC Jam
Type Sensor Name/Detection Contents Sensor ID
ID Code
PS703 04 0001 Delay Document End Sensor Delay PS702
04 0002 Stationary Document End Sensor PS702
03 0040 Size error Size error -
03 0060 Size error Size error -
04 0071 Sequence Sequence Error -
PS702 04 0094 Power ON Document End Sensor / Document Sensor PS702/PS703
03 0104 Delay Registration Detection Sensor SR602
03 010C Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
03 014C
03 0184 Registration Detection Sensor SR602
03 0208 Stationary Registration Detection Sensor SR602
03 0210 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
F-7-3 03 0217 Registration Detection Sensor SR602/SR605/
Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
03 021C Wrap Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
03 0248 Stationary Registration Detection Sensor SR602
03 0250 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
SR15
03 0257 Registration Detection Sensor SR602/SR605/
SR8 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
MP Tray Pre-Registration Detection Sensor
03 025C Wrap Fixing Delivery Sensor SR602
03 1014 Power ON Registration Detection Sensor SR602/SR603/
03 1054 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR609
03 1094 Fixing Loop Sensor
SR10 03 10D4
03 1118 Door Open Registration Detection Sensor SR602/SR609/
03 1158 Fixing Delivery Sensor SR612/SR613
03 1198 Front Cover Sensor
03 11D8 Rear Cover Sensor
SR14 T-7-6
SR4
SR7

SR12 SR13
SR1

F-7-4

7-9
7
Error codes > Jam Code > MF8200 Series
8 Service Mode

■Overview

■COPIER

■FEEDER

■FAX

■TESTMODE

8
Service Mode
8 Service Mode > Overview > Backing up Service Mode
8-2

Overview Backing up Service Mode


Each device is tuned at the time of shipment and the tuned values are written on the service
Service Mode Menu label.
However, when replacing the main controller PCBs / DC controller PCBs or clearing RAM,
tuned ADJUST and OPTION values are reset to defaults. Each service technician should
Service mode
adjust these values in field and ensure to write values after changes in the service label. If the
corresponding item is not found on the service label, enter the value in the blank space.
COPIER Service mode for copier
• Service label position (MF8500 series)
DISPLAY Service mode for copier

I/O I/O display mode

ADJUST Adjustment mode [1]


FUNCTION Operation / inspection mode

OPTION Specification setting mode

COUNT ER Counter mode

FEEDER ADF service mode

ADJUST Adjustment mode

FUNCTION Operation / inspection mode

F-8-2
FAX FAX service mode

SSSW Bit switch registration mode • Service label position (MF8200 series)

MENU Menu switch registration mode

NUM Numeric parameter setting mode

NCU NCU parameter setting mode


(Service adjustment is not available)
[1]
TESTMODE Service mode for test print, operation check, etc.

PRINT Print test mode

FAX FAX test mode

F-8-1

F-8-3

8-2
8
Service Mode > Overview > Backing up Service Mode
8 Service Mode > Overview > Screen flow of Service Mode > Screen flow of Service mode
8-3
Screen flow of Service Mode ■■Screen flow of Service mode
• Initial / Category / Sub category screen
■■Service mode structure
Select the item : Up-arrow
/ down-arrow key SERVICE MODE
Go to Sub category screen : OK key COPIER
User screen
Go to Initial screen : Return key FEEDER
FAX
1)Up-arrow / down-arrow key TESTMODE
2)OK key

Initial screen • Item selection screen


Select the item : Up-arrow
1)Up-arrow / down-arrow key / down-arrow key ADJ-X :0
Return key
2)OK key Go to Setting screen : OK key ADJ-Y :0
Go to Sub category screen : Return key ADJ-Y-DF :0
Up-arrow / down-arrow key ADJ-X-MG :0
Category
Category
STRD-POS :0

1)Up-arrow / down-arrow key Return key


2)OK key
• Input value screen
Up-arrow / down-arrow key Enter the setting value : numeric keypad
Sub category Sub category Switch the sign (+/-) of the value. : “*” Key
ADJ-X
Increment the setting value one by : Up-arrow key ▲
1)Up-arrow / down-arrow key one 0
Return key
2)OK key Decrease the setting value one by : Down-arrow key ▼
one (-30 - 30)
Change the setting : OK key
Item Item Maintain the setting : Return key

1)Up-arrow / down-arrow key


2)OK key OK / Return key
• Method to display the setting value of switch
• On decimal display format, display is left aligned. (Comma is put every 3 digits.)
Setting screen • On binary display format, the most significant bit is placed at the leftmost position and
the least significant bit is placed at the rightmost position.
F-8-4

8-3
8
Service Mode > Overview > Screen flow of Service Mode > Screen flow of Service mode
8 Service Mode > Overview > Supported models
8-4
Remote UI service mode ●● Authentication screen
1) PSWD-SW: 0
■■Function Overview
Remote UI can be used to display, set and implement various service mode in addition to
rebooting the machine. In this case, machine's UI displays "Remote service mode".

F-8-5
■■Operating condition 2) PSWD-SW: 1

Operation of service mode using remote UI becomes possible in the following cases:
• Service mode is not used on LUI.
• There is no user who has been logged in to the remote UI service mode (this function).
• Remote UI is enabled in the setting of LUI.
Setting Menu > System Management Settings > Remote UI On/Off
• “RMT-SW” is enabled in service mode (Enabled when the setting value is “1”.) F-8-6
COPIER > OPTION > BODY > RMT-SW (remote UI service mode function) 3) PSWD-SW: 2
0: OFF, 1: ON (default)

■■Usage method
1. Activate the Web browser.
2. Enter the following URL in the address input field.
http://<IP address of the machine or host name>/servicemode.html
3. Enter the password and click "Log In".
* Password required for authentication differs depending on the service mode setting. F-8-7

COPIER > OPTION > BODY > PSWD-SW 4) Click “Logout” to end the operation.

MEMO :
PSWD-SW Password required for authentication After login, if you close the browser without “logout”, it is recognized that you have
0 1. Password of RUI service mode been “logged in”. Therefore, in order to log in to service mode again, you must wait for
1 1. Password of RUI service mode a certain period of time (3 minutes) from the last access to make the system timeout or
2. Password of service mode turn OFF/ON the power.
2 1. Password of RUI service mode
2. User's system administrator ID
3. Password of system administrator
4. Password of service mode
* Password of service mode can be changed in COPIER > OPTION
T-8-1 > BODY > Supported models
SM-PSWD.
The following table shows availability of service mode by model using the following symbols.
○ Supported
▲ Supported by model with FAX only
– Not supported
T-8-2

8-4
8
Service Mode > Overview > Supported models
8 Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > ERR
8-5

COPIER PANEL
COPIER > DISPLAY > VERSION
PANEL version
M82 M85

  Details To display the version of PANEL.


DISPLAY Use case When upgrading the firmware
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only) ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 00.00 to 99.99
■■VERSION
Default value 0
COPIER > DISPLAY > VERSION M82 M85 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> PANEL-UP
MAIN Display of MAIN (main program) version ECO ECO version
  Details To display the firmware version of Main Controller PCB.   Details To display the version of ECO.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
○ ○ ○ ○
Adj/set/operate methodN/A (Display only) Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 00.00 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.00 to 99.99
Default value 0 Default value 0
BOOT Boot ROM version DEMOMODE Version of data for shop demonstration
  Details To display the version of Boot ROM (BOOT program).   Details To display the version of data for shop demonstration.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When checking the version of data for shop
○ ○ ○ ○
Adj/set/operate methodN/A (Display only) demonstration
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.00 to 99.99
Default value 0 Default value 0
LANG Language pack version T-8-3
  Details To display the version of language pack.
Use case When upgrading the firmware ■■ERR
○ ○
Adj/set/operate methodN/A (Display only)
Error code display screen
Display/adj/set range 00.00 to 99.99
Up to 10 E codes and detailed codes for system errors can be shown.
Default value 0
DEMODATA Demo print data version
  Details To display the version of demo print data. 110508 2310 E100-0000
Since this machine does not have demo print function,
“FF.FF” is displayed. 110507 1024 E001-0000
○ ○
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
110506 2310 E196-2000
Display/adj/set range --.-- 110503 2310 E001-0000
Default value 0
ECONT ECONT version 110501 0913 E001-0000
  Details To display the version of Engine Controller PCB.
Use case When upgrading the firmware F-8-8
○ ○
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 00.00 to 99.99
Default value 0

8-5
8
Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > ERR
8 Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > CCD
8-6
■■JAM ■■CCD
Jam code display screen COPIER > DISPLAY > CCD M82 M85
Up to 10 Jam codes and detailed codes for system errors can be shown. TARGET-B Shading target value (B)
  Details To display the shading target value of Blue.
Continuous display of 128 (minimum) or 384 (maximum)
is considered a failure of the CIS Unit.
Use case At scanned image failure ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 128 to 384
Default value 269
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-B
TARGET-G Shading target value (G)
  Details To display the shading target value of Green.
F-8-9 Continuous display of 128 (minimum) or 384 (maximum)
is considered a failure of the CIS Unit.
Use case At scanned image failure ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 128 to 384
Default value 270
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-G
TARGET-R Shading target value (R)
  Details To display the shading target value of Red.
Continuous display of 128 (minimum) or 384 (maximum)
is considered a failure of the CIS Unit.
Use case At scanned image failure ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 128 to 384
Default value 263
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R
TARGETBW Shading target value (B&W)
  Details To display the shading target value at B&W jobs.
Continuous display of 128 (minimum) or 384 (maximum)
is considered a failure of the Main Controller PCB.
Use case At scanned image failure ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 128 to 384
Default value 276
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW
T-8-4

8-6
8
Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY
8-7
I/O ADJUST
■■R-CON ■■ADJ-XY
COPIER>IO>R-CON M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY M82 M85
Address BIT Description Remarks ADJ-X Adj of img pstn in book mode: vert scan
P001 0 Display sensor status While the screen is open, the values   Details To adjust the image reading start position (image leading
(Document end sensor) are updated periodically (with an edge position) in the vertical scanning direction at
1 Display sensor status interval of 1 second). ○ ○ copyboard reading.
(Document sensor) When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing the
2 Display sensor status (HPS) RAM data, enter the value of service label.
P002 - No sensor allocated; 0 is While the screen is open, the values When the non-image width is larger than the standard
always shown are updated periodically (with an ○ ○ value, set the smaller value.
interval of 1 second). When out of original area is copied, set the larger value.
T-8-5 As the value is incremented by 1, the image position
moves to the trailing edge side by 0.1 mm. ○ ○
Use case • When replacing the Reader Unit
• When replacing the CIS Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -30 to 30
Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0
ADJ-Y Adj of img pstn in book mode: horz scan
  Details To adjust the image reading start position in the horizontal
scanning direction at copyboard reading.
When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing the
RAM data, enter the value of service label.
When the non-image width is larger than the standard
value, set the smaller value.
When out of original area is copied, set the larger value.
As the value is incremented by 1, the image position
moves to the rear side by 0.1 mm. ○ ○
Use case • When replacing the Reader Unit
• When replacing the CIS Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0

8-7
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY
8-8
COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY M82 M85
ADJ-Y-DF Adj img pstn in ADF mode:horz scan STRD-POS Adjustment of reading position at ADF stream reading
  Details To adjust the image reading start position in the horizontal   Details To adjust the reading position at ADF stream reading.
scanning direction at ADF reading. When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing the
When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing the RAM data, enter the value of service label.
RAM data, enter the value of service label. Use case When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing RAM
As the value is incremented by 1, the image position data
moves to the trailing edge side by 0.1 mm. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
Use case • When replacing the Reader Unit ○ ○
key) and press OK key.
• When replacing the CIS Unit ○ ○
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ value in the service label.
key) and press OK key. Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed Unit 0.1 mm
value in the service label. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS
Unit 0.1 mm T-8-6
Default value 0
ADJ-X-MG Fine adjustment of image magnification ratio (vertical
scanning direction)
  Details To make a fine adjustment of image magnification ratio
in the vertical scanning direction by changing the reading
cycle of CIS.
When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing the
RAM data, enter the value of service label.
As the value is incremented by 1, the image magnification
changes by 0.01 %.
+: Reduce
-: Enlarge ○ ○
Use case When replacing the Engine Controller PCB/clearing RAM
data
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -200 to 200
Unit 0.01 %
Default value 0

8-8
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > ADJ-XY
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8-9
■■CCD COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85
W-PLT-Z White level data(Z) entry of white plate
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85   Details To enter the white level data (Z) for the Standard White
W-PLT-X White level data(X) entry of white plate Plate.
  Details To enter the white level data (X) for the Standard White When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit, enter the value of
Plate. service label. When replacing the Reader Upper Cover
When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit, enter the value of Unit, enter the value of barcode label which is affixed on
service label. When replacing the Reader Upper Cover the glass.
Unit, enter the value of barcode label which is affixed on When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
the glass. of service label.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
of service label. • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB
• When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. value in the service label.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed Display/adj/set range 7000 to 9999
value in the service label. Default value 9427
Display/adj/set range 7000 to 9999 Related service mode COPIER.> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-X, W-PLT-Y
Default value 8273 DFTAR-R Adjustment of shading target value (R) at ADF reading
Related service mode COPIER.> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-Y, W-PLT-Z
  Details To adjust the shading target value of Red at ADF reading.
W-PLT-Y White level data(Y) entry of white plate When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
  Details To enter the white level data (Y) for the Standard White of service label.
Plate. After executing COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-
When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit, enter the value of WLVL1, DF-WLVL2, write the value which is automatically
service label. When replacing the Reader Upper Cover set in the service label.
Unit, enter the value of barcode label which is affixed on Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit
the glass. ○ ○
• When replacing the CIS Unit
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
of service label. • When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
• When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit Display/adj/set range 128 to 384
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Default value 299
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> CCD> TARGET-R
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range 7000 to 9999
Default value 8737
Related service mode COPIER.> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-X, W-PLT-Z

8-9
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8-10
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85
DFTAR-G Adjustment of shading target value (G) at ADF reading DFTAR-BW Adjustment of shading target value (B&W) at ADF reading
  Details To adjust the shading target value of Green at ADF   Details When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
reading. of service label.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value After executing COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-
of service label. WLVL3, DF-WLVL4, write the value which is automatically
After executing COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF- set in the service label.
WLVL1, DF-WLVL2, write the value which is automatically Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit
set in the service label. • When replacing the CIS Unit ○ ○
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○ • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
• When replacing the CIS Unit • When replacing the Main Controller PCB
• When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB Display/adj/set range 128 to 384
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 315
Display/adj/set range 128 to 384 Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> CCD> TARGETBW
Default value 309 COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL3, DF-WLVL4
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> CCD> TARGET-G 50-RG Color displacement (R and G lines) correction value in the
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 vertical scanning direction (50%)
DFTAR-B Adjustment of shading target value (B) at ADF reading   Details To correct the color displacement (R and G lines) in the
  Details To adjust the shading target value of Blue at ADF reading. vertical scanning direction at 50% copyboard reading.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
of service label. of service label.
After executing COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF- Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB
WLVL1, DF-WLVL2, write the value which is automatically Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
set in the service label. ○ ○
key) and press OK key.
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
○ ○
• When replacing the CIS Unit value in the service label.
• When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit Display/adj/set range -512 to 512
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB Unit 0.001 line
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value -333
Display/adj/set range 128 to 384 Supplement/memo 50% reading: 300 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x
Default value 307 600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode.
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> CCD> TARGET-B 50-GB Color displacement (G and B lines) correction value in the
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 vertical scanning direction (50%)
  Details To correct the color displacement (G and B lines) in the
vertical scanning direction at 50% copyboard reading.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
of service label.
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
○ ○
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -512 to 512
Unit 0.001 line
Default value 333
Supplement/memo 50% reading: 300 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x
600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode.

8-10
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8-11
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85
100-RG Color displacement (R and G lines) correction value in the 50DF-RG Color displacement (R and G lines) correction value in the
vertical scanning direction (100%) vertical scanning direction at ADF reading (50%)
  Details To correct the color displacement (R and G lines) in the   Details To correct the color displacement (R and G lines) in the
vertical scanning direction at 100% copyboard reading. vertical scanning direction at 50% ADF reading.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
of service label. of service label.
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
○ ○ ○ ○
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label. value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -512 to 512 Display/adj/set range -512 to 512
Unit 0.001 line Unit 0.001 line
Default value -333 Default value -333
Supplement/memo 100% reading: 600 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x Supplement/memo 50% reading: 300 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x
600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode. 600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode.
100-GB Color displacement (G and B lines) correction value in the 50DF-GB Color displacement (G and B lines) correction value in the
vertical scanning direction (100%) vertical scanning direction at ADF reading (50%)
  Details To correct the color displacement (G and B lines) in the   Details To correct the color displacement (G and B lines) in the
vertical scanning direction at 100% copyboard reading. vertical scanning direction at 50% ADF reading.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
of service label. of service label.
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
○ ○ ○ ○
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label. value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -512 to 512 Display/adj/set range -512 to 512
Unit 0.001 line Unit 0.001 line
Default value 333 Default value 333
Supplement/memo 100% reading: 600 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x Supplement/memo 50% reading: 300 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x
600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode. 600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode.

8-11
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8-12
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85
100DF-RG Color displacement (R and G lines) correction value in the OFST-BW1 Adjustment of CIS (Center) at B&W reading
vertical scanning direction at ADF reading (100%)   Details To adjust the offset of the CIS (Center) when reading
  Details To correct the color displacement (R and G lines) in the B&W original.
vertical scanning direction at 100% ADF reading. Use case When replacing the CIS Unit
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
of service label. Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB Default value 8
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC
○ ○
key) and press OK key. OFST-BW2 Adjustment of CIS (Front) at B&W reading
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed   Details To adjust the offset of the CIS (Front) when reading B&W
value in the service label. original.
Display/adj/set range -512 to 512 Use case When replacing the CIS Unit
Unit 0.001 line ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value -333 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Supplement/memo 100% reading: 600 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x Default value 8
600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode.
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC
100DF-GB Color displacement (G and B lines) correction value in the
OFST-CL0 Adjustment of CIS (Rear) at color reading
vertical scanning direction at ADF reading (100%)
  Details To adjust the offset of the CIS (Rear) when reading color
  Details To correct the color displacement (G and B lines) in the
original.
vertical scanning direction at 100% ADF reading.
Use case When replacing the CIS Unit
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
of service label.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Default value 8
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
○ ○ Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>CL-AGC
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed OFST-CL1 Adjustment of CIS (Center) at color reading
value in the service label.   Details To adjust the offset of the CIS (Center) when reading
Display/adj/set range -512 to 512 color original.
Unit 0.001 line Use case When replacing the CIS Unit
○ ○
Default value 333 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo 100% reading: 600 dpi in horizontal scanning direction x Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
600 dpi in vertical scanning direction reading mode. Default value 8
OFST-BW0 Adjustment of CIS (Rear) at B&W reading Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>CL-AGC
  Details To adjust the offset of the CIS (Rear) when reading B&W OFST-CL2 Adjustment of CIS (Front) at color reading
original.   Details To adjust the offset of the CIS (Front) when reading color
Use case When replacing the CIS Unit original.
○ ○ Use case When replacing the CIS Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 8 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC Default value 8
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>CL-AGC

8-12
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8-13
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > CCD M82 M85
GAIN-BW0 Adjustment of gain at B&W reading LED-CL-G Adjustment of LED light-up time (G) at color reading
  Details To adjust the gain when reading B&W original.   Details To adjust the green color LED light-up time when reading
Use case When replacing the CIS Unit color original.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 1 to 255 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2168
Default value 64 Default value 1200
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC
GAIN-CL0 Adjustment of gain at color reading LED-CL-B Adjustment of LED light-up time (B) at color reading
  Details To adjust the gain when reading color original.   Details To adjust the blue color LED light-up time when reading
Use case When replacing the CIS Unit color original.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 1 to 255 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2168
Default value 64 Default value 1200
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>CL-AGC Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC
LED-BW-R Adjustment of LED light-up time (R) at B&W reading T-8-7

  Details To adjust the red color LED light-up time when reading
B&W original.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2432
Default value 1000
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>CL-AGC
LED-BW-G Adjustment of LED light-up time (G) at B&W reading
  Details To adjust the green color LED light-up time when reading
B&W original.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2432
Default value 1000
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC
LED-BW-B Adjustment of LED light-up time (B) at B&W reading
  Details To adjust the blue color LED light-up time when reading
B&W original.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2432
Default value 1000
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC
LED-CL-R Adjustment of LED light-up time (R) at color reading
  Details To adjust the red color LED light-up time when reading
color original.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2168
Default value 1200
Related service mode COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD>BW-AGC

8-13
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > PASCAL
8-14
■■PASCAL COPIER > ADJUST > PASCAL M82 M85
OFST-P-K Bk density adj at test print reading
COPIER > ADJUST > PASCAL M82 M85   Details To adjust the offset of Bk color test print reading signal at
OFST-P-Y Y density adj at test print reading Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust).
  Details To adjust the offset of Y color test print reading signal at When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust). of service label.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment
of service label. gets darker.
As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
gets darker. • When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB key) and press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
key) and press OK key. value in the service label.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
value in the service label. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
T-8-8
Default value 0
OFST-P-M M density adj at test print reading
  Details To adjust the offset of M color test print reading signal at
Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust).
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
of service label.
As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment
gets darker.
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
Default value 0
OFST-P-C C density adj at test print reading
  Details To adjust the offset of C color test print reading signal at
Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust).
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value
of service label.
As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment
gets darker.
Use case • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed
value in the service label.
Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
Default value 0

8-14
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > PASCAL
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > VIFADJ
8-15
■■VIFADJ COPIER > ADJUST > VIFADJ M82 M85
TR1-HV-Y Adjustment of primary transfer bias setting value (Y)
COPIER > ADJUST > VIFADJ M82 M85   Details To adjust the setting value of Y-color primary transfer
DEV-HV-Y Adjustment of developing bias setting value (Y) bias.
  Details To adjust the setting value of Y-color developing bias. Use case When an image failure occurs
Use case When an image failure occurs Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ ○ ○
key) and press OK key.
key) and press OK key. ○ ○ Display/adj/set range -5 to 5
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5 Default value 0
Default value 0 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> TR1-HV-M, TR1-HV-C,
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> DEV-HV-M, DEV-HV-C, TR1-HV-K
DEV-HV-K TR1-HV-M Adjustment of primary transfer bias setting value (M)
DEV-HV-M Adjustment of developing bias setting value (M)   Details To adjust the setting value of M-color primary transfer
  Details To adjust the setting value of M-color developing bias. bias.
Use case When an image failure occurs Use case When an image failure occurs
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. ○ ○ ○ ○
key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5 Display/adj/set range -5 to 5
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> DEV-HV-Y, DEV-HV-C, Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> TR1-HV-Y, TR1-HV-C,
DEV-HV-K TR1-HV-K
DEV-HV-C Adjustment of developing bias setting value (C) TR1-HV-C Adjustment of primary transfer bias setting value (C)
  Details To adjust the setting value of C-color developing bias.   Details To adjust the setting value of C-color primary transfer
Use case When an image failure occurs bias.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Use case When an image failure occurs
key) and press OK key. ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5 ○ ○
key) and press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -5 to 5
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> DEV-HV-Y, DEV-HV-M, Default value 0
DEV-HV-K Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> TR1-HV-Y, TR1-HV-M,
DEV-HV-K Adjustment of developing bias setting value (Bk) TR1-HV-K
  Details To adjust the setting value of Bk-color developing bias. TR1-HV-K Adjustment of primary transfer bias setting value (Bk)
Use case When an image failure occurs   Details To adjust the setting value of Bk-color primary transfer
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ bias.
key) and press OK key. ○ ○ Use case When an image failure occurs
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
○ ○
Default value 0 key) and press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> DEV-HV-Y, DEV-HV-M, Display/adj/set range -5 to 5
DEV-HV-C Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> TR1-HV-Y, TR1-HV-M,
TR1-HV-C

8-15
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > VIFADJ
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR
8-16
COPIER > ADJUST > VIFADJ M82 M85 ■■SCNR
TR2SF-HV Adjustment of secondary transfer bias setting value (front
side) COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR M82 M85
  Details To adjust the setting value of secondary transfer bias (front SUB-S-Y0 Adjustment of emitting position 1 (Y) in the vertical
side). scanning direction
Use case When an image failure occurs   Details To adjust the Y-color emitting position 1 in the vertical
○ ○ scanning position.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5 written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit
Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> TR2BK-HV
key) and press OK key.
TR2BK-HV Adjustment of secondary transfer bias setting value (back
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
side)
Default value 0
  Details To adjust the setting value of secondary transfer bias
SUB-S-M0 Adjustment of emitting position 1 (M) in the vertical
(back side).
scanning direction
Use case When an image failure occurs
○ ○   Details To adjust the M-color emitting position 1 in the vertical
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
scanning position.
key) and press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Default value 0
Scanner Unit
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> VIFADJ> TR2SF-HV
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
ICL-HV Adjustment of bias setting value for ITB cleaning key) and press OK key.
  Details To adjust the bias setting value to be used for ITB Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
cleaning.
Default value 0
Use case When an image failure occurs
○ ○ SUB-S-C0 Adjustment of emitting position 1 (C) in the vertical
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ scanning direction
key) and press OK key.
  Details To adjust the C-color emitting position 1 in the vertical
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5 scanning position.
Default value 0 Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
FU-TMP Adjustment of setting value of Fixing Roller surface written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
temperature Scanner Unit
  Details To adjust the setting value of the surface temperature of Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
the Fixing Roller. key) and press OK key.
Use case When an image failure occurs ○ ○ Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Default value 0
key) and press OK key. SUB-S-K0 Adjustment of emitting position 1 (Bk) in the vertical
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 scanning direction
Default value 0   Details To adjust the Bk-color emitting position 1 in the vertical
T-8-9 scanning position.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-16
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR
8-17
COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR M82 M85
SUB-S-Y1 Adjustment of emitting position 2 (Y) in the vertical SUB-S-Y2 Adjustment of emitting position 3 (Y) in the vertical
scanning direction scanning direction
  Details To adjust the Y-color emitting position 2 in the vertical   Details To adjust the Y-color emitting position 3 in the vertical
scanning position. scanning position.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUB-S-M1 Adjustment of emitting position 2 (M) in the vertical SUB-S-M2 Adjustment of emitting position 3 (M) in the vertical
scanning direction scanning direction
  Details To adjust the M-color emitting position 2 in the vertical   Details To adjust the M-color emitting position 3 in the vertical
scanning position. scanning position.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUB-S-C1 Adjustment of emitting position 2 (C) in the vertical SUB-S-C2 Adjustment of emitting position 3 (C) in the vertical
scanning direction scanning direction
  Details To adjust the C-color emitting position 2 in the vertical   Details To adjust the C-color emitting position 3 in the vertical
scanning position. scanning position.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
  Details To adjust the Bk-color emitting position 2 in the vertical SUB-S-K2 Adjustment of emitting position 3 (Bk) in the vertical
scanning position. scanning direction
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value   Details To adjust the Bk-color emitting position 3 in the vertical
written on the label included in the package of the Laser scanning position.
Scanner Unit ○ ○ Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
key) and press OK key. Scanner Unit
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
Default value 0 key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-17
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR
8 Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR
8-18
COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR M82 M85 COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR M82 M85
MAI-S-Y0 Adjustment of scan time 1 (Y) in the horizontal scanning MAI-S-Y1 Adjustment of scan time 2 (Y) in the horizontal scanning
direction direction
  Details To adjust the Y-color scan time 1 in the horizontal   Details To adjust the Y-color scan time 2 in the horizontal
scanning direction. scanning direction.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -511 to 511 Display/adj/set range -511 to 511
Default value 0 Default value 0
MAI-S-M0 Adjustment of scan time 1 (M) in the horizontal scanning MAI-S-M1 Adjustment of scan time 2 (M) in the horizontal scanning
direction direction
  Details To adjust the M-color scan time 1 in the horizontal   Details To adjust the M-color scan time 2 in the horizontal
scanning direction. scanning direction.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -511 to 511 Display/adj/set range -511 to 511
Default value 0 Default value 0
MAI-S-C0 Adjustment of scan time 1 (C) in the horizontal scanning MAI-S-C1 Adjustment of scan time 2 (C) in the horizontal scanning
direction direction
  Details To adjust the C-color scan time 1 in the horizontal   Details To adjust the C-color scan time 2 in the horizontal
scanning direction. scanning direction.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -511 to 511 Display/adj/set range -511 to 511
Default value 0 Default value 0
MAI-S-K0 Adjustment of scan time 1 (Bk) in the horizontal scanning MAI-S-K1 Adjustment of scan time 2 (Bk) in the horizontal scanning
direction direction
  Details To adjust the Bk-color scan time 1 in the horizontal   Details To adjust the Bk-color scan time 2 in the horizontal
scanning direction. scanning direction.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○
Scanner Unit Scanner Unit
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+
key) and press OK key. key) and press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -511 to 511 Display/adj/set range -511 to 511
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-18
8
Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD
8-19
COPIER > ADJUST > SCNR M82 M85 FUNCTION
MAI-S-Y2 Adjustment of scan time 3 (Y) in the horizontal scanning
direction
■■CCD
  Details To adjust the Y-color scan time 3 in the horizontal
scanning direction. COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD M82 M85
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value DF-WLVL1 White level adj in book mode: color
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○   Details To adjust the white level for copyboard scanning
Scanner Unit automatically by setting the paper which is usually used
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ by the user on the Copyboard Glass.
key) and press OK key. Use case • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
Display/adj/set range -127 to 127 • When replacing the CIS Unit
Default value 0 • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
MAI-S-M2 Adjustment of scan time 3 (M) in the horizontal scanning Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the Copyboard Glass.
direction 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
  Details To adjust the M-color scan time 3 in the horizontal Caution Be sure to execute DF-WLVL2 in a row.
scanning direction. Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R, DFTAR-G,
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value DFTAR-B
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL2
Scanner Unit DF-WLVL2 White level adj in ADF mode: color
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+   Details To adjust the white level for ADF scanning automatically
key) and press OK key. by setting the paper which is usually used by the user on
Display/adj/set range -127 to 127 the ADF.
Default value 0 Use case • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
MAI-S-C2 Adjustment of scan time 3 (C) in the horizontal scanning • When replacing the CIS Unit
direction • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit ○ ○
  Details To adjust the C-color scan time 3 in the horizontal Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the ADF.
scanning direction. 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Caution Be sure to execute this item after DF-WLVL1.
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R, DFTAR-G,
Scanner Unit DFTAR-B
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1
key) and press OK key. DF-WLVL3 White level adj in book mode (B&W)
Display/adj/set range -127 to 127   Details To adjust the white level for copyboard scanning
Default value 0 automatically by setting the paper which is usually used
MAI-S-K2 Adjustment of scan time 3 (Bk) in the horizontal scanning by the user on the Copyboard Glass.
direction Use case • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit
  Details To adjust the Bk-color scan time 3 in the horizontal • When replacing the CIS Unit
○ ○
scanning direction. • When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit, enter the value Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the Copyboard Glass.
written on the label included in the package of the Laser ○ ○ 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Scanner Unit Caution Be sure to execute DF-WLVL4 in a row.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW
key) and press OK key. COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL4
Display/adj/set range -127 to 127
Default value 0
T-8-10

8-19
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR
8-20
COPIER > FUNCTION > CCD M82 M85 ■■CLEAR
DF-WLVL4 White level adj in ADF mode (B&W)
  Details To adjust the white level for ADF scanning automatically
COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR M82 M85
by setting the paper which is usually used by the user on R-CON Initialization of Reader/ADF
the DADF.   Details To initialize the factory adjustment values of the Reader/
Use case • When replacing the Reader Upper Cover Unit ADF. ○ ○
• When replacing the CIS Unit Use case When clearing RAM data of the Main Controller PCB
○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
• When replacing the ADF/Reader Unit
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the ADF. SRVC-DAT Clearing service mode setting value
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.   Details To clear the service mode setting values.
Caution Be sure to execute this item after DF-WLVL3. The user mode setting values are not cleared.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-BW The factory adjustment values of the Reader/ADF are not ○ ○
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL3 initialized.
CL-AGC CIS light intensity adj in ADF (color) Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
  Details To adjust the black/white level of the CIS for ADF 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
scanning automatically by setting the paper which is COUNTER Clearing service counter
usually used by the user on the ADF.   Details To clear the counter by maintenance/part/mode.
(For color scanning) The numerator printed on a system dump list becomes 0. ○ ○
○ ○ Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case • When replacing the Reader Unit
• When replacing the CIS Unit 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the ADF. HIST Clear of logs
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.   Details To clear the communication management/print/jam/error
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> BW-AGC log.
○ ○
BW-AGC CIS light intensity adj in ADF (B&W) Use case When clearing logs
  Details To adjust the black/white level of the CIS for ADF Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
scanning automatically by setting the paper which is 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
usually used by the user on the ADF. ALL Clearing setting information
(For B&W scanning)   Details • User mode setting values
Setting values of the following service modes are • Service mode setting values (excluding the service
automatically calculated: COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > counter)
OFST-BW0/1/2, GAIN-BW0, LED-BW-R/G/B. • ID and password of the system administrator
Use case • When replacing the Reader Unit • Communication management/print/jam/error log
• When replacing the CIS Unit • E719 error (counter meter-installed models only)
○ ○ ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the ADF. The following items are not cleared/initialized.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. • Service counter
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> CL-AGC • Factory adjustment values of the Reader/ADF
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > OFST-BW0 Use case At installation
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > OFST-BW1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > OFST-BW2 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > GAIN-BW0 Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> BODY> LOCALE, SIZE-LC
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > LED-BW-R T-8-12
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > LED-BW-G
COPIER > ADJUST > CCD > LED-BW-B
T-8-11

8-20
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P
8-21
■■MISC-R ■■MISC-P
COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-R M82 M85 COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P M82 M85
SCANLAMP Light-up check of CIS Unit LED SRVC-DAT Output of system data list/system dump list
  Details To light up CIS Unit LED for 3 seconds.   Details To execute report output of the system data list and the
Light up in the following order: R->G->B->R->G-B. system dump list.
○ ○
Use case When replacing the CIS Unit LED System data list: The service software switches and
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. parameters used in FAX function ▲ ▲
Required time 3 seconds System dump list: The number of sends/receives, the
SCAN-ON Execution of copyboard reading number of pages sent/received, the number of sheets
printed/read, the number of errors, etc.
  Details To execute reading of the original on the Copyboard
Glass. ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the Copyboard Glass. SYS-DAT Output of system data list
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.   Details To execute report output of the system data list.
T-8-13
The service software switches and parameters used in ▲ ▲
FAX function are output.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
SYS-DMP Output of system dump list
  Details To execute report output of the system dump list.
The number of sends/receives, the number of pages
▲ ▲
sent/received, the number of sheets printed/read, the
number of errors, etc. are output.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
CNTR Output of counter report
  Details To output the counter report.
The usage of functions (reading, recording, ○ ○
communication and copy) is output.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
ERR-LOG Output of error log report
  Details To output the error log report. ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
SPEC Output of spec report
  Details To output the spec report.
The current device specifications such as the location, ○ ○
model information, and ROM version are output.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
T-8-14

8-21
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC
8-22
■■SYSTEM ■■VIFFNC
COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM M82 M85 COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC M82 M85
PANEL-UP Download from USB memory (PANEL) SMEAR-PV Execution of image smear prevention mode
  Details To perform downloading when PANEL exists in the root   Details To execute the image smear prevention mode.
directory of the USB memory. Depending on the paper type or environment (especially
Use case At upgrade in a high humidity environment), thin line or fine halftone
Adj/set/operate method 1) Install the USB memory. may become lighter.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. ○ ○ In this case, execute the image smear prevention mode
(rotate the drum for 60 seconds after toner ejection of all ○ ○
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not turn OFF/ON the power before “Executing...” colors).
disappears. Use case When thin line or fine halftone becomes lighter
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> DOWNLOAD, BKUP- Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
UP Display/adj/set range 0: OFF, 1: ON
LOGWRITE Writing sublog to USB memory Default value 0
  Details To write sublog that includes the following information to FEED-IMP Execution of pickup jam prevention mode
the USB memory.   Details When using paper with which double feed is more likely
• Job list (job names, user names, and destinations) to occur, pickup operation cannot be performed at the
• Communications log (destinations and user names) appropriate timing because of double feed. As a result of
• Job log (user names and job names) that, pickup delay jam may occur.
○ ○
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem In this case, extend the pickup interval. Jam occurrence
Adj/set/operate method 1) Install the USB memory. can be prevented, but productivity decreases.
○ ○
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. Use case When pickup jam occurs with paper with which double
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. feed is more likely to occur
Caution Do not turn OFF/ON the power before “Executing...” Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
disappears. Caution Be sure to get approval from the user by telling that the
IMPORT Reading of service mode setting value from USB memory productivity decreases to prevent jam occurrence.
  Details To write the service mode setting values (excluding those Display/adj/set range 0: OFF, 1: ON
related to Reader/ADF) to the USB memory. Default value 0
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB as a measure FOG-PV Execution of image fogging prevention mode 2
against failures   Details To execute the image fogging prevention mode 2 (the
○ ○
Adj/set/operate method 1) Install the USB memory. following 4 processing) when fogging which looks like fine
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. vertical lines occurs on the image.
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. • Toner ejection of all colors
Caution Do not turn OFF/ON the power before “Executing...” • Rotation of the drum for 60 seconds
disappears. • Offset of charging - ○
EXPORT Writing service mode setting value to USB memory • Cleaning sequence for talc paper
  Details To write the service mode setting values (excluding those Use case When fogging which looks like fine vertical lines occurs
related to Reader/ADF) to the USB memory. Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB as a measure Display/adj/set range 0: OFF, 1: ON
○ ○
against failures Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Install the USB memory. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL14682
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution “Executing...” disappears when writing is completed.
T-8-15

8-22
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8-23
COPIER > FUNCTION > VIFFNC M82 M85 ■■SPLMAN
ICL-IMP Execution of ITB cleaning failure prevention 1
  Details MF8200
COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85
To alleviate cleaning failure by increasing the current SPL14159 Fixing of USB device ID
(bias) applied to the Cleaning Blade and Primary   Details To fix the USB device ID to “000000000000”.
Transfer Roller. Driver for each machine is installed to a PC. However,
MF8500 by fixing the serial number, the PC considers that any
To execute cleaning for one round of the ITB after connected machine to be the same machine; thus, there
printing 2 sheets. (It becomes 2 sheets intermittent will be no need to install the drivers many times. ○ ○
mode.) ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Use case When an image that was on 2 sheets before appears 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
lightly depending on paper type and print pattern Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
(especially high printing ratio) 0: OFF, 1: ON
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0: OFF, 1: ON SPL27767 Setting of highly-resistive paper
Default value 0   Details To increase the secondary transfer bias.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL50288 Use case When a trace which looks like toner scattering occurs
FD-R-CHG Execution of Pickup Roller replacement mode around the text or print pattern depending on the paper
  Details To move the Pickup Roller to the replacement position by type or environment (especially in a low humidity
executing this mode. ○ ○ environment) ○ ○
Use case When replacing the Pickup Roller Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
STOR-DCN Backup of Engine Controller PCB NVRAM 0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
  Details To back up the setting data in NVRAM of the Engine
Controller PCB to NVRAM of the Main Controller PCB. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPL26535
Use case Before replacing the Engine Controller PCB SPL89793 Execution of re-transfer prevention mode
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.   Details To lower the primary transfer bias.
○ ○ Use case When re-transfer occurs due to strong primary transfer
Caution During operation, the setting data changes by manual or
automatic adjustment. When backup data which has been bias
- ○
left for a long period of time is restored, it is overwritten Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
with new setting data and the old data is deleted. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> RSTR-DCN 0: OFF, 1: ON
RSTR-DCN Restoration of Engine Controller PCB NVRAM Default value 0
  Details To restore backup information of the Engine Controller SPL23846 Setting of moist paper
PCB NVRAM stored in the Main Controller PCB NVRAM   Details To increase the secondary transfer bias.
to the Engine Controller PCB NVRAM. Use case When color text or pattern using 2 or more colors of
Use case After replacing the Engine Controller PCB toner becomes lighter depending on the paper type or
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. environment (especially in a high humidity environment) ○ -
○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution During operation, the setting data changes by manual or Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
automatic adjustment. When backup data which has been 0: OFF, 1: ON
left for a long period of time is restored, it is overwritten Default value 0
with new setting data and the old data is deleted.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> STOR-DCN
T-8-16

8-23
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8-24
COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85 COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85
SPL26433 Execution of drum idle rotation mode SPL41971 Execution of curl prevention mode 1
  Details To execute idle rotation of the drum.   Details To extend the initial rotation time and paper interval, and
Use case When thin, sharp horizontal lines appear in halftone lower the control temperature.
images after a long downtime Use case When paper which has been printed is curled toward the
○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. printed side depending on the paper type, environment
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 (especially in a low humidity environment) or print pattern
- ○
0: OFF, 1: ON (especially high printing ratio)
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
SPL14682 Execution of image fogging prevention mode 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
  Details To change the developing bias. 0: OFF, 1: ON
Use case When toner is lightly transferred to the white area in case Default value 0
of printing an image with large white area using glossy Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL69399
paper SPL35607 Execution of down sequence prevention mode
○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.   Details To lower the control temperature of the Fixing Assembly
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 without exception.
0: OFF, 1: ON Use case When down sequence occurs
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> VIFFNC> FOG-PV Caution Be sure to get approval from the user in advance by
- ○
SPL83279 Setting of Chinese paper explaining that there is a possibility that fixing failure may
  Details To change the transfer bias. occur depending on the paper type by lowering the fixing
Use case When a trace which looks like toner scattering occurs control temperature.
around the text or print pattern in case of using Chinese Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
paper ○ ○ 0: OFF, 1: ON
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 SPL37510 ON/OFF of ITB cleaning at paper size mismatch
0: OFF, 1: ON   Details Normally, when paper other than that of the specified size
Default value 0 is fed, ITB cleaning is executed to remove toner.
SPL50288 Execution of ITB cleaning failure prevention 2 When 1 is set, ITB cleaning is not executed even if paper
size is mismatched.
  Details MF8200
Productivity improves, but toner soiling may occur.
To alleviate cleaning failure by increasing the current
(bias) applied to the Cleaning Blade and Primary Use case When paper size is mismatched ○ ○
Transfer Roller. Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
MF8500 Caution Be sure to get approval from the user by telling that toner
To execute cleaning for one round of the ITB after soiling may occur to improve productivity.
printing 2 sheets. (It becomes 2 sheets intermittent Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
mode.) 0: ON, 1: OFF
It is more effective than ICL-IMP. ○ ○ Default value 0
Use case When an image that was on 2 sheets before appears
lightly depending on paper type and print pattern
(especially high printing ratio)
When the trailing edge of paper is soiled
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-24
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8-25
COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85 COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85
SPL65677 Increase of paper leading edge margin SPL25607 Decrease of paper right and left margins
  Details To increase the margin on the leading edge of paper.   Details To decrease the margins on the right and left edges of
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased paper.
by 0.1 mm. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is decreased
If the setting is incompatible with SPL68676 (decrease by 0.1 mm.
of margin), the setting is disabled (the margin will be If the setting is incompatible with SPL68677 (increase
standard). ○ ○ of margins), the setting is disabled (the margins will be
standard). ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 0.1 mm Display/adj/set range 0 to 20
Default value 0 Unit 0.1 mm
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL68676 Default value 0
SPL68676 Decrease of paper leading edge margin Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL68677
  Details To decrease the margin on the leading edge of paper. SPL93822 Setting of department ID count all clear
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is decreased   Details To set whether to disable clearing of all department ID
by 0.1 mm. counts.
If the setting is incompatible with SPL65677(increase Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
of margin), the setting is disabled (the margin will be Caution Be sure to perform this mode after consulting with the
standard). ○ ○
○ ○ system administrator at user’s site.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20 Default value 0
Unit 0.1 mm Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL78788
Default value 0 SPL78788 Setting of department ID count clear
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL65677   Details To set whether to disable clearing of department ID count.
SPL68677 Increase of paper right and left margins Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
  Details To increase the margins on the right and left edges of Caution Be sure to perform this mode after consulting with the
paper. system administrator at user’s site. ○ ○
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
by 0.1 mm. 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
If the setting is incompatible with SPL25607 (decrease Default value 0
of margins), the setting is disabled (the margins will be
○ ○ Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL93822
standard).
SPL41250 Reset of calibration
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
  Details When the user allows printing at absence of toner,
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
calibration using toner is disabled.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20
As a remedy, calibration reset is executed by this switch.
Unit 0.1 mm
Use case When the user allows printing after absence of toner is
Default value 0 displayed. ○ ○
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SPLMAN> SPL25607 Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-25
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8 Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8-26
COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85 COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN M82 M85
SPL15176 Extension of detection on absence of toner SPL00171 Change of the maximum value of auto sleep shift time
  Details Error occurs when the drum running distance reaches a   Details To change the maximum value of auto sleep shift time in
certain point in the case of toner absence. Settings/Registration> Timer Settings> Auto Sleep Time.
Turning this switch ON delays the occurrence of error Use case When changing the setting time to shift to auto sleep
(threshold value is changed). mode
Use case When delaying the display of “absence of toner” message ○ - Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: 0 to 60, 1: 0 to 240
0: OFF, 1: ON Default value 0 (For Europe)
Default value 0 1 (For locations other than Europe)
SPL89821 Shop demonstration mode SPL80100 Mask setting at copyboard scanning
  Details To display image data on color UI repeatedly to appeal   Details To cancel the image mask occurs on the left edge at
the product features to potential users. copyboard scanning.
Use case When appealing the product features to users at shops Use case Upon request from user who does not satisfy with the
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. mask on the left edge ○ ○
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. ○ ○ Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0: Mask value according to the specifications of each job
0: OFF, 1: ON 1: No mask (0 mm)
Default value 0 Default value 0
Supplement/memo When the setting value is 1 at startup, the shop
SPL27354 For R&D use
demonstration mode is enabled.
SPL58122 Wrinkle prevention mode   Details For R&D use ○ ○
  Details To prevent envelope from getting wrinkles by keeping Default value Default value is not changed.
the speed of the Fixing Motor constant and feeding an T-8-17
envelope with a little pulling tension applied to it.
Use case When preventing envelope from getting wrinkles ○ -
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
SPL71100 Setting of the duty of Off-hook PCB
  Details This is the mode to make handsets of particular
manufacturers to be rung when fax reception mode is set
to "FAX/TEL switching".
Use case When fax reception mode is set to FAX/TEL switching
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 99
▲ ▲
Default value 50
Supplement/memo When receiving a call, a handset connected to the host
machine is rung. However, if the connected handset is
manufactured by a particular manufacturer (e.g., SANYO,
Model No.: TEL-DH5, etc.), it may not be rung. To solve
the problem, set the value so that the handset can be
rung correctly.

8-26
8
Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > SPLMAN
8 Service Mode > COPIER > OPTION > BODY
8-27
■■INSTALL OPTION
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL M82 M85
STRD-POS Scan position auto adj in ADF mode ■■BODY
  Details To adjust the ADF scanning position automatically. COPIER > OPTION > BODY M82 M85
Use case At ADF installation/uninstallation TMIC-BK ON/OFF of TMIC Bk PASCAL gamma LUT trailing edge
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set a paper for stream reading position adjustment, correction
and then close the ADF.   Details To set ON/OFF of the trailing edge correction of Bk color
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. ○ ○ PASCAL gamma LUT used by TMIC.
The operation automatically stops after the adjustment. When 1 is set, the density of the high density area is high.
3) Write the value displayed by COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ- Therefore, while text and thin lines are clear, gradation of
XY>STRD-POS in the service label. photos may become unnatural.
Caution Write the adjusted value in the service label. When 0 is set, the density of the high density area
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS becomes low. Therefore, while the gradation is improved,
T-8-18 thin lines may be partly missing or characters may be
faded. ○ ○
Use case • When gradation of photos become unnatural
• When thin lines are partly missing or characters are
faded
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 1
Supplement/memo TMIC: Error diffusion correction of photo/high image
quality.
TMIC-CMY ON/OFF of TMIC Y/M/C PASCAL gamma LUT trailing
edge correction
  Details To set ON/OFF of the trailing edge correction of Y/M/C
color PASCAL gamma LUT used by TMIC.
When 1 is set, the density of the high density area is high.
Therefore, while text and thin lines are clear, the hue of
gradation area of photos may change.
When 0 is set, the density of the high density area
becomes low. Therefore, while the gradation is improved,
thin lines may be partly missing or characters may be
faded. ○ ○
Use case • When gradation of photos become unnatural
• When thin lines are partly missing or characters are
faded
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 1
Supplement/memo TMIC: Error diffusion correction of photo/high image
quality.

8-27
8
Service Mode > COPIER > OPTION > BODY
8 Service Mode > COPIER > OPTION > BODY
8-28
COPIER > OPTION > BODY M82 M85 COPIER > OPTION > BODY M82 M85
LOCALE Setting of location NS-CMD5 Setting of CRAM-MD5 authentication method at SMTP
  Details To set the location. authentication
At installation in areas other than Japan, perform the   Details To restrict use of CRAM-MD5 authentication method at
following procedure to match the setting information with the time of SMTP authentication.
that of the location. When 1 is set, CRAM-MD5 authentication method is not
Use case • At installation used.
• When changing the location information Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value under LOCALE, and then press Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Set the paper size configuration under SIZE-LC. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 ○ ○
3) Execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> ALL. 0: Used (SMTP server-dependent), 1: Not used
○ ○
4) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Caution Since COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> ALL is executed Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user
when changing the location, the setting information of authentication function is added to SMTP, which is the
user mode, service mode, etc. is initialized. protocol to be used for e-mail transmission. At the time of
The setting information of this item is not initialized. e-mail transmission, this protocol executes authentication
Display/adj/set range 1 to 8 of the user account and the password between the SMTP
1: Japan, 2: North America, 3: Korea, 4: China, 5: Taiwan, server and the user to approve e-mail transmission only
6: Europe, 7: Asia, 8: Oceania when it’s authenticated.
Default value 1 NS-PLN Setting of plaintext authentication at SMTP authentication
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> ALL   Details To restrict use of PLAIN/LOGIN authentication,
COPIER> OPTION> BODY> SIZE-LC which is plaintext authentication, at the time of SMTP
SIZE-LC Setting of paper size configuration authentication under the environment where the
  Details To set the paper size configuration. communication packet is not encrypted.
At installation in areas other than Japan, perform the When 1 is set, plaintext authentication is not used.
following procedure to match the setting information with Use case Upon user’s request
that of the location. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case • At installation 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
• Upon user’s request Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set the location under LOCALE. 0: Used (SMTP server-dependent), 1: Not used
2) Enter the setting value under SIZE-LC, and then press Default value 0
OK key. Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user
3) Execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> ALL. ○ ○ authentication function is added to SMTP, which is the
4) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. protocol to be used for e-mail transmission. At the time of
Caution Since COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> ALL is executed e-mail transmission, this protocol executes authentication
when changing the location, the setting information of of the user account and the password between the SMTP
user mode, service mode, etc. is initialized. server and the user to approve e-mail transmission only
The setting information of this item is not initialized. when it’s authenticated.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 4
1: AB configuration, 2: Inch configuration, 3: A
configuration, 4: AB/Inch configuration
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> ALL
COPIER> OPTION> BODY> LOCALE

8-28
8
Service Mode > COPIER > OPTION > BODY
8 Service Mode > COPIER > OPTION > ACC
8-29
COPIER > OPTION > BODY M82 M85 COPIER > OPTION > BODY M82 M85
NS-LGN Setting of LOGIN authentication at SMTP authentication PSWD-SW Setting of service mode password level
  Details To restrict use of LOGIN authentication at the time of Details To set the password level required to get into service
SMTP authentication. mode.
When 1 is set, LOGIN authentication is not used. Use case When getting into service mode
Use case Upon user’s request Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: Password is not required
0: Used (SMTP server-dependent), 1: Not used ○ ○ (RUI service mode password only)
Default value 0 1: Password for service engineer is required
Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user 2: Passwords for service engineer and system
authentication function is added to SMTP, which is the administrator at user's site are required
protocol to be used for e-mail transmission. At the time of Default value 0
e-mail transmission, this protocol executes authentication SM-PSWD Password setting for service technician
of the user account and the password between the SMTP Details To set the password required to enter when the level
server and the user to approve e-mail transmission only is set to 1 or 2 in PSWD-SW at the time of getting into
when it’s authenticated. service mode.
SLPMODE Setting of shift to sleep mode Use case When the level is set to 1 or 2 in PSWD-SW at the time of
○ ○
  Details To restrict shift to sleep mode 1/sleep mode 3. getting into service mode
When 1 is set, the machine does not shift to sleep mode. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When sleep failure occurs 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○ Display/adj/set range 1 to 99999999
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 11111111
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 T-8-19
0: Shift is available., 1: Shift is not available.
Default value 0
■■ACC
SDTM-DSP Setting of automatic shutdown menu display COPIER > OPTION > ACC M82 M85
Details When setting COPIER> OPTION> BODY> SDTM-DSP to WLANMODE Setting of IEEE802.11n
1, menu is displayed. When 0 is set, menu is hidden.   Details To set whether to enable IEEE802.11n which is the
Use case When setting the automatic shutdown menu display wireless LAN standard.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: Menu is hidden., 1: Menu is displayed. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Supplement/memo Even with the fax model for locations other than Europe, Default value 1 (Not depend on the location)
the service mode is displayed. However, the menu will not T-8-20
be displayed on UI even 1 is set.
RMT-SW ON/OFF setting of RUI service mode function
Details To set ON/OFF of RUI service mode function.
Use case When setting ON/OFF of RUI service mode function
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 1

8-29
8
Service Mode > COPIER > OPTION > ACC
8 Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > TOTAL
8-30
■■SERIAL COUTER
COPIER > OPTION > SERIAL M82 M85
SN-MAIN Entry of serial number ■■TOTAL
  Details To write the serial number of this machine in the Main COPIER > COUNTER > TOTAL M82 M85
Controller PCB. SERVICE1 Service-purposed total counter 1
When this item is executed, the 8-digit alphanumeric   Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the
entered in System Settings > Device Information > machine.
Location in user mode is written in the Main Controller The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
PCB. ○ ○
The counter is not advanced by delivery in service mode.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, be sure to write
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
the serial number in the new PBC to prepare for trouble
Unit Number of sheets
since the serial number of the device is not succeeded.
Default value 0
Use case - When replacing the Main Controller PCB
SERVICE2 Service-purposed total counter 2
Adj/set/operate method 1) Write down the current data in System Settings >
Device Information > Location in user mode.   Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the
2) Replace the Main Controller PCB after turning OFF the machine.
main power switch. The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
○ ○ ○ ○
3) Enter the serial number (8-digit alphanumeric) in The counter is not advanced by delivery in service mode.
“Location” of step 1. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
4) Select SN-MAIN, and then press OK key to write in the Unit Number of sheets
Main Controller PCB. Default value 0
After writing, the serial number entered in step 3 is TTL Total counter
deleted.   Details To display the total of counters of copy, PDL print, FAX,
5) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. report print and media print.
6) Output the spec report from COPIER> FUNCTION> (Total of COPY, PDL-PRT, FAX-PRT, RPT-PRT and MD-
MISC-P> SPEC to check the serial number (Body No.). PRT in service mode described below)
7) Enter the data backed up in step 1 in “Location”. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Caution Since the above “Location” is only temporarily used to Unit Number of sheets
store data, back up the data before input and enter it Default value 0
again after writing is completed. Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> TOTAL> COPY, PDL-PRT, FAX-
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> DHALF PRT, RPT-PRT, MD-PRT
Related user mode System Settings > Device Information> Location COPY Total copy counter
T-8-21   Details To count up when the copy is delivered outside the
machine.
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
The counter is not advanced by delivery in service mode. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> TOTAL> TTL

8-30
8
Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > TOTAL
8 Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > TOTAL
8-31
COPIER > COUNTER > TOTAL M82 M85 COPIER > COUNTER > TOTAL M82 M85
PDL-PRT PDL print counter 2-SIDE 2-sided copy/print counter
  Details To count up when the PDL print is delivered outside the   Details To count up the number of 2-sided copies/prints when the
machine/2-sided printout is stacked. copy/printout is delivered outside the machine/2-sided
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size. copy/printout is stacked.
The counter is not advanced by blank paper or delivery in The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
○ ○ - ○
service mode. The counter is not advanced by blank paper or delivery in
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 service mode.
Unit Number of sheets Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0 Unit Number of times
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> TOTAL> TTL Default value 0
FAX-PRT FAX reception print counter SCAN Scan counter
  Details To count up when the FAX reception print is delivered   Details To count up the number of scan operations when the
outside the machine/2-sided printout is stacked. scanning operation is complete.
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size. The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
○ ○
The counter is not advanced by blank paper or delivery in The counter is not advanced by delivery in service mode.
service mode. ▲ ▲ Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Unit Number of times
Unit Number of sheets Default value 0
Default value 0 T-8-22
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> TOTAL> TTL
RPT-PRT Report print counter
  Details To count up when the report print is delivered outside the
machine/2-sided printout is stacked.
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
The counter is not advanced by blank paper or delivery in ○ ○
service mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> TOTAL> TTL
MD-PRT Media print counter
  Details To count up when the media print is delivered outside the
machine.
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
The counter is not advanced by blank paper or delivery in
service mode. ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> TOTAL> TTL

8-31
8
Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > TOTAL
8 Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > JAM
8-32
■■PICK-UP ■■FEEDER
COPIER > COUNTER > PICK-UP M82 M85 COPIER > COUNTER > FEEDER M82 M85
C1 Cassette 1 pickup total counter FEED ADF original pickup total counter
  Details To count up the number of sheets picked up from the   Details To count up the number of originals picked up from the
Cassette 1 (standard Pickup Cassette). ADF.
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size. The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
○ ○
The counter is advanced by printout in service mode. Use case When checking the total counter of original pickup by ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 ADF
Unit Number of sheets Display/adj/set range 0 to 429496725
Default value 0 Unit Number of sheets
C2 Cassette 2 pickup total counter Default value 0
  Details To count up the number of sheets picked up from the T-8-24
Cassette 2 (option Pickup Cassette).
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size. ■■JAM
- ○
The counter is advanced by printout in service mode.
COPIER > COUNTER > JAM M82 M85
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
TOTAL Printer total jam counter
Unit Number of sheets
  Details To count up the number of total jam occurrences.
Default value 0
Use case When checking the total jam counter of printer
MF Multi-purpose Tray pickup total counter ○ ○
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
  Details To count up the number of sheets picked up from the
Unit Number of times
Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Unit.
Default value 0
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size.
○ ○ FEEDER ADF total jam counter
The counter is advanced by printout in service mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999   Details When checking the total jam counter of ADF
Unit Number of sheets Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 ○ ○
Default value 0 Unit Number of times
2-SIDE 2-sided pickup total counter Default value 0
  Details To count up the number of sheets picked up in duplex 2-SIDE Duplex Unit jam counter
mode.   Details To count up the number of jam occurrences in the Duplex
The counter is advanced regardless of the original size. Unit.
- ○ Use case When checking the jam counter of Duplex Unit - ○
The counter is advanced by printout in service mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets Unit Number of times
Default value 0 Default value 0
T-8-23 MF Multi-purpose Pickup Tray jam counter
  Details To count up the number of jam occurrences in the Multi-
purpose Tray Pickup Unit.
The counter is advanced by paper size mismatch or
misprint.
○ ○
Use case When checking the jam counter of Multi-purpose Pickup
Tray
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of times
Default value 0

8-32
8
Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > JAM
8 Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > DRBL-2
8-33
COPIER > COUNTER > JAM M82 M85 ■■DRBL-2
C1 Cassette 1 pickup jam counter
  Details To count up the number of jam occurrences in the
COPIER > COUNTER > DRBL-2 M82 M85
Cassette 1 (standard Pickup Cassette). DF-SP-PD Separation Pad parts counter: ADF
The counter is advanced by paper size mismatch or   Details To count up the number of sheets to be fed regardless of
○ ○ 1-sided/2-sided mode.
misprint.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Accumulated counter value
Unit Number of times Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing
Default value 0 the parts
○ ○
C2 Cassette 2 pickup jam counter Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then
enter 0.
  Details To count up the number of jam occurrences in the
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Cassette 2 (option Pickup Cassette).
The counter is advanced by paper size mismatch or Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
- ○ Unit Number of sheets
misprint.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Default value 0
Unit Number of times DF-SP-RL ADF Pickup Roller parts counter
Default value 0   Details To count up the number of sheets to be fed regardless of
T-8-25
1-sided/2-sided mode.
Accumulated counter value
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing
the parts
○ ○
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then
enter 0.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets
Default value 0
T-8-26

8-33
8
Service Mode > COPIER > COUTER > DRBL-2
8 Service Mode > FEEDER > ADJUST
8-34

FEEDER DOCST2
FEEDER > ADJUST
Fine adjustment of VSYNC timing at ADF reading [back side]
  Details To make a fine adjustment of VSYNC timing when reading the back
ADJUST side of original with ADF.
Execute when the output image after ADF installation is displaced.
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value of service
FEEDER > ADJUST label.
DOCST Fine adjustment of VSYNC timing at ADF reading [front side] As the value is incremented by 1, the margin at the leading edge of
  Details To make a fine adjustment of VSYNC timing when reading the front the image is decreased by 0.1mm. (The image moves in the direction
side of original with ADF. of the leading edge of the sheet.)
Execute when the output image after ADF installation is displaced. Use case • When installing ADF
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value of service • When replacing the Main Controller PCB
label. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin at the leading edge of press OK key.
the image is decreased by 0.1mm. (The image moves in the direction
Display/adj/set range -30 to 30
of the leading edge of the sheet.)
Unit 0.1 mm
Use case • When installing ADF
Default value 0
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB
DOCST-R Fine adjustment of trailing edge at ADF reading
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.   Details To make a fine adjustment of trailing edge when reading original with
ADF.
Display/adj/set range -30 to 30
Execute when the output image after ADF installation is displaced.
Unit 0.1 mm
When replacing the Main Controller PCB, enter the value of service
Default value 0 label.
LA-SPD Fine adjustment of magnification ratio in vertical scanning direction As the value is incremented by 1, the margin at the trailing edge of
at ADF stream reading [front side] the image is decreased by 0.1mm. (The image moves in the direction
  Details To make a fine adjustment of the image magnification ratio in vertical of the trailing edge of the sheet.)
scanning direction when stream reading the front side of original with Use case • When installing ADF
ADF. • When replacing the Main Controller PCB
As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.01% in Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
vertical scanning direction. (The feeding speed increases, and the press OK key.
image is reduced.)
Display/adj/set range -30 to 30
Use case • When installing ADF
Unit 0.1 mm
• When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
LA-SPD2 Fine adjustment of magnification ratio in vertical scanning direction
Display/adj/set range -200 to 200
at ADF stream reading [back side]
Unit 0.01%
  Details To make a fine adjustment of the image magnification ratio in vertical
Default value 0 scanning direction when stream reading the back side of original with
ADF.
As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.01% in
vertical scanning direction. (The feeding speed increases, and the
image is reduced.)
Use case When replacing the Main Controller PCB
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -200 to 200
Unit 0.01%
Default value 0
T-8-27

8-34
8
Service Mode > FEEDER > ADJUST
8 Service Mode > FEEDER > FUNCTION
8-35
FUNCTION
FEEDER > FUNCTION
MTR-ON Operation check of ADF Motor
  Details To start operation check of ADF Motor (M702).
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
The unit operates for approximately 5 seconds and automatically
stops.
2) Press OK key.
The operation check is completed.
Caution Be sure to press the OK key again after execution. The operation
automatically stops after approximately 5 seconds, but is not
completed unless the OK key is pressed (STOP is not displayed).
Required time Approx. 5 seconds
FEED-ON Operation check of ADF individual feed
  Details To start operation check of the ADF individual feed in the mode
specified by FEED-CHK.
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> FEED-CHK
FEED-CHK Setting of ADF individual feed mode
  Details To set the ADF feed mode.
Feed operation is activated in the specified feed mode by executing
FEED-ON.
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: 1-sided, 1: 2-sided
Default value 0
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> FEED-ON
T-8-28

8-35
8
Service Mode > FEEDER > FUNCTION
8 Service Mode > FAX > List of SSSW
8-36

FAX FAX > SSSW M82 M85


SSSW No. Bit No. Function
SW 05 (Switch relating to standard functions and DIS signal settings)
List of SSSW Bit 0 - - -
Bit 1 mm/inch conversion (text mode) - -
FAX > SSSW M82 M85 Bit 2 mm/inch conversion (text/photo mode / photo mode) ○ ○
SSSW No. Bit No. Function Bit 3 Prohibition of bit transmission after DIS bit 33 ○ ○
SW 01 (Switch relating to error and copy) Bit 4 Declaration of cut paper ○ ○
Bit 0 Output of error code for service technician ○ ○ Bit 5 Declaration of LTR/LGL by DIS - -
Bit 1 Error memory dump ○ ○ Bit 6 Prohibition of ECM transmission - -
Bit 2 Entry of password at transfer of confidential received image - - Bit 7 Prohibition of ECM reception - -
Bit 3 Prohibition of copy - - SW 06 (Switch relating to settings for reading condition)
Bit 4 - - - Bit 0 Shifting from DES to pre-scan position - -
Bit 5 - - - Bit 1 Pre-scan at times other than power-on - -
Bit 6 Prohibition of date/time settings by user - - Bit 2 Limitation on original length - -
Bit 7 Batch cancellation of prohibition of user setting - - Bit 3 Stamp option - -
SW 02 (Switch relating to settings for network connection condition) Bit 4 Scan width 0: A4, 1: LTR ○ ○
Bit 0 Prohibition of startup when memory clear list cannot be output - - Bit 5 Recording by dividing data into multiple files at the time of
- -
memory copy
Bit 1 - - -
Bit 6 Variability of resolution at the time of copy - -
Bit 2 - - -
Bit 7 Halftone + Super fine - -
Bit 3 - - -
SW 07 - SW 11 Not in use
Bit 4 V34 CCRTN OFF - -
SW 12 (Switch relating to settings for page timer)
Bit 5 - - -
Bit 0 Timeout period for 1 page (transmission) ○ ○
Bit 6 - - -
Bit 1 Timeout period for 1 page (transmission) ○ ○
Bit 7 Connect the terminal as F network type 2 ○ ○
Bit 2 Timeout period for 1 page (Halftone transmission) ○ ○
SW 03 (Switch relating to echo prevention)
Bit 3 Timeout period for 1 page (Halftone transmission) ○ ○
Bit 0 TCF EQM check ○ ○
Bit 4 Timeout period for 1 page (Reception) ○ ○
Bit 1 - - -
Bit 5 Timeout period for 1 page (Reception) ○ ○
Bit 2 - - -
Bit 6 - - -
Bit 3 - - -
Bit 7 Timeout period for 1 page ○ ○
Bit 4 - - -
SW 13
Bit 5 - - -
Bit 0 Prohibition of relay broadcasting/forwarding at the time of
Bit 6 - - - - -
relay/forwarding reception
Bit 7 Output 1080Hz before CED ○ ○
Bit 1 Response in case of image failure at the time of relay/
SW 04 (Switch relating to prevention of communication problems) - -
forwarding reception
Bit 0 Monitoring of LC - -
Bit 2 Execution of mm/inch conversion when sending the received
Bit 1 Frequency check of CI signal ○ ○ ○ ○
image
Bit 2 V.21 end flag - - Bit 3 - - -
Bit 3 Prohibit T.30 node F kept by both parties ○ ○ Bit 4 - - -
Bit 4 T.30 node F echo timer ○ ○ Bit 5 - - -
Bit 5 Frequency check of CI signal at PBX settings ○ ○ Bit 6 - - -
Bit 6 No CNG transmission at the time of manual transmission ○ ○ Bit 7 - - -
Bit 7 No CED transmission at the time of manual transmission ○ ○

8-36
8
Service Mode > FAX > List of SSSW
8 Service Mode > FAX > List of SSSW
8-37
FAX > SSSW M82 M85 FAX > SSSW M82 M85
SSSW No. Bit No. Function SSSW No. Bit No. Function
SW 14 SW 25 (Setting for report display function)
Bit 0 - - - Bit 0 Prioritize the received abbreviated name to the dialed
○ ○
Bit 1 - - - abbreviated name
Bit 2 Setting whether to execute inch to mm conversion in horizontal Bit 1 - - -
and vertical scanning directions or in vertical scanning ○ ○ Bit 2 - - -
direction only Bit 3 - - -
Bit 3 Execution of inch to mm conversion only when performing Bit 4 - - -
- -
OCR transmission Bit 5 - - -
Bit 4 Declaration of inch-configuration resolution ○ ○ Bit 6 - - -
Bit 5 - - - Bit 7 - - -
Bit 6 - - - SW 26 - SW 27 Not in use
Bit 7 - - - SW 28
SW 15 Bit 0 Prohibit calling party for V8 procedure ○ ○
Bit 0 - - - Bit 1 Prohibit called party from V8 procedure ○ ○
Bit 1 - - - Bit 2 Prohibit calling party from V8 late-start ○ ○
Bit 2 Acceptance of reception of a line with caller ID: the machine Bit 3 Prohibit called party from V8 late-start ○ ○
- -
line Bit 4 Prohibit V.34 called party from starting fallback ○ ○
Bit 3 - - - Bit 5 Prohibit V.34 calling party from starting fallback ○ ○
Bit 4 - - - Bit 6 - - -
Bit 5 - - - Bit 7 - - -
Bit 6 Detection of sequential signal at FAX/TEL switching - - SW 29 - SW 35 Not in use
Bit 7 - - - T-8-29
SW 16 - SW 17 Not in use
SW 18
Bit 0 Detection of carrier disconnection between DCS and TCF ○ ○
Bit 1 Time to wait for carrier disconnection between DCS and TCF ○ ○
Bit 2 Prohibition of communication control for IP network ○ ○
Bit 3 - - -
Bit 4 - - -
Bit 5 - - -
Bit 6 - - -
Bit 7 - - -
SW 19 - SW 21 Not in use
SW 22
Bit 0 Prohibition of NSX transmission - -
Bit 1 Prohibition of recording by splitting data into A4 - -
Bit 2 Prohibition of sequential broadcast - -
Bit 3 Prohibition of manual polling operation ○ ○
Bit 4 Prohibition of manual transmission at archive transmission - -
Bit 5 - - -
Bit 6 Archive transmission function available - -
Bit 7 - - -
SW 23 - SW 24 Not in use

8-37
8
Service Mode > FAX > List of SSSW
8 Service Mode > FAX > List of NUM
8-38
List of MENU List of NUM
Menu switch registration mode M82 M85 Numeric parameter setting mode M82 M85
No. Parameter Selection No. Parameter Allowable setting range
01 - 04 Not in use - - 01 Not in use - -
05 - - - - 02 RTN transmission criteria X 1 to 99 % ○ ○
06 Telephone line monitor 0-3 03 RTN transmission criteria n 2 to 99 times ○ ○
0: DIAL, 1: SERVICEMAN1, 2: ○ ○ 04 RTN transmission criteria m 1 to 99 lines ○ ○
SERVICEMAN2, 3: OFF 05 NCC pause (before ID code) 1 to 60 sec ○ ○
07 Transmission level (ATT) 0 - 15 ○ ○ 06 NCC pause (after ID code) 1 to 60 sec ○ ○
08 Upper limit of V.34 modulation speed 0 - 5 07 Spare - -
0: 3429 BAUD, 1: 3200 BAUD, 2: 3000 08 STORED_DIAL_MODE wait timer 0 to 65 sec ○ ○
○ ○
BAUD, 3: 2800 BAUD, 4: 2743 BAUD, 5: 09 Not in use - -
2400 BAUD
10 T.30 T0 timer 55 sec principally ○ ○
09 Upper limit of V.34 data speed 0-13
11 T.30 T1 timer (for incoming transmission) 0 to 9999
0: 33.6 kbps, 1: 31.2 kbps, 2: 28.8 kbps, 3:
(France: 3500, Others: ○ ○
26.4 kbps, 4: 24.0 kbps, 5: 21.6 kbps, 6:
○ ○ 3000)
19.2 kbps, 7: 16.8 kbps, 8: 14.4 kbps, 9:
12 Maximum incoming lines 0 to 65535 (line)
12.0 kbps, 10: 9.6 kbps, 11: 7.2 kbps, 12: ○ ○
0: without limitation
4.8 kbps, 13: 2.4 kbps
13 T.30 EOL timer 500 to 3000
10 OFF Hook signal frequency 0-2 ○ ○
○ ○ (set to 55 sec by default)
0: 50 Hz, 1: 25 Hz, 2: 17 Hz
14 Not in use - -
11 - 20 Not in use - -
15 Threshold between hokking nad on-hook 0 to 999 ○ ○
T-8-30
16 Lead time to the first response when switching 0 to 9
○ ○
between FAX and TEL
17 Duration to activate pseudo-RBT cadence 0 to 999 ○ ○
18 Duration to deactivate pseudo-RBT cadence (short) 0 to 999 ○ ○
19 Duration to deactivate pseudo-RBT cadence (long) 0 to 999 ○ ○
20 Duration to activate pseudo-ring cadence 0 to 999 ○ ○
21 Duration to deactivate OFF Hook cadence (short) 0 to 999 ○ ○
22 Duration to deactivate OFF Hook cadence (long) 0 to 7 ○ ○
23 - - - -
24 - - - -
25 CNG monitor duration while the answering device is 0 to 999
○ ○
activated
26 - - - -
27 - - - -
28 Not in use - -
29 Off-hook PCB duty settings 20 (*10ms)
(For NAC, setting can be made with SPL71100 in ○ ○
special management mode.)
30 - 48 Not in use - -
49 NSX MODEL ID 0 to 4095 ○ ○
50 Not in use - -
51 Threshold to detect hook 10 to 9999 ○ ○
52 Not in use - -

8-38
8
Service Mode > FAX > List of NUM
8 Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > TONE/PULSE
8-39
Numeric parameter setting mode M82 M85 Setting of NCU Parameters
No. Parameter Allowable setting range
53 Set DTMF calling counts when receiving FAX 10 to 9999 (default 25)
○ ○ ■■TONE/PULSE
remotely
54 Set Busy Tone outgoing duration when using handset ○ ○ Operation Method
55 - 80 Not in use - - 1) Setting of Tone Parameters
T-8-31
While "#NCU" is displayed, press "OK" key -> Select "#TONE" and press "OK" key so that
it becomes tone parameter setting mode.
2) Setting of Pulse Parameters
While "#NCU" is displayed, press "OK" key -> Select "#PULSE" and press "OK" key so that
it becomes pulse parameter setting mode.

Item Function Setting range M82 M85


TONE 01; Tone signal sending time 10 to 9999 (msec)
○ ○
(PSTN)
02; Minimum pause time (PSTN) 10 to 9999 (msec) ○ ○
PULSE PULSE FORM Pulse digit format 0 -> DP (N)
1 -> DP (N+1) ○ ○
2 -> DP (10-N)
PULSE NUM 01; - - - -
02; - - - -
03; Pulse dial make ratio 10 to 90 (%) ○ ○
04; Minimum pause time 10 to 9999 (msec) ○ ○
T-8-32

8-39
8
Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > TONE/PULSE
8 Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > BUSY TONE 0
8-40
■■DIAL TONE ■■BUSY TONE 0
●● Bit Switch ●● Bit Switch
Bit No. Function 1 0 M82 M85 Bit No. Function 1 0 M82 M85
Bit 0 Frequency detection method Modem Tonal counter - - Bit 0 - - - - -
Bit 1 Cadence pattern check Not detected Detected ○ ○ Bit 1 - - - - -
Bit 2 Signal frequency Changed Not changed ○ ○ Bit 2 Signal frequency Changed Not changed - -
Bit 3 - - - - - Bit 3 - - - - -
Bit 4 Judgment of intermittent start from valid ON start from either valid Bit 4 Judgment of intermittent start from valid ON start from either valid
○ ○ - -
signal signal ON signal or OFF signal signal signal ON signal or OFF signal
Bit 5 - - - - - Bit 5 - - - - -
Bit 6 Signal form Continuous Intermittent ○ ○ Bit 6 Signal form Continuous Intermittent - -
Bit 7 Signal detection Detected Not detected ○ ○ Bit 7 Signal detection Detected Not detected ○ ○
T-8-33 T-8-35

●● Numeric value parameter ●● Numeric value parameter


Parameter No. Function Setting range M82 M85 Not in use
01; T0 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
02; T1 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
03; T2 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
04; T3 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
05; T4 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
06; Signal detection table 0 to 16 ○ ○
07; Signal detection level 0 to 7 ○ ○
08; Number of signal frequency 0 to 9999 ○ ○
T-8-34

■■2nd DIAL TONE


Not in use

8-40
8
Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > BUSY TONE 0
8 Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > MULTI
8-41
■■BUSY TONE 1 ■■REORDER TONE
●● Bit Switch ●● Bit Switch
Bit No. Function 1 0 M82 M85 Bit No. Function 1 0 M82 M85
Bit 0 - - - - - Bit 0 - - - - -
Bit 1 - - - - - Bit 1 Signal detection method FED FR3 - -
Bit 2 Signal frequency Changed Not changed - - Bit 2 Signal frequency Changed Not changed - -
Bit 3 RBT signal detection Yes No - - Bit 3 - - - - -
Bit 4 Judgment of intermittent Start from valid ON Start from either valid Bit 4 Judgment of intermittent start from valid ON start from either valid
- - - -
signal signal ON signal or OFF signal signal signal ON signal or OFF signal
Bit 5 RBT signal check cycle 1 cycle 1/2 cycle - - Bit 5 - - - - -
Bit 6 Signal form Continuous Intermittent - - Bit 6 Signal form Continuous Intermittent - -
Bit 7 Signal detection Detected Not detected ○ ○ Bit 7 Signal detection Detected Not detected ○ ○
T-8-36 T-8-38

●● Numeric value parameter ●● Numeric value parameter


Parameter No. Function Setting range M82 M85 Parameter No. Function Setting range M82 M85
01; - - - - 01; - - - -
02; T1 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 02; T1 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
03; T2 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 03; T2 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
04; T3 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 04; T3 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
05; T4 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 05; T4 timer 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
06; Signal detection table 0 to 16 ○ ○ 06; Signal detection table 0 to 16 ○ ○
07; Signal detection level 0 to 7 ○ ○ 07; Signal detection level 0 to 7 ○ ○
08; Number of signal frequency 0 to 9999 ○ ○ 08; Number of signal frequency 0 to 9999 ○ ○
T-8-37 T-8-39

■■MULTI
Not in use

8-41
8
Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > MULTI
8 Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > DAM
8-42
■■AUTO RX ■■RKEY
●● Numeric value parameter ●● Numeric value parameter
Parameter No. Function Setting range M82 M85 Parameter No. Function Setting range M82 M85
01; CI ON time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 01; Connection time of flash 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
02; CI LONG ON time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 02; Connection time of grounding wire 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
03; CI OFF time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ 03; - - - -
04; CI LONG OFF time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ T-8-42
05; CI MAX OFF time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
06; CI WAIT time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
07; CI frequency 0 to 9999 (cycle) ○ ○ ■■PBX DIAL TONE 1
08; CI frequency lower limit 0 to 9999 (Hz) ○ ○
Not in use
09; CI frequency upper limit 0 to 9999 (Hz) ○ ○
T-8-40

■■CNG DETECT ■■PBX BUSY TONE


Not in use
●● Numeric value parameter
Parameter No. Description Setting range M82 M85
01; At F/T switching CNG mIN ON time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
02; CNG mAX ON time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ ■■FTSW OGM
03; Tolerable time of 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) Not in use
instantaneous - -
interruption
04; CNG OFF time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) - -
05; Number of detection 0 to 9999 (times) - -
■■DAM
06; Hit ratio 0 to 9999 (%) - -
07; At direct connecting to CNG MIN ON time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○ Not in use
08; answering phone CNG MAX ON time 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec) ○ ○
09; Tolerable time of 0 to 9999 (x 10 msec)
instantaneous ○ ○
interruption
10; - - - -
11; Number of detection 0 to 9999 (times) ○ ○
12; Hit ratio 0 to 9999 (%) ○ ○
T-8-41

8-42
8
Service Mode > FAX > Setting of NCU Parameters > DAM
8 Service Mode > TESTMODE > PRINT
8-43

TESTMODE THRU
TESTMODE > PRINT
Setting of image correction table at test print
M82 M85

  Details It is possible to check the density characteristics due to


PRINT the density correction process when normal gamma LUT
is used, and the density characteristics of the engine
when the linear gamma LUT is used.
TESTMODE > PRINT M82 M85
Use case At trouble analysis ○ ○
PG-TYPE Setting of PG number
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
  Details To set the PG number of the test print.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Use case At trouble analysis 0: Normal gamma LUT, 1: Through (linear) gamma LUT
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 6 Supplement/memo Gamma LUT: Density gradation characteristic table
0: Full correction chart 1
NRKE ON/OFF of laser scanning transfer process of test print
1: Full correction chart 2 ○ ○
  Details To perform line transfer process for skew correction of
2: Color chart
test print engine's laser scanning.
3: Color displacement correction chart
4: Rainbow chart (vertical scanning direction) Use case At trouble analysis
5: Rainbow chart (horizontal scanning direction) Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
○ ○
6: Grid Bk Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: OFF, 1: ON
COUNT Setting of PG output quantity Default value 0
  Details To set the number of sheets for PG output. Supplement/memo Transfer process: A process to correct skew of laser
Use case At trouble analysis scanning in vertical scanning direction
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○ BLND ON/OFF of interpolation process at test print
Display/adj/set range 1 to 99   Details To set ON/OFF of interpolation process at test print (linked
with NSC).
Unit 1 sheet
When 1 is set, interpolation process is performed (no
Default value 1
phase shift).
PHASE Setting of PG 2-sided mode
Use case At trouble analysis
  Details To set 1-sided/2-sided print for PG output.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ○ ○
Even if 2-sided print is set for a machine that only
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
supports 1-sided print, the setting is disabled.
0: OFF, 1: ON
Use case At trouble analysis ○
Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo Interpolation process: A process to predict, for pixels
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
holding no color information, color based on the
0: 1-sided, 1: 2-sided
surrounding pixels, and then set up the color information.
Default value 0
FEED Setting of paper source at test print
MODE Setting of test print image formation method
  Details To set the paper sources at the time of test print output.
  Details To set the image formation method for the test print. If this mode is set when there is no Cassette 2 (option
If PG-TYPE is 0/1, this setting is disabled because a Pickup Cassette), output is from Cassette 1 (standard
specific image formation method is applied. Pickup Cassette).
Use case At trouble analysis If color paper is loaded in the specified paper source,
○ ○ ○ ○
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. there is no output because the setting is disabled.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Use case When outputting a test print
0: T-MIC (T-MIC), 1: High screen ruling (SCA), 2: Low Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
screen ruling (SCB), 3: TBIC Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Default value 0 0: Multi-purpose Tray, 1: Cassette 1, 2: Cassette 2
Default value 1

8-43
8
Service Mode > TESTMODE > PRINT
8 Service Mode > TESTMODE > FAX > MODEM
8-44
TESTMODE > PRINT M82 M85 TESTMODE > FAX > MODEM M82 M85
START Output of test print FREQ Frequency test
  Details To output a test print with the PG pattern set in PG-TYPE,   Details To test whether the specified frequency is oscillated.
MODE, etc. ○ ○ By closing or opening the DC circuit in accordance with
Use case At trouble analysis the setting value, the specified frequency is oscillated by
Adj/set/operate method Press OK key. the tone transmission function of the modem.
T-8-43 Check this with the speaker.
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem ▲ ▲
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
FAX Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 7
■■MODEM 0: OFF, 1: 462 Hz, 2: 1100 Hz, 3: 1300 Hz, 4: 1500 Hz, 5:
1650 Hz, 6: 1850 Hz, 7: 2100 Hz
TESTMODE > FAX > MODEM M82 M85 Default value 0
RELAY-1 NCU relay test 1 G3TX G3 signal transmission test
  Details To test ON/OFF of relay and port switch of NCU.   Details To test whether the specified G3 signal is transmitted.
This mode is disabled for an NCU with no relay and port By closing or opening the DC circuit in accordance
switch. with the setting value, the specific G3 signal pattern is
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem transmitted at the specified transmission speed by the G3
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. signal transmission function of the modem.
▲ ▲
Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. Check this with the speaker.
▲ ▲
Display/adj/set range 0 to 6 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: All OFF, 1: CML ON/OFF, 2: P ON/OFF, 3: S ON/OFF, 4: Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test.
H ON/OFF, 5: HD ON/OFF, 6: R ON/OFF Display/adj/set range 0 to 9
Default value 0 0: OFF, 1: 300 bps, 2: 2400 bps, 3: 4800 bps, 4: 7200
Related service mode TESTMODE> FAX> MODEM> RELAY-2 bps, 5: 9600 bps, 6: TC7200 bps, 7: TC9600 bps, 8:
RELAY-2 NCU relay test 2 12000 bps, 9: 14400 bps
  Details To test ON/OFF of relay and port switch of NCU. Default value 0
This mode is disabled for an NCU with no relay and port DTMFTX DTMF transmission test
switch.   Details To test whether the specified DTMF signal is transmitted.
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem By closing or opening the DC circuit in accordance with
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. the setting value, the specified DTMF signal is transmitted
Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. ▲ ▲ by the DTMF transmission function of the modem.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 7 Check this with the speaker.
0: All OFF, 1: CIST2 ON/OFF, 2: C1 ON/OFF, 3: NORG Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
ON/OFF, 4: DCSEL ON/OFF, 5: DCLIM ON/OFF, 6: Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. ▲ ▲
IPSEL1 ON/OFF, 7: IPSEL2 ON/OFF Display/adj/set range 0 to 12
Default value 0 0: OFF, 1: 1, 2: 2, 3: 3, 4: 4, 5: 5, 6: 6, 7: 7, 8: 8, 9: 9, 10: 0,
Related service mode TESTMODE> FAX> MODEM> RELAY-1 11: *, 12: #
Default value 0
Supplement/memo DTMF (Dual Tone Multi Frequency): Signal method
combining two specific frequencies like a push-tone
phone.

8-44
8
Service Mode > TESTMODE > FAX > MODEM
8 Service Mode > TESTMODE > FAX > FACULTY
8-45
TESTMODE > FAX > MODEM M82 M85 TESTMODE > PRINT M82 M85
V34G3TX V.34 G3 signal transmission test DETECT1 Ring detection
  Details To test whether the specified V.34 G3 signal is   Details To check the ON/OFF state of CI, FC, and hook from the
transmitted. line.
By closing or opening the DC circuit in accordance The detection results are displayed on the console
with the setting value, the specific G3 signal pattern (UART).
is transmitted at the specified transmission speed and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
modulation speed by the G3 signal transmission function Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. ▲ ▲
(V.34) of the modem. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Check this with the speaker. 0: OFF, 1: ON
A setting value other than 0 is indicated as a 3-digit Default value 0
integer (1st digit: modulation speed, last 2 digits:
Supplement/memo CI (Calling Identification): Ring signal
transmission speed). A value other than the specified
UART (Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter):
numerical value is invalid.
▲ ▲ Console
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
DETECT2 Calling tone detection test 1
Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test.
  Details To check calling tone signal and FED.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 614 Set the CML relay to ON and detect the calling tone.
0: OFF The detection results are displayed on the console
• First digit (Modulation speed/baud rate) (UART).
1: 2400 baud, 2: 2743 baud, 3: 2800 baud, 4: 3000
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
baud, 5: 3200 baud, 6: 3429 baud
Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. ▲ ▲
• Last 2 digits (Transmission speed)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
01: 2400 bps, 02: 4800 bps, 03: 7200 bps, 04: 9600
0: OFF, 1: ON
bps, 05: 12000 bps, 06: 14400 bps, 07: 16800 bps, 08:
19200 bps, 09: 21600 bps, 10: 24000 bps, 11: 26400 Default value 0
bps, 12: 28800 bps, 13: 31200 bps, 14: 33600 bps Supplement/memo CML (Connect Modem to Line) relay: Relay installed at
Default value 0 the NCU (Network Control Unit) Board to switch between
the telephone and fax.
T-8-44
DETECT3 Calling tone detection test 2
■■FACULTY   Details To check calling tone signal and FED.
Set the CML relay to OFF and detect the calling tone.
TESTMODE > PRINT M82 M85 The detection results are displayed on the console
G34800TX G3 4800 bps signal transmission test (UART).
  Details To test whether the G3 signal is transmitted at 4800 bps. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
By closing or opening the DC circuit, the specific G3 Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. ▲ ▲
signal pattern is transmitted at 4800 bps by the G3 signal Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
transmission function. 0: OFF, 1: ON
Check this with the speaker. ▲ ▲ Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo CML (Connect Modem to Line) relay: Relay installed at
Caution Be sure to set the value back to 0 after the test. the NCU (Network Control Unit) Board to switch between
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 the telephone and fax.
0: OFF, 1: ON
T-8-45
Default value 0

8-45
8
Service Mode > TESTMODE > FAX > FACULTY
Appendex

■Special Tools

■Solvents and Oils

■General Circuit Diagram

■Backup Data
Appendex > Service Tools > Solvents and Oils
II

Service Tools

Special Tools
In addition to the standard tools set, the following special tools are required when servicing
the machine:

Name of Tool Parts.No Use


Digital Multimeter FY9-2002 Used as a probe extension when making electrical checks.

F-9-1 T-9-1

Solvents and Oils


The table below lists the standard tools required in service works for this product.

No. Name of Tool Use Remarks


1 Alcohol Cleaning: • Keep away from flame
Plastic • Purchase locally
Rubber
Metal part
Oil stain
Toner stain
2 Lubricant Apply to gear • HY9-0007 (MOLYCOTE EM-50L)

3 Lubricant Apply to ADF scanning area • FY9-6020(Oil glass cleaner)

T-9-2

II
Appendex > Service Tools > Solvents and Oils
III

General Circuit Diagram

General Circuit Diagram (MF8500)


Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8500) > MF8500 (1/3)

Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8500) > MF8500 (1/3)
■■MF8500 (1/3)
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

VIN M7 Laser Scanner Unit

1
VSS1
Laser Scanner

2
VIN
J3011
Motor

3
VSS2
J1002 UN3 SR4
REGS RDSDR

17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
4

8
1
VIN

3
SGND RDSSR

J163
High Voltage Power Supply PCB UN4 J501

7
2
VSS3

2
M
Registration Detection +3LED RDSGAIN0
F F

6
J601
3

1
Laser Driver PCB 25
PCB29
VIN RDSGAIN1
Sensor

5
VSS4 1 2 3 4
RDSLED
J1001

4
J2007 J501_BUS[0:25] +3.3V Patch Sensor

S47

3
S42

S41

S44

S43

S46

S45

S48
J1001_BUS[0:31] SGND
W

W
R

2
+24VA

J161

1
1

10

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

21

22

23

24

25
11
J3010 ITBLLED

10

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

21

22

23

24

25

26

/DOPEN 27
4 PEXPON12328

PEXPON4 29
30

31
21 TR2PWM 11

4
SR7
HLDR1 HLDR2 HLDR3 HLDR4 MPTPREGS RSLED

29 PGND(HVT)

28 PGND(HVT)

+3.3V4A

8
27 HVDACLK

23HVOUTEN

J162
1
25 HVDATA1

+3.3V3A

+3.3V2A

+3.3V1A
+3.3V

3
24 HVDALD

GND4A

GND2A

GND1A
20 DEVCLK

/TGEN1
/TGEN2
/TGEN3
/TGEN4
22 TR2CLK
SGND

31+24V(HVT)

30+24V(HVT)

CNT41
CNT40

GND3A
13ICLRSNS

12ICLBSNS

SGND

CNT10
CNT11
VDO3

VDO2
/VDO4

/VDO3

/VDO2

/VDO1

7
CNT30
CNT31

CNT20
CNT21
MP Tray Pre-Registration

TGRD
TGSD

VDO4

VDO1

2
+3.3V
TNR1
TNR2
TNR3
TNR4
26 SGND

2
TR1S
TR2S
J11 J12 J13 J14 +3LED RSSR

/BDI

6
3
Detection Sensor

9
RBLSGAIN0

/SCNDEC
/SCNACC

8
RBLSGAIN1

25

24

23

22

21

20

19

18

17

16

15

14

13

12

11

10
+24VA

4
PGND
19

18

17

16

15

14

10
11
SGND

7
1 ITBTS 1

1
PCB30

3
+24VA

6
2 MPTPS 2

J611
2
J133_BUS[0:31] J1131_BUS[0:25]

5
3 RDSDR 3
Patch

J160
ITBLS

4
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1 4 RDSSR 4
31 25 Registration
UN13

3
J132 J110 J111 5 RDSGAIN0 5

UN1 Sensor

J160_BUS[0:25]

2
6 RDSGAIN1 6
E E
J133 J131
Main Controller PCB

1
7 RDSLED 7

J914 J915 J929


DC Controller PCB SGND

UN5
8 8
J151 J154 J150 J157 J153
9
ITBLLED 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 4 3 2 1

MF8540Cdn Model 10
RSLED 10 Relay PCB

SGND
PFULLS
+3LED
POUTS
FSRPRSS
LOOPS

SGND

SGND
SUB2TH

ENVSDA

ENVSCL
+3.3V

PGND(HVT)
+24V(HVT)
PGND

+24V
PGND
+24V
PSREM24V
RLD+
RLD-
FSRD
ZEROX
+3.3VOFF
SWOFF
+3.3V
+3.3V
SGND
SGND

DEVSL

3.3V
11 11

+24VA
+3LED
SR1
A1

J393

3
RSSR
2

12 12

J164
SGND

MAINTH
/MANUAL_RST

RBLSGAIN0 13

SUBTH

2
1

13
Paper Feeder

SGND

SGND
OPTPREGS

J141_BUS[0:25]
RBLSGAIN1 14

1
J4001DH
2

14
2

2 1 J4001D Pre-Registration
FM0-3916

SGND
+24S_ON

1 2 3 4
SL3
DCC_ON

J392 15 15 J3002
1

SL
J3015 16 ITBLS 16 Detection Sensor
+3.3V
+3.3V

PCB28
1

B3

J3003
Developing Separation
+24V

4 3 2 1
GND
GND

GND

GND

+24VA
1

SW1 Solenoid
1 2 3 4
17 17 +3LED
2

SR12

1
Environment Sensor

3
18 FDOORS 18 SGND
Main Power Switch J4001L
3

2
19 DEVHPS 19

J141

25
PREGS

J165
Pre-registration

3
J393B

1
20 CSTPS 20
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1
Detection Sensor

4
21 PREGS 21

3
J707 J706 +3LED

J708
J351 J352 J1391LB J1391L J361 J362
SR13

3
REGS
UN6
22 22

2
SGND

6
D D

2
23 OPTPREGS23

PFULLS
Cassette Paper

1
CSTPS
Fixing Relay PCB

+3LED

1
+3LED

SGND
24 24

2 1 J709 J710 25 MPTPREGS 25 J3004 Detection Sensor


1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

UN9 TH802 SR14

1
J3001

+3LED
SGND
POUTS
+3LED
SGND
FSRPRSS
+3LED
SGND
LOOPS
J4003MB 220V
Low Voltage Sub PCB Sub MP Tray +3LED
H220 SR6

3
3 2 1
FU LIVE
Paper Detection SGND

1
Thermistor 1

2
Fixing Heater

2
Developing
J364
J363

1 2
Sensor DEVHPS

J166
3

1
FU NEUTRAL

1
TB1B TB2B
J4018 +3LED
Homeposition Sensor

4
J1301B J3006 MPTPS
FU1B
SR15
2 1 2 1 SGND

1
J388 J387 J386 J386B

6
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1

5
SGND

TH801 TH803 FDOORS


SR2

3
2
Delivery Full

6
J167
1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 1 2 3 +3LED
FUSER_AC

2
1

4
Front Cover Sensor
PGND

120V Main Sub Sensor


24VD

J3014 J3013 J3012 ITBTS

1
P_GND

3
H120 SR8 SR9 SR10
SGND
+24V

FU LIVE
Thermistor Thermistor 2

3
1

2
+3LED J3005

2
FU NEUTRAL
Fixing Heater

2
1 2
Fixing Delivery Fixing Fixing Loop

2
2

1
1
TB1A

1
TB2A

3
COR6 FU1A Sensor Pressure Sensor J3009
J4017D
J1301A
Release Sensor

2
J4003MA J4017L J4017DH
C Fixing Assembly C
SR16
1 2

1 2 J4003F
FU NEUTRAL +24V
ITB Pressure

1
1

3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1

J654
Release Sensor

J156
SGND
FU LIVE

J651
J383

2
2

2
J381B UN7 SUBRLD

3
3

1
J384
J385

J140
Fixing Sub PCB
J381
J382

J382B J152

J653
2
31
AWG16

1 2 3 4 5 6
J4004LA

1
J4004L
UN8 MAIN_SW
J6002
FM2
H 1
AWG18
1

SOLD3
1 J140_BUS[0:31]
J301

7
FACH
INLET

2 SOLD6
J311 2
1
2

3 SOLD4 N
Low Voltage Main PCB FACL
6
3 UN11
FEEDMI3 31 Duplex Feeding Fan
3

J312 COR3 31
FEEDMB
MT301

+24VA 5 30
Paper Feeder
2

+24VA
7
4
7

COR2 S4 30
FEEDMI2
PGND 4 SGND 29
1

5
OPTPS 3 6
OPTPS
S3
Relay PCB 29
FEEDMI1 28
321
S2 28
OPTPKSL 2 OPTPKSL J1202 J1203 FEEDMA 27
7 S1 27
1 2 1 2 3 FEEDMI0

DUPFANLCK
J4003DA_BUS[0:7] 1 26
J4003LB_BUS[0:7]

DUPFANON
26
J4004D REGIMI3 25

OPTPKSL

+3LED

OPTPS
+24VA

SGND
B B
2 1
J4004DA 25
REGIMI1 24
J210 24

PGND
REGIMI2
UN2
1 2 3 4
23
23
REGIMB

PGND
J201

DUPSWBKCL
DUPSWBKSL
DUPFANON
22

+24VA
DUPFANLK
Driver PCB J213 SL J3007 3 2 1
22
REGIMA 21
21 3 2 1
REGIMI0 20

SL6
J205 J211 J204 J206 J208 J207 J209 J202 J203 20 J705
FANPWM 19

SR3
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 3 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 19
Paper Feeder
CSTPKSL
SL5

J703
18 DUPSWBKSL

2
18

SL
FANLK
/DRMMACC
/DRMMDEC

Paper Feeder
FEEDMBNO
FEEDMB
FEEDMANO
FEEDMA
/DEVMACC
/DEVMDEC

+24VA
/FSRMDEC
/FSRMACC

MPTPKSL

17
DRMMREV

Pickup Solenoid Duplex Reversal Solenoid


CSTPKSL
MPTCLCH
FANPWM
FSRMREV

REGIPHB
REGIPHBNO
REGIPHANO
REGIPHA
+24VA

+24VA

+24VA

1
17
DRMMFG

FANLCK

FSRMFG
DEVMFG
FSRMFG

Paper Detection 16
16
PGND

/FSRMDEC
+24VA

+24VA
+24VA

+24VA
+24VA
PGND

PGND
PGND

PGND
PGND

15
Sensor CL2

J704
15
/FSRMACC DUPSWBKCL
14

CL
2
14 +24VA
J201_BUS[0:31]
FSRMREV 13 Duplex Feeding Clutch

1
321 13
MPTPKSL 12
6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12
MPTCLCH 11
CL SL J2004 J2005
SL 11
OPTPKSL
J2001 J2002 J2003 10

SL2 SL1
10
FM1 CL1
4 3 2 1
UN10
4 3 2 1 OPTPS 9 6 5 4 3 2 1
9
M M M DRMMREV J701
A Fixing MP Tray Cassette Pickup MP Tray Pickup M M
8
/DRMMACC
8
Duplex Driver PCB A
7
/Fixing Power Supply Feeding Clutch Solenoid Solenoid
M4 M1 M2
7
/DRMMDEC 6
6

Fixing Motor Drum Motor Developing Motor Cooling Fan M5 M3 5


DRMMFG 5
/DEVMACC 4
Pickup Motor Registration Motor 4
/DEVMDEC 3
3
DEVMFG 2
2
SGND 1
1

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

P.1
F-9-2

III
IV

■■MF8500 (2/3)
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8500) > MF8500 (2/3)

Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8500) > MF8500 (2/3)
MF8580Cdw Model
F F
USB-Memory UN1
CIS Unit
DC Controller PCB
J9710 1 VBUS1
DM
UN15 J130 J409

J971
2 2

UN23 2 4 6 8 10 12 14

4
3 DP 3
USB Host PCB 23 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15
Wireless LAN PCB J9710_BUS[0:4]
GND 4
4
J971_BUS[0:4]
J972 J107_BUS[0:23]
J1005
6 5 4 3 2 1

17

23

22

21

20

19

18

17

16

15

14

13

12

11

10

1
MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn J1005_BUS[0:17]
Model

SOLD12
SP1

10

12

13

14

15

16

17
11

Y
WH
Speaker

PK
Y
Y
E SOLD10
E
SOLD9

+3.3_AFEA
1

CISMODE
CISOUTO
CISOUT2

CISOUT1

+12_LED

G_CTHD
R_CTHD
B_CTHD
CISCLK
RESET

CISSP
DATA1

DATA3

DATA0

DATA2

VREF
CMD
GND

GND

GND

LINK

GND

GND

GND

GND
VDD

VDD
CLK
N.C

N.C

N.C

SOLD11

/VDOEN

ENGON
/CCRT

/VDO4

/VDO3

/VDO2

/VDO1
SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND
VDO4

VDO3

VDO2

VDO1
SCLK

/BDO
/TOP

N.C.

N.C.
+5V_USB

SC
Y
H_DM
H_DP
GND

GND

23

22

21

20

19

18

17

16

15

14

13

12

11

10
10

12

13

14

15

16

17
11

1
1

9
J910_BUS[0:17] J6_BUS[0:23]

17 23 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15

D D
1 2 1 2 3 4 5 2 4 6 8 10 12 14
J922 J910 J908 J912 J901

UN13
Main Controller PCB

J918 J921 J909 J911 J904L J903L (J903LH) J902L


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3
19 4 8 MT31
MT21
J918_BUS[0:19] J909_BUS[0:4] J911_BUS[0:8]

COR5
1

/MODEM_DCD2
3

MODEM_ESC 5
6

/MODEM_RTS 7
8

10

/MODEM_CI112
/MODEM_CI213
/INT_MODEM14
15

16

17

18

19
11

C C

8
/MODEM_CTS

/BOOK_B

/BOOK_A
BOOK_B

BOOK_A
MODEM_RX
MODEM_TX

MONI_OUT

+3.3V
/RST_FAX

GND
HPS
J1401D

USB Device
/HOOK

J1402D
GND

GND

GND
VDD
VDD

GND

ADF_*B
ADF_B
ADF_*A
ADF_A

DES
GND
+3.3V

DS
GND
+3.3V
HRL

J1401DH

Ethernet
1 2 3 4 1 2 3

J1402DH 4 3 2 1 3 2 1
J1401L
19

18

17

16

15

14

13

12

11

10

J1310D
9

1 J1003DH
2

8
J1402L 1 2 3 4 2 1 J1003D
J941_BUS[0:19] J1310DH
J9091_BUS[0:4] J9111_BUS[0:8]

COR4
19 4 8 4 3 2 1 1 2
J1310L
5 4 3 2 1 J1003L
J941 J2000 J9091 J9111 MT32
J942

J2008
1
2

MT22
2

CT J945 1 2
1

UN17
3

SL
B B
TEL J944 Off Hook PCB
PC SL4
UN16 ADF Pickup
FAX-NCU PCB Solenoid
J1404
LINE J943 1 2 3
4 3 2 1
1 2 3

J1305
M720 PS701 4 3 2 1
J1312
1 2 3 1 2 3
J1302

Reader Motor CIS Unit 4 3 2 1

MF8580Cdw/8550Cdn Model Homeposition 1 2 3 1 2 3

Sensor M

M721 PS702 PS703


ADF Motor Document End Document
A Sensor Sensor A

READER / ADF Unit

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

P.2
F-9-3

IV
V

■■MF8500 (3/3)

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8500) > MF8500 (3/3)

Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8500) > MF8500 (3/3)
F F

GND
28 28
GND
27 27
+3.3V_A
26 26
+3.3V_A
25 25

6
+3.3V_D
24 24

5
+3.3V_D
23 23
UN14

J9531

J953

4
SHUT

28

28
22 22
Control Panel LCD PCB

3
DCLK
21 21

J952
J9531_BUS[0:28]

2
VSYNC

J953_BUS[0:28]
E 20 20 E

1
HSYNC
19 19
DISP_ENB
J951
LCD 18
DATA7
18

17 17 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
DATA6
16 16 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27
DATA5
15 15
DATA4
14 14
DATA3
13 13
DATA2
12 12
DATA1
6 5 4 3 2 1
11 11
DATA0
J961
10 10
SDOUT
D D
UN20
9 9
SCLK
8 8
Control Panel Key PCB
/SCS
7 7
/RESET
6 6
SDIN
5 5
LED_ANODE
4 4
LED_ANODE
3 3

FT41
LED_CATH
2 2
LCD Module 1
LED_CATH
1

/RST_PULQUE
LVDS_DATA_N
LVDS_DATA_P

LVDS_CLK_N
LVDS_CLK_P

/RST_PANEL
PANEL_RX1

PANEL_RX0
C C

PANEL_TX1

PANEL_TX0
LCD_DOUT
+3.3V_LCD

+3.3V_LCD

LCD_CLK
LCD_DIN
LCD_CS

+3.3V
+24V
GND

GND

GND

GND

GND

GND

GND

GND
MT42

1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27

2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
J924

B B

UN13
Main Controller PCB

A A

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

P.3
F-9-4

V
VI

General Circuit Diagram (MF8200)


■■MF8200 (1/2)
Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8200) > MF8200 (1/2)

Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8200) > MF8200 (1/2)
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

Laser Scanner Unit SR606 ITB Unit SR602


M704 Developing SW2 SR601
Laser Scanner Motor Homeposition Front Cover Sensor
SR603 Registration
Cassette Paper
UN6 UN7 Fixing Loop Detection
UN11 Sensor Detection Sensor
2 1 Patch Registration Patch Sensor Sensor Sensor
Laser Driver PCB
F F
M

J501 Sensor
J621 J611

S7
S8

S5
S6

S3
S4

S1
S2

J151
J152
J153
J704

S10

J161
J162
J163
29

S9
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J603 J602
1 2 3 1 2 3

J501_BUS[0:29]

(W)

(W)

(W)

(W)
(R)

(R)

(R)

(R)

(GN)
(GN)
(GN)

(GY)
(GY)
(GY)
(BL)

(BL)
(W)

(W)
(R)

(R)
10

12

13
14
15

16
17
18

19
20
21

22
23
24

25

26

27

28
29
1
2

4
5
6

7
8
9

11
LD4PWM

LD3PWM

LD2PWM

LD1PWM
CNT120
CNT121

/VDO10
+3.3VB

+3.3VB

+3.3VB

+3.3VB

VDO10
CNT41
CNT40

CNT31
CNT30
/VDO4

/VDO3

/VDO2
SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND
VDO4

VDO3

VDO2
/BDI

RD_GAIN1
RD_GAIN0
RD_REGA
/SCNDEC
/SCNACC

RD_PWM

LOOPSNS
RD_DIFA
ITBLSNS

REGSNS
29

28
27
26
25

24
23

22
21
20

19
18

17
16
15

14
13

12
11
10

DHPSNS

DOPENF

R_PWM

CSTSNS
R_DIFA
9
8
7

6
5

4
3

2
1

+3.3VB

+3.3VB

+3.3VB
+24VA

+24VA

+24VA
PGND

+3.3VB

SGND

SGND

+3.3VB

+3.3VB

+3.3VB
SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND
VSS4

VSS3

VSS2

VSS1
VIN

VIN

VIN

VIN
J108_BUS[0:29]

4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1 2 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1
29
J109 J124 J120 J131 J130 J119 J116 J127 J126

E J108
E
UN1
DC Controller PCB
J140 J107 J115
J117 J103 J105 J104
21 1 2 3 4 5 6 23 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5
25

J107_BUS[0:23]
+3LED
SGND
MPTPSNS
+3LED
SGND
MPTRSNS

MAINTH
SGND
+3.3VB
SGND
PWRSNS
J115_BUS[0:25]

10

12
13

14
15
16

17
18

19
20
21

22
23
1
2

3
4
5

6
7
8

11

/SW_ON/OFF

10

12

13
14

15

16

17
18

19

20

21
22

23

24
25
REM24V

1
2

3
4

7
8

11
PSOFF
WAKEENG

+3.3VA
+3.3VA

+24VA
+24VA
SGND
SGND

PGND
PGND
WAKEVC
/VDOEN

RTC3V
/CCRT

/VDO4

/VDO3

/VDO2

/VDO1
SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND

SGND
VDO4

VDO3

VDO2

VDO1
SCLK
/TOP

/BD0
SC
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
SR611

1
23
22

21
20
19

18
17
16

15

14
13

12
11
10
J373

9
8
7

6
5
4

3
2
1

2
Media Width

FREQSNS

3
J912_BUS[0:23]

/HVRESET
FSRD+

TEMPSNS
FSRD-

HVDACLK
Sensor (R)

SGND

HVDATA1
ICLRSNS
J951

DOPENR

ICLBSNS
RLD+

PWLSNS
FPRSNS

HVDALD
RLD-

DEVCLK
D D

FDSNS

+3.3VB
PGND

+24VA
+24VA
SGND

SGND

PGND
PGND
TNR4
TNR3
TNR2
TNR1
TR2S
TR1S
J604 J605 J914 J351

6
24V
3 2 1 3 2 1
23 6 5 4 3 2 1

2
SGND

25

24
23

22

21
20

19

18

17

16

15
14

13

12
11

10
J203

2
FUSER_TH

9
8

6
5

1
SGND
J912
UN20

1
3

3
SR604 SR605
3.3V
UN5

1
J1001_BUS[0:25]

2
3.3V
Main Controller PCB Fixing Power Supply PCB J802D J802H J802L
TH802 J1001

1
MP Tray MP Tray SGND
Thermistor

1
Paper Pre-Registration MF8230Cn Model J915 J352

4
/RESET

2
Detection Detection

3
3.3D_ON

3
J929

2
24S_ON
Sensor Sensor

4
3 2 1

UN4

1
Multi-purpose Tray Unit Low Voltage

2
J393
SOLD2 TUBE
Power Supply

J801
H801
FU NEUTRAL
A1 B3 J201

1
1

2
J391 LIVE2 (BK)

3
J311 J211
PCB
2

SR608 SR607

1
TP1

2
2

Fixing Heater

3
1
2 1

2
FU LIVE
1

2
12
TP
3

J392
Fixing Pressure Rear Cover

2
NEUTRAL2 (W)

1
TB1 TB2

3
SW1

1
C Release Sensor Sensor C
Main Power Switch
SW4
2

2
J391B
SOLD1
Main Power Switch

1
1

INLET_100V
J6001
L(BK)
UN3
3
SOLD6 High Voltage Power Supply PCB
3
2 SOLD14 N(W) J301A
1 SOLD7 2
SR609 FDSNS (BL)
J1024
1

MT302

4
(GY)
Fixing Delivery Sensor PWLSNS

J371
J372
J1023

J810
(BL)
J6002

(R)

3
L(BK) SGND (OR)
3

INLET_200V 3
SOLD8 J301B J1022

2
SOLD99 (GN)
N(W)
SR610 +3.3VB
2

2 J1021
SOLD9

1
1
1

MT301 Media Width Sensor (L)

+24VA
PGND
Fixing Unit Sensor
B B
2 1

21
DEVSL
FEEDI1B
1 UN2 J401 Fixing Assembly
20
FEEDI0B
2 J408 Driver PCB
3
J202_BUS[0:21] 19
FEEDI1A J406 J407 J402 J403 J404 J405
4
UN3
21

18 J172 SGND (V)


FEEDI0A 5 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 J1011
J171 TEMPSNS (V)
Environment
17
FEEDPB 6 J408_BUS[0:21] J1012
16
FEEDPA 7
Sensor
(GN)
(GN)
(GN)
(GN)

(GN)
(GN)
(GN)
(GN)
15
FEEDSL 8
14
FSRMPA 9
13
FSRMPB 10
FANPWM

12
/FSRMAOUT

/FSRMBOUT
/MAINMACC
/MAINMDEC

/FEEDAOUT

/FEEDBOUT
FSRMAOUT

FSRMBOUT

FSRMI0A

FEEDAOUT

FEEDBOUT
FANLK

11
/MAINMFG
PGND
FEEDSL

11
DEVSL

FSRMI1A
+24VA

+24VA

12
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
PGND
PGND
PGND

10
FSRMI0B 13
9
FSRMI1B 14
1 2 3
8 2 1 2 1
/MAINMFG 15 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
7 SL SL
/MAINMACC 16 J701 J703 J702
6

SL705 SL706 FM1


/MAINMDEC 17
5
SGND
A A
18
4
SGND 19 Cassette Pickup Developing Fan M M M
3
2
FAN_ON 20 Solenoid Separation
FANLK
1
21
Solenoid
M701 M703 M702
Main Motor Fixing Motor Pickup Motor

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

P.1
F-9-5

VI
VII

■■MF8200 (2/2)

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8200) > MF8200 (2/2)

Appendex > General Circuit Diagram > General Circuit Diagram (MF8200) > MF8200 (2/2)
F F
USB-Memory
J9710 VBUS GND
1 1
28 28
DM GND
2 2

6
UN24
27 27

UN21

J9531_BUS[0:28]
+3.3V_A

J971
4

4
3 DP 3

5
26 26

J953
+3.3V_A
4 GND 4
USB Host Control Panel LCD PCB

28

4
25 25
J9710_BUS[0:4] J971_BUS[0:4] +3.3V_D
PCB

3
24 24

J953_BUS[0:28]
+3.3V_D
CIS Unit

2
J972 23 23

J952
SHUT FFC

1
6 5 4 3 2 1 22 22

J9531

28
DCLK J951
21 21 J409
VSYNC 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
2 4 6 8 10 12 14
20 20
HSYNC 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15
19 19

MF8280Cw/8240Cw Model LCD 18


DISP_ENB
DATA7
18
17 17
DATA6
16 16
DATA5
E 15
DATA4
15
E
UN16
14 14 6 5 4 3 2 1
DATA3
13 13 J961
MF8280Cw/8250Cn Wireless LAN PCB 12
DATA2
12

Model 11
DATA1

DATA0
11 UN22
J1005 10 10 Control Panel Key PCB
SP1 9
SDOUT
9

SOLD?
17 SCLK
Speaker

Y
8 8

WH
/SCS

PK
Y
Y
7 7
J1005_BUS[0:17] /RESET
6 6
SDIN
SOLD9
1
2

5 5

FT41
SOLD? LED_ANODE
4 4

10

12

13
14

15
16
17
1
2

3
4
5

6
7
8

11
LED_ANODE
3 3
LED_CATH
2 2

RESET
LCD Module
LED_CATH
DATA1

DATA3

DATA0

DATA2
MT42

CMD
GND

GND

GND

LINK

GND
1 1
VDD

VDD
CLK
N.C

N.C

N.C

/RST_PULQUE
LVDS_DATA_N
LVDS_DATA_P

LVDS_CLK_N
LVDS_CLK_P

/RST_PANEL
PANEL_RX1

PANEL_RX0
PANEL_TX1

PANEL_TX0
LCD_DOUT
+3.3V_LCD

+3.3V_LCD

+3.3_AFEA
LCD_CLK
SOLD?

LCD_DIN

CISMODE
LCD_CS

CISOUTO
CISOUT2

CISOUT1

+12_LED

G_CTHD
R_CTHD
B_CTHD
10

12

13
14
15

16
17
11

CISCLK
+3.3V
1
2
3

4
5
6

7
8

+24V

GND

GND

GND

GND

GND

GND

GND

CISSP
VREF
GND

GND

GND
Y
+5V_USB
D D

H_DM
J910_BUS[0:17]

H_DP
GND

GND
1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15
17
1 2 3 4 5 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 2 4 6 8 10 12 14
J910 J908 J924
1 2 J901
J922

UN20
Main Controller PCB

J918 J9211 J909 J911 J904L J903L (J903LH)


6 5 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
19 4 8 MT31
MT21

C C
J918_BUS[0:19] J909_BUS[0:4] J911_BUS[0:8]

COR5
10

12
13
14
15
16

17
18

19
1

4
5

7
8

11

2
3

2
3

5
6

/BOOK_B

/BOOK_A
BOOK_B

BOOK_A
/MODEM_DCD

/MODEM_CTS
/MODEM_RTS
MODEM_ESC

/INT_MODEM
/MODEM_CI1
/MODEM_CI2
MODEM_RX
MODEM_TX

+3.3V
MONI_OUT

GND
HPS
/RST_FAX

J1402D J1401D
/HOOK

ADF_*B

ADF_*A
ADF_B

ADF_A
GND

GND

GND
VDD
VDD

+3.3V

+3.3V
GND

USB Device
J1402DH
HRL

J1401DH

GND

GND
DES
1 2 3 4 1 2 3

DS
Ethernet
4 3 2 1 3 2 1
J1402L J1401L
19

18

17
16

15

14

13
12
11

10

J1310D
9

8
7
6

5
4

3
2
1

2
3

2
3

5
6

8
J1310DH 1 2 3 4
J941_BUS[0:19]
J9091_BUS[0:4] J9111_BUS[0:8]

COR4
19 4 8 J1310L 4 3 2 1
1 2
J941 J2003 J9091 J9111 MT32

MT22
UN26
J942

CT J945
B B
1

3
2

Off Hook PCB


J2001
2

PC J1305
1

TEL J944
UN25 4 3 2 1

FAX-NCU PCB J1404 1 2 3 4


LINE J943 1 2 3 J1302
4 3 2 1
M J1312
1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3

M721
123
1 2 3

M720 PS701 ADF Motor


MF8280Cw/8250Cn Model
Reader Motor CIS Unit PS702 PS703
Homeposition Document End Document Sensor
Sensor Sensor

MF8280Cw/8250Cn/8240Cw/8230Cn Model
A A
READER / ADF Unit

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

P.2
F-9-6

VII
VIII

Backup Data
Appendex > Backup Data

Appendex > Backup Data


Data Location Replace Delete Backup by User Backup by Service

User function > Initialize Menu Service function

Initialize Menu Other

DC Controller Main Preferences Timer Common Copy Fax Scan USB Printer Initialize Initializing the Initializing Initializing R-CON SRVC- HIST ALL Yes/No Method Location Yes/No Method Location
PCB Controller Settings Settings Settings Settings Settings Direct Settings All Address Book the Key and the System *2 DAT *4 *5 to be to be
PCB Print Certificate Management *3 stored stored
*1 Settings Settings
Address Book Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - - - Clear - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -

Menu
Preferences Flash ROM - Clear Clear - - - - - - - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -

Timer Settings Flash ROM - Clear - Clear - - - - - - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -

Common Settings Flash ROM - Clear - - Clear - - - - - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -

Copy Settings Flash ROM - Clear - - - Clear - - - - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -

Fax Settings Flash ROM - Clear - - - - Clear - - - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -
*6
Scan Settings Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - Clear - - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -
*7
USB Direct Print Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - Clear - Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -
Settings
Printer Settings Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - Clear Clear - - - - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -

Key and Certificate Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - - - - Clear - Clear No - - No - -


*10
System Management Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - - - - - Clear - - - Clear Yes Remote UI PC No - -
Settings *12 *13
Serial Number Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - No - - No - -
*11
Job History Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - - - - - - - - Clear Clear No - - No - -

Service Service mode RCON - - - - - - - - - - - - - - Clear - - - No - - No - -


mode setting values
(R-CON)
Service mode Flash ROM - Clear - - - - - - - - - - - - - Clear - Clear No - - Yes Service USB
setting values mode memory
(MN-CON) *8
Service mode Flash ROM Clear - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - No - - Yes Service Flash
setting values mode ROM
(DC-CON) *9
T-9-3

*1. Log data such as Mac address, USB serial number, printer-related setting values, scanner-related setting values, user data, and logs are initialized.
*2. The factory adjustment values of the Reader and ADF are initialized.
*3. Service data is cleared. User data is not cleared. The factory adjustment values of the Reader and ADF are not initialized.
*4. The logs (communication management, print, jam, error, and alarm) are cleared.
*5. The user data, service data, logs, and system administrator are initialized. (The system manager ID and password are changed back to the default values.) The factory adjustment values of the Reader and ADF are not initialized.
*6. Excluding Fax Setup Guide
*7. Excluding the shortcut key
*8. FUNCTION > SYSTEM > IMPORT / FUNCTION > SYSTEM > EXPORT
*9. FUNCTION > VIFFNC > STOR-DCN / FUNCTION > VIFFNC > RSTR-DCN
*10. When the key and certificate are initialized, TLS authentication of IEEE802.1X and the SSL setting are changed to "OFF".
*11. Only devices without counter meter are supported. After replacement of the PCB, resetting is required. OPTION > SERIAL > SN-MAIN
*12. The system administrator ID and the password are changed back to the default values. <Counter meter-installed model> ID: 7654321 / PWD: 7654321 <Model without counter meter> ID: 0 / PWD: 0
*13. Excluding [Forwarding Settings], [Remote UI On/Off], [Update Firmware], [Initialize Key and Certificate], [Initialize Address Book], and [Initialize System Management Settings]

VIII

You might also like